* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download 1 - Case Western Reserve University
Survey
Document related concepts
Transcript
REQUIREMENTS AND PROCEDURES FOR CLINICAL EDUCATION IN SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATION SCIENCES CASE WESTERN RESERVE UNIVERSITY 2004-06 SIGN-OFF SHEET I have read all of the information in the Clinical Education Manual. I understand that I am responsible for completing the requirements outlined therein. Please sign and return to Department Assistant. ________________________________ Signature _________________ Date PHILOSOPHY AND OBJECTIVES The graduate program in speech-language pathology is accredited by the Council on Academic Accreditation in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology of the American Speech-Language and Hearing Association (ASHA). The Department is affiliated with and located in the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center (CHSC), one of the largest centers serving children and adults with communication disorders. The Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center is an ASHA accredited professional service program. The program's philosophy and objective is to educate highly competent clinical practitioners and researchers in speech and language disorders. The intent is to educate all students to embody the best of the clinician's and researcher's rigorous approach to problem solving and intuitive, artful skills. Clinical education is viewed as a dynamic process which prepares practitioners who manifest the following characteristics: • • • • • A broadly-based foundation of knowledge in communication sciences and disorders, with emphasis on a processing framework that helps the student analyze and synthesize information. A problem-solving attitude of inquiry and decision making as represented in the scientific method. A high level of applied skill competency in clinical diagnosis and treatment. An ability to participate in the interprofessional rehabilitation management of clients. The ability to communicate effectively and professionally with clients, their families and with other professionals. Clinical education offers preparation necessary to meet requirements for the following: 1. ASHA Certificate of Clinical Competence in Speech-Language Pathology 2. Ohio Licensure in Speech-Language Pathology 3. Ohio Department of Education Teacher Licensure as a Speech and Language Therapist for schools Appropriate application forms and specific requirements for each of these certificates and licenses are available in the office of the Department of Communication Sciences. CLINICAL REQUIREMENTS AND PROCEDURES STUDENT CLINICIANS Student interns work in cooperation with certified speech-language pathologists and/or audiologists in the delivery of services to communicatively impaired persons. The practicum experience is designed to facilitate application of principles and procedures gained through academic course-work and clinical observations to the actual delivery of services. Practicum assignments are chosen to allow for the gradual development of those skills required for independent functioning as clinical speech-language pathologists. Student responsibilities during each practicum assignment are determined based on 1) guidelines set by Council on Academic Accreditation in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology (CAA) of the American Speech-Language and Hearing Association (ASHA), 2) the student's level of competence, and 3) the policies and procedures of the facility where the student is placed. During each semester of enrollment in the Master's degree program students are required to participate in clinical practicum and enroll in COSI 452: Graduate Clinical Practicum for 1 credit (3 semesters minimum). All Master's students must have completed an undergraduate course in Clinical Procedures before enrolling in COSI 452. If a student did not complete a Clinical Procedures course as an undergraduate, he/she must complete COSI 352: Practicum in Communication Disorders before enrolling in COSI 452. Undergraduate students who have declared Communication Disorders as a major and who have achieved senior status have the option of participating in clinical practicum. During the Fall Semester of the senior year, students must enroll in COSI 352 INTRODUCTION TO CLINICAL PRACTICE. Practicum assignments are made through this course by the Coordinator of Clinical Education after graduate student assignments have been made. PROCEDURES FOR OBTAINING CLINICAL ASSIGNMENTS Clinical Assignments are made by the Coordinator of Clinical Education with CHSC Clinicians and externship Supervisors. Procedures for clinical assignments are as follows: 1. Students turn in practicum requests, class schedules, a listing of their previous clinical experience, and a listing of all courses they have completed and are currently enrolled in during the first week of classes each semester. Students also note the approximate number of hours per week they would like for their clinical assignment. This information should be completed on the Graduate Practicum Clinical Summary form located in Appendix B. 2. Students must have a 3.0 GPA to be enrolled in Clinic. 3. The Coordinator of Clinical Education contacts CHSC Clinicians and Externship Supervisors to determine potential placements. 4. Assignments are given to students by the beginning of the second week of classes. Students should contact their Clinical Supervisors immediately and make arrangements to begin clinical assignments. 5. Any revisions in schedule are completed by the end of the third week of classes. 6. Students begin clinical work by the third week of classes. Students should contact the Coordinator of Clinical Education immediately if there are any difficulties/concerns related to their clinical assignment (e.g., decrease in hours projected; change in supervisor’s schedule; concerns about skills in clinic). 7. Students terminate clinical work at the END of regularly scheduled courses. (No clinic final exam week.) Students may continue their placements for a longer period of time if approved by their supervisor and the Coordinator of Clinical Education. 8. In some cases a student’s clinical assignment may continue across a two semester period. Extension of an assignment for more than one semester should benefit the student’s training needs. Such decisions are made at the discretion of the Coordinator of Clinical Education with input from the clinical supervisor/instructor and the student. ASSISTANT CLINICIANS Undergraduate and graduate students enrolled in COSI 352 may be assigned as assistant clinicians. The purpose of this experience is to provide the novice student clinicians with a structured introduction to therapy. Before students are assigned as assistant clinicians, they must have completed their 25 hours of supervised clinical observation. The assistant clinician will be considered part of the treatment team along with the primary student clinician and the supervisor. As a result, the assistant clinician is expected to attend every therapy session and every scheduled conference the primary student clinician has with the supervisor. If there is a disagreement between the two student clinicians concerning treatment, they should first attempt to resolve it themselves and then seek the advice of their supervisor. Assistant clinicians are expected to independently seek out information related to their clinical experience. In addition, the assistant clinician will be required to do the following: 1. Contact primary clinician. Read the case folder as soon as the client is assigned. The student clinicians should discuss the case together, before the initial conference with the supervisor. 2. The assistant clinician should be aware of the information on the case summary form the primary clinician completes prior to the initial supervisory conference. 3. The assistant clinician should have the primary clinician explain the lesson plan for each session so that he or she is fully aware of the goals, their rationale, and the procedures to be used during the session. 4. The assistant clinician will generally be in the room for every session. 5. After the assistant clinician has become familiar with the client and his/her goals, he or she will choose one area to work on with the Client. For that area, this clinician will write the goal, plan the therapy, and execute the therapy plan. 6. By the last two weeks of therapy, the assistant clinician should be able to plan the sessions with the help of the primary clinician and completely run the sessions. The last two sessions or the last two out of three sessions should be completely planned by and executed by the assistant clinician. 7. The assistant clinician will be responsible for section(s) of the progress report as assigned by the supervisor. The following are some suggested duties for the assistant clinician: 1. Help in attaining or analyzing a speech/language sample. 2. Taking data during therapy sessions. 3. Serve as a speech/language model for the Client. 4. Assist with the manipulation of therapy materials. 5. Provide reinforcements to Client. 6. Explain therapy goals and tasks to family members/elicit their input concerning therapy. 7. Contact other sources of the Client’s natural environment for information about their communication outside of the clinic setting. 8. Set up the room for therapy session. 9. Design therapy materials. 10. Monitor a specified behavior of the primary clinician. Assistant clinicians are given letter grades of A, B, or C. Any students receiving a C as an assistant clinician will have to be an assistant clinician again before he or she can be assigned a client as the primary clinician. GRADUATE PRACTICUM COURSE REQUIREMENTS 1. All students participating in Graduate Practicum assignments must be enrolled in COSI 452. 2. All full-time graduate students will initially be assigned to clinical duties at CHSC for approximately 4-8 hours per week. Part-time students will be assigned to 2-4 hours per week. Once a student has successfully completed approximately 100 contact hours, he/she can be considered for an externship site placement. Externship placements are typically made for 10 hours per week during the school year. During the summer semester, students are encouraged to schedule 2-4 full days per week of clinical assignments (8 weeks minimum). This allows students to simulate the professional expectations and hours of a speech-language pathologist in a typical job setting. It also allows students to complete a large number of clinical hours during a period of time when coursework is minimal. Externship sites vary in the time commitments required. Some sites require that students work three days per week; other site vary their expectations in relation to the goals and needs of the student. Some sites interview potential student externs from CWRU and other area programs prior to selecting the candidate for the position. Interviewing schedules will be announced during Graduate Practicum class. 3. Students enrolled in Graduate Clinical Practicum are required to attend all sessions of the practicum course. Unexcused absences from this course will result in the lowering of the student's semester grade by one letter grade. 4. First and second year students are required to do a formal case presentation to the Department through the COSI 452 course. 5. All students must submit two (2) completed Evaluation of videotaped/audiotaped sessions. 6. Students assigned to a public school site, who are working towards school certification, may be excused from the weekly course meetings on an individual basis as determined by the Coordinator of Clinical Education. Students are typically assigned to the school setting for 4 days per week for 16 weeks. Semester grades for these students will be determined solely by their Master Teacher through the public school evaluation. School assignments are made by Coordinator of Teacher Licensure. Please inform the Director of your intention to complete a public school practicum at least one semester before the placement is needed. Students should review their course of study on an individual basis with the Coordinator to ensure they are meeting all the requirements for Ohio Teacher Licensure. 7. Students are required to submit signed certification of practicum hours within 30 days of the completion of their clinical assignment. The clinical practicum record forms may be obtained from the Coordinator of Clinical Education or the Department office. (See Appendix A) 8. Students are required to provide the Coordinator of Clinical Education with all original, signed practicum records, keep personal copies of their practicum records, and inform the Coordinator of Clinical Education as to their completion of ASHA requirements. A record of clinical hours will be kept on file by the Coordinator of Clinical Education. 9. A student’s grade for the Graduate Practicum course (COSI 452) will be determined from their clinical performance (as evaluated by their clinical supervisor(s)), their attendance at COSI 452 class, and their performance on class assignments. When students are placed with more than one supervisor, their clinic grade will be weighted in relation to the number of hours earned with each supervisor. 10. Students must meet with the Coordinator of Clinical Education 30 days prior to graduation to initiate a final clinical hours certification check. Expectations Students should view themselves as professionals while participating in their clinic assignments. It is assumed that graduate clinicians are responsible and will take initiative in meeting all clinical and professional expectations in their clinical assignments. Students are expected to conform to procedures used at each of their educational sites. Specific guidelines will be provided at CHSC and each externship. Clinical Contracts When students approach one of the Clinical Supervisors to arrange clinical assignments, THEY ARE, IN EFFECT, ENTERING INTO A VERBAL CONTRACTUAL AGREEMENT WITH THE INSTRUCTOR. Students may not alter the contract unless the changes are approved by the Clinical Supervisors and the Coordinator of Clinical Education. In addition to the verbal agreement, Clinical Supervisors will complete a written clinical contract with the student. A copy of that contract is provided in Appendix B. Despite requirements of coursework, obligations to clients and supervisors may not be offset. Absences from Assignments Clinical absences require notification of the Instructor (and client when appropriate) within a timely fashion. Rules regarding absence from clinical duties are as follows: with exception of illness, family emergencies, and University holidays, your contractual agreement with your Clinical Instructor must be honored. Students should inform their clinical instructors of upcoming University holidays and deadlines (i.e., date of end of the semester). Other causes for absences, such as religious holidays, will be considered on an individual basis by the Coordinator of Clinical Education and the Clinical Supervisors upon submission of absence request. Dress Code The first impression a person often makes about another is his/her manner of dress. This is especially true when one seeks professional services. As a clinician, it is important that your appearance underscore and not distract from your professional image. Professional dress is conservative. This professional dress must be followed when seeing clients and when observing therapy. Failure to follow dress code will result in a less favorable evaluation. The specific rules for professional dress are as follows: • Men - Must wear conservative shirt and tie Dress slacks Appropriate shoes • Women - Conservative blouses Dress slacks Skirts and dresses must be knee length Appropriate shoes The following are considered unprofessional dress: Blouses with low necklines Backless tops or dresses Shorts Short skirts Party dresses Jeans T-shirts Sweatshirts Tennis or gym shoes Work boots Distracting makeup, necklaces, or jewelry Dress should not distract or inhibit a graduate clinician’s ability to conduct clinical duties effectively. Dress codes will vary from site to site. Please talk with supervisors at each site to clarify dress expectations. Professional Language Any type of profanity or swearing is not allowed. This restriction includes swearing that may be allowed on television or PG rated movies. In addition, when dealing with clients or their families, one should be careful in using other examples of unprofessional language such as slang or inappropriate humor. Your communications with clients, their families, the clinical staff, and the secretarial staff should always be polite. All supervisors should be addressed formally; thus they should be addressed as Dr., Mrs., Ms., or Mr. at all times. Adult clients and parents of child clients should always initially be addressed formally. Professionalism Professionalism encompasses the above areas of professional dress and professional language. It also includes other behaviors which are expected of a professional. As you are in training to become a professional, it is essential that you develop appropriate professional behaviors. Among these professional behaviors are: 1) punctuality for meetings, deadlines, and therapy sessions, 2) dependability, 3) ability to take and act upon constructive criticism, 4) ability to voice appropriately your opinions to your supervisors, 5) being aware of what you do and do not know, 6) appropriate non-verbal behaviors, 7) self-evaluating your performance, 8) demonstrating confidence, 9) intellectual curiosity, 10) ethical behavior, 11) non-discrimination, 12) emotional control, 13) demeanor, 14) attitude. As you will throughout your career, you need to independently seek out information to improve your clinical knowledge and skills. Most importantly, professionalism entails a dedication to helping your clients improve in their ability to communicate. External Placements With the exception of public school practicum, external placement decisions in speech-language pathology are made by the Coordinator of Clinical Education with advice from the supervisory staff. Students must have at least 100 clinic hours before they can be considered for most external sites. Many sites require other specific requirements such as previous hospital experience. The student must have an overall GPA of at least 3.0 to be considered for an external placement. Many sites require each student to complete a clinically oriented project as part of the practicum experience. Some externships also require that the student be interviewed before being accepted as an extern. Several factors will be taken into consideration for being given an external placement. Among them are the following: 1. Previous clinical experiences-types of clients seen 2. Number of clinical hours earned 3. Opinion of previous supervisors that you can make clinical decisions with a certain degree of independence 4. Previous coursework 5. Date of graduation-those near graduation will be given priority 6. Success in previous external practicum 7. Level of professionalism in interaction with others 8. Transportation available to site 9. Willingness and/or ability to follow requirements of the site 10. Number of hours available per week to give to site 11. Schedule flexibility 12. Interest in populations seen at a given available site It should be stressed that being assigned any external placement is something that must be earned and is not a right. If a student has more than 50 hours from an undergraduate program other than CWRU, he or she will still be required to complete at least 25 hours in the CHSC before being considered for an external placement. It is of paramount importance that you take full advantage of your external placements. External placements are invaluable training for future employment. Employers are highly impressed with a positive evaluation from an external supervisor. You should also remember that external supervisors are not paid for taking students and do it because they are dedicated to helping train future speech-language pathologists. They are, as a group, patient and willing to help students who demonstrate a sincere desire to improve their skills. Be sure to take advantage of attending team meetings and other experiences such as observing at other sites affiliated with your site. From conversations with various external supervisors, the following will result in a more favorable evaluation: • Enthusiasm toward working with the populations seen at the facility • Completing independent reading on the types of disorders the clients at the site have • Asking pertinent questions • Requesting reading materials to increase fund of knowledge • Independently searching for information for improving your therapy techniques • Familiarizing yourself with assessment techniques used at the site • Flexibility to changing schedules and demands • Willingness to change approach if client is having difficulty • Willingness and ability to counsel the families of clients seen • Ability to empathize with client needs • Willingness to try new procedures • Punctuality in all areas • Using time effectively • Adapting to the note and report writing style used at the site • Presenting in a positive constructive way at interdisciplinary meetings • Ability to interpret diagnostic information • • • Demonstrating the ability to use supervisor feedback successfully Willingness and ability to become more independent in clinical skills as the practicum experience proceeds Overall professionalism while at the site EVALUATION PROCEDURES The following outline presents the steps for evaluating students' progress during a semester of Clinical Practicum. 1. Evaluation of clinical skills is an ongoing process throughout the student's clinical education. At any point during the course of the semester a Clinical Supervisor may request a conference to discuss a student's progress. The Clinical Supervisor needs to apprise the Coordinator of Clinical Education of any issues or concerns that arise relating to Clinical Education. (Sample forms for session feed-back and midterm/end-ofsemester evaluation are included in Appendix B of this document.) Students are also encouraged to make an appointment to meet with the Coordinator of Clinical Education at any time during the semester to discuss their progress and performance in their practicum assignments. 2. At the beginning of each clinic, practicum students will meet with their supervisors and complete the supervisory needs form to help identify how the supervisor can best help the student (Appendix B) 3. A midterm evaluation will be held by each student and supervisor to review performance and identify strengths and areas to be improved. A written copy of the midterm evaluation will be sent to the Coordinator of Clinical Education. (See Appendix B) 4. At the conclusion of the semester the following should be completed: a) A written evaluation of the student's progress will be completed by the Clinical Supervisor, reviewed orally with the student and sent to the Coordinator of Clinical Education. b) The student clinician will complete the Supervisor Evaluation Form (See Appendix B). Students can provide their clinical supervisor with a copy of the evaluation after the student's semester grade has been completed. A copy of the Supervisor Evaluation information must be given to the Coordinator of Clinical Education at the end of the semester. c) The student will make an appointment to meet with the Coordinator of Clinical Education to review clinical strengths and areas to improve. This meeting will also provide an opportunity to discuss upcoming clinic placements and to update the Coordinator of Clinical Education on progress toward ASHA requirements (clinical hours). 5. Within the final two weeks of the semester the Coordinator of Clinical Education and the Clinical Supervisors and Externship Clinical Supervisors will share the following information: a. The student's clinical strengths and weaknesses b. Recommendations for clinical status (as appropriate) c. Point value earned by the student in assignment with each supervisor 6. Clinical Probation. Clinical practicum assignments are a privilege and students are expected to act in a professional manner. Students judged as acting in an unprofessional manner or making inadequate progress will be placed on Clinical Probation. Clinical Probation status will be considered on an individual basis. When a student is placed on Clinical Probation, the Coordinator of Clinical Education will meet with the faculty and the Clinical Supervisors to define expectations for the student. These expectations will be defined in writing to the student and placed in their Student File. The student's response to the requirements will determine whether he/she is returned to regular clinical status or dismissed from the clinical education program. Students who have not met the stipulations of the Clinical Probation may not be permitted to complete their clinical requirements. 7. Grades will not be issued until all reports and clinical duties are completed to the supervisor's satisfaction. The student's grade may be lowered one letter grade each week that reports are overdue. CLINICAL GRADES: A STATEMENT OF PURPOSE The purpose of clinical grades is two-fold. First, these grades provide a system of measure for the level of clinical expertise presently maintained by the student-intern. Second, they serve to provide a continuous record of clinical performance through the student's course of study. The goal of both students and supervisors is to have graduating clinicians performing at the A grade level at the completion of their 375 supervised clinical hours. However, some students may reach the A grade level criteria early in their clinical training. Through systematic use of the Clinical Contract and the Semester Evaluations, students can identify areas for improvement. These areas can be focused on in subsequent clinical work so that the student can achieve success. Mid-term grade status will be communicated to the student by the Clinical Supervisor during the 8th week of the semester. Midterm grades provide a formal mechanism for identifying student strengths and areas to improve. Final Grades will be communicated at a final conference with the Clinical Instructor and Student Intern during Final Exam Week. Grades will be sent to the Coordinator of Clinical Education for placement in the clinical file. The Coordinator of Clinical Education may request a conference with Student Clinicians to discuss clinical progress at any point in the semester. Students are also encouraged to meet with the Coordinator of Clinical Education whenever the/a need Clinical grades are included in academic averages. The grading criteria are defined on forms in Appendix B and help a student build skills towards a professional level of competence. An overall clinical grade is derived from 1)a student’s participation in COSI 452 course and 2)weighted grading from clinical supervisors across assignments. The clinical grading systems includes a three-tier system of grades. Students will be graded in relation to expectations for their level of clinical experience as follows: Level I: 0-100 hours of clinic experience in SLP Level II: 101-200 hours of clinic experience in SLP; first externship site placement Level III: 201 or more hours of clinic experience in SLP; has had at least one previous externship site experience Letter grades are computed by the Coordinator of Clinical Education through weighted scorings on the points earned with each clinical assignment/supervisor. Clinical grades are also influenced by student participation and mandatory attendance in the COSI 452 class. A student’s grade can be lowered by one letter grade if they miss more than one class meeting of COSI 452 per semester. 4.5+ 3.7 - 4.4 3.6 - 3.0 2.3 - 2.9 Below 2.3 = = = = = A B C D F CLINICAL REQUIREMENTS NAME BADGE: All graduate clinicians will be provided with a CWRU Name Badge at the beginning of Fall Semester. Badges must be worn whenever services are provided at CHSC. Some externship sites also require identification badges. If lost, a replacement badge may be purchased for $2.00 through the department office. EQUIPMENT: All practicum students are required to have a tape recorder, microphone and audio cassettes for use in their practicum experience. Equipment should allow for quality recordings to enable students to do accurate transcription of speech/language samples. STUDENT LIABILITY INSURANCE: All students participating in clinical practicum are required to purchase student liability insurance annually. Proof of insurance must be given to the Coordinator of Clinical Education and filed in the student's clinic file. Insurance may be purchased through NSSHLA or through OSHA. STUDENT EXTERNSHIP MEDICAL STATEMENT: May be completed by family physician or may be completed by Case Student Health Services (http://www.cwru.edu/stuaff/UHS/uhs.html; 216-368-2450) at no cost. See attached form. CLINICAL FEES: Students will pay a $25 clinical fee annually (due in the Fall). This fee will be used to purchase clinical materials and forms which will be housed in the department. DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATION SCIENCES STUDENT EXTERNSHIP MEDICAL STATEMENT Student Name Date of Exam Date of Birth SSN This is to certify that I have examined the above-named person and have found him/her to be: 1. Free from apparent communicable disease. 2. Free from tuberculosis verified by two step Mantoux skin test (except for those with documentation of previously significant reaction). 3. Physically fit for work in a health care facility. 4. Immunizations: a. Immunized against measles and mumps; or born before December 31, 1956; or has a disease history of measles and mumps; or exempt from this requirement for medical or religious reasons. b. Immunized against rubella; or has a laboratory test demonstrating detectable rubella antibodies; or exempt from this requirement for medical or religious reasons. c. Immunized against tetanus and diptheria; or exempt from this requirement for medical or religious reasons. 5. List known allergies Signature of Physician Street Address City, State, and Zip Code Telephone No. ( ) Note: This does not take the place of a complete physical examination. The physician may exempt the student from the above immunization requirements for medical reasons. This form was adapted from the ODHS Child Care Center/Type A and Certified Type B Family Day Care Homes. (9/97) CLEVELAND HEARING & SPEECH (CHSC) WORKFORCE CONFIDENTIALITY AGREEMENT I understand that CHSC has a legal and ethical responsibility to maintain patient privacy, including obligations to protect and safeguard the confidentiality of patient information. In addition, I understand that I may see or hear other confidential information such as financial data and operational information. As a condition of my employment/affiliation with CHSC, I understand that I must sign and comply with this agreement. By signing this document, I understand and agree that: I understand that any patient or confidential information that I access at CHSC does not belong to me. I will disclose patient/confidential information only if such disclosure complies with CHSC policies and is required for the performance of my job. I will not discuss any information pertaining to CHSC in an area where unauthorized individuals may hear (e.g., hallways, elevators, social events). I understand that it is not acceptable to discuss patient or confidential information in public areas even if specifics such as patient name are not used. I will not make inquiries about patient or confidential information for any individual or party who does not have proper authorization to access such information. I will not access or view any information other than what is required to do my job. If I have any question about whether access to certain information is required, I will ask my supervisor. I will not make any unauthorized transmissions, copies, disclosures, inquiries, modifications, or purgings of patient or confidential information. Such unauthorized transmissions include, but are not limited to removing and/or transferring patient or confidential information from CHSC’s computer system to unauthorized locations (e.g., my home). Upon termination from CHSC, I will immediately return all property (e.g., keys, documents). I agree that my obligations under this agreement regarding patient information will continue after the termination of my employment/affiliation with CHSC. I understand that violation of this Agreement may result in disciplinary action, up to and including termination and/or suspension, restriction or loss or privileges, in accordance with CHSC’s policies, as well as potential personal civil and/or criminal legal penalties. My access code(s), user ID(s), password(s), etc. are kept confidential at all times. I have read the above agreement and agree to comply with all its terms as a condition of continuing employment. ___________________________ Signature Date _____________________ ___________________________ Name effective 4/14/03 My personal access code(s), user ID(s), access key(s) and password(s) used to access computer systems or other equipment are kept confidential at all times. HEALTH & SAFETY Students should be knowledgeable about procedures that can help protect themselves and their clients from the transmission of communicable diseases. These policies have been taken from the Policies & Procedures Manual of the Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center. Many common diseases are transmitted through contact with the body fluids of an infected person. To minimize the risk of transmission of these diseases, these guidelines describe universal precautions which are to be used with all clients at all times. They assume that blood and other body fluids from all clients are potentially infective and that exposure to these body fluids may occur during routine performance of job duties. Universal Precautions All students who work directly with clients in the course of Graduate Practicum must recognize that certain health risks are inherent in the practice of speech/language pathology. In order to protect themselves in this work environment, students should strictly adhere to the universal precautions which are described below. Universal precautions are recognized by infection control specialists as the best defense against the spread of infectious diseases. They are listed in the box below and described in more detail in the following sections. UNIVERSAL PRECAUTIONS Practicum students should treat all blood and OPIM (other potentially infectious materials) as though they are infectious and use universal precautions at all appropriate times. (Saliva and gingival fluids are considered to be potentially infectious material since they often may be contaminated with blood. 1. ROUTINE HAND WASHING 2. DISPOSABLE GLOVES 3. DISINFECT 1. Routine Hand Washing Wash hands carefully and thoroughly: *BEFORE AND AFTER EACH CLINICAL SESSION *when hands become contaminated with saliva, blood, or other body fluids (e.g., after sneezing, coughing, or wiping a nose) *after you use the toilet or help a client with toileting *after diapering *after handling soiled items, such as used tissues or dirty toys *before preparing or eating food 2. Disposable Gloves Wear disposable gloves when in contact with urine, stool, blood, or saliva, such as during oral examinations, cleaning wounds, or testing blood glucose. *wash hands immediately after removing gloves *dispose of gloves in plastic-lined container 3. Disinfect Sanitize potentially contaminated surfaces and objects: *Toys & other objects--if soiled with blood, feces, vomit, or urine must be disinfected or discarded immediately. Mouthed toys must be washed with soap and water or disinfected. *Dishes--wash with dishwashing liquid and hot water (120 degrees F), air dry. *Ear probe tips--if contaminated with blood or other visible substance, wash with soap and water. Disinfect in 70% alcohol solution for a minimum of 30 minutes. This solution should be changed daily. *Diapering->Wear disposable gloves when changing child. Dispose gloves after each child has been changed. >Changing surfaces should be non-porous. Disinfect surface after each diaper change. >Place soiled clothes in plastic bag to be sent home with child. >Clean child with dampened paper towels. Dispose of these materials in plastic-lined container. >Diaper & dress child. >Wash child’s hands in sink. >Clean changing mat with disinfectant. >Wash your hands thoroughly with soap and water. *Environmental spills of blood (e.g., nosebleeds), vomit, or other body fluids: >Wear disposable gloves >Wipe up spill with paper towels. Immediately dispose of this material in plastic-lined container >Wash area with soap and water >Douse with disinfectant or bleach (1:10 ratio of bleach to water) >Dispose of gloves in plastic-lined container >Wash hands thoroughly with soap and water EXPOSURE CONTROL The following job classifications at the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center are at moderate risk for occupational exposure to blood or other potentially infectious materials (OPIM): Speech/Language Pathologists; Audiologists; Interpreters; and Graduate Students working with CHSC clients under CHSC staff supervision. Clinical tasks and procedures associated with occupational exposure which may occur during speech/language pathology practicum assignments: 1. Oral Mechanism Screenings 2. Intervention that has potential for splattering (i.e., patients with tracheostomy or tracheostoma). 3. Servicing or routine cleansing of specialized medical equipment. 4. Performing dysphagia assessment and therapy. 5. Cleaning a blood of OPIM spill. 6. Coming into contact with blood or OPIM. 7. Assisting with toileting. 8. Disposing of medical waste including but not limited to blood or OPIM either in liquid, semi-liquid, or solid form. Clinical tasks and procedures associated with occupational exposure which may occur during practicum assignments under the supervision of audiologists include the following: 1. Cleaning a blood or OPIM spill. 2. Coming into contact with blood or OPIM. 3. Disposing of medical waste including but not limited to blood or OPIM either in liquid, semi-liquid, or solid form. HEPATITIS B VACCINE INFORMATION Hepatitis B Infection Hepatitis B is a major health problem in the United States. It is caused by a virus, the hepatitis B virus, and primarily affects the liver. Acute symptomatic infection can incapacitate a person for weeks or months and can, sometimes, lead to complications or chronic disease conditions. Fortunately, most people recover fully. Fifty to sixty percent of all hepatitis B infections, however, produce no symptoms in the infected person. These cases are more likely than the symptomatic ones to progress to complications. Some of the major chronic problems of hepatitis B infection are a chronic carrier state which develops in approximately 10% of the cases, and chronic persistent and chronic active hepatitis. Sometimes cirrhosis of the liver develops in a carrier. Also, the incidence of primary liver cancer is higher among chronic carriers than in noncarriers. Many cases of hepatitis B can now be prevented by vaccine. Hepatitis Risks to Students When a person has hepatitis B, the virus is found in their blood and many other body fluids. Because of the nature of client contact and the types of clients served, some students are at a higher risk for contracting hepatitis B than others. Many studies have been done to accurately attempt to identify just which people are at highest risk. These areas include departments where there is frequent contact with the blood of clients. Frequent blood contact has been shown to be the most important factor related to risk, especially contact with the blood of clients who are at high risk for developing hepatitis B. Hepatitis B Vaccine A vaccine for the prevention of hepatitis B first became available in 1982. A newer vaccine became available in 1987. This new vaccine is produced in yeast cells and does not involve the blood of hepatitis carriers. The vaccine is very effective, producing protective antibodies in 91% to 98% of healthy adults vaccinated. The duration of immunity is unknown at this time. The vaccine is administered intramuscularly in the deltoid muscle of the arm. The three does necessary for complete immunization are given over a six-month period of time. Soreness at the injection site is the most common adverse reaction. Less common are fatigue/weakness and headache. Fever and infection are also uncommon reactions. No serious adverse reactions have occurred in recipients of the new vaccine. As with any vaccine, there is the possibility that broad use of the vaccine could reveal adverse reactions not observed in clinical trials. Contraindications for use of the vaccine are any serious active infection or a hypersensitivity (allergy) to yeast. Hepatitis B vaccine will not prevent hepatitis caused by other agents, including the hepatitis A virus, the agent(s) which cause non-A, non-B hepatitis, or other viruses known to infect the liver. Students may want to consider having a hepatitis B vaccine series. Individuals should discuss this with their family physician. Some externship sites may require the Hepatitis B series. Please check with your hospital or skilled nursing facility extern supervisor for specific requirements. CLINICAL STAFF 1. COORDINATOR OF CLINICAL EDUCATION The Coordinator of Clinical Education oversees all aspects of clinical education and is responsible for clinical assignments and records of all Speech-Language Pathology Students. 2. DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATION SCIENCES FACULTY: Faculty, through coursework, assist students in developing a theoretical basis in communication sciences and disorders. They act as resources for both students and clinical instructors. As evidence of the close professional relationship between the Department of Communication Sciences and the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center, all faculty hold appointments as consultants to the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center staff and clinicians. The appointments enable faculty to take an active role in each student's clinical education. 3. CLEVELAND HEARING AND SPEECH CENTER DEPARTMENT DIRECTORS: Directors of Audiology and Speech/Language Pathology help develop the schedule of all Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center clinical assignments, and serve as coordinators of education within their respective departments. They hold clinical appointments in the Department of Communication Sciences. 4. CLINICAL SUPERVISORS: Clinical Instructors have broad academic and clinical bases in the area of communication disorders, as well as special areas of expertise and interest, which qualify them to educate students. Clinical education, like all teaching/learning paradigms, requires the involvement of both the instructor and the student. The clinical instruction process is characterized by exchanges between the instructor and student and is highly interactive in nature. The skills listed here could be extended almost indefinitely since the role of Clinical Supervisor is a complex one. However, the general skill requirements for Clinical Supervisors include the ability to: a. Assist the student in development of appropriate assessment, management, and treatment programs. b. Serve as a resource person for the student requiring specialized knowledge related to a communication disorder. c. Utilize a variety of instructional/supervision methods (audio- and/or video recordings, group and/or individual conference staffings, self evaluation, peer evaluation) to assist the student in developing and refining clinical skills through a supportive learning environment. d. Observe, record, analyze and evaluate the student's clinical skills and share this information in a direct manner with the student, CHSC Department Directors, the Coordinator of Clinical Education, and the Faculty. There are two categories of Clinical Instructor appointments within the Department of Communication Sciences: a. Clinical Instructors: Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center (CHSC). The major affiliation for clinical education is with Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center. Members of the professional staff of CHSC hold appointments as Clinical Instructors in the Department of Communication Sciences at Case Western Reserve University. They are responsible for direct instruction in the student's clinical education experience. The professional staff of the CHSC may hold appointments as Adjunct Clinical Instructors at Case Western Reserve University. b. Adjunct Clinical Instructors: ASHA requires that students receive education at two or more externship sites in addition to their primary clinical education facility. Instructors at externship locations may hold appointments as Adjunct Clinical Instructors. Their responsibilities are also to provide direct instruction in the student's clinical education experience. CLINICAL FACILITIES Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center The Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center is the primary clinical educational site for Audiology and SpeechLanguage Pathology. The Department of Communication Sciences is committed to assisting CHSC in providing quality clinical services that involve student intern participation. The personnel and facilities of the CHSC provide exceptional clinical experiences for students. The professional staff are vitally involved in the clinical education of students seeking clinical certification in Speech-Language Pathology. Clinical services at the Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center include: A. Speech-Language Pathology 1. In-house Diagnosis and Treatment of: Speech Production Disorders-- Articulation Disorders, Phonological Disorders, Voice Disorders Foreign Accent Reduction, and Fluency Disorders Developmental Language Disorders Language-Learning Disabilities Aural Rehabilitation Services Augmentative/Alternative Communication (AAC) Neurogenic Language Disorders----Aphasia, Dysarthria, Apraxia Structural/Neurologic Disorders: Craniofacial Anomalies, Laryngectomy, Brain Injury, and Neurologic Disease 2. Contracted Services throughout the greater Cleveland area-Provide diagnostic and treatment services in community settings. Sites include HeadStart programs, Day Care Centers, Private Elementary, and Secondary Schools. 3. Audiology Comprehensive Audiologic Evaluation Otoacoustic Emissions Testing Hearing Aid Services including consultation Hearing Aid Fitting and Repairing Aural Rehabilitation Hearing Conservation Programs Hearing Screening Case Reviews CHSC Clinical Forms Students participating in practicum assignments with CHSC staff will utilize forms and procedures described in the Policies and Procedures Manual of the Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center. Clinic supervisors will review procedures which are relevant to the caseload being covered by the student’s assignment. Appendix E includes copies of CHSC forms (treatment plan/progress report, diagnostic reports, SOAP note procedures). Diagnostic and Therapy Materials The COSI Department has a collection of diagnostic and intervention materials (assessment tools stored in Room 401 and toys stored in Room 415B (See Appendix G for a list). Materials must be returned within a three-hour period. Students may also use the diagnostic and therapy materials of the CHSC when working with CHSC clients. Materials must be checked out through a CHSC staff member (who has a key). Check out materials by signing your name and the name of your supervisor as follows: CHSC PEDIATRIC MATERIALS ROOM PROCEDURES GRADUATE STUDENTS Check out: 1. Sign out all materials on the white bulletin board/sign out sheet. and date/time checked out. 2. List your name, the name of the clinician who is supervising you, the name of the material, and date/time checked out. For Check-in: 1. Note date returned on the right side of your name. 2. Cross out your name. 3. Return item(s) to their correct location on shelves. The therapy materials room is located on the second floor in Room 204. Pediatric and adult diagnostic materials are housed in Room 205. A listing of CHSC Diagnostic materials appears in AppendixG. It is imperative that you sign out materials as described above. The adult materials sign-out sheet is located on the door of the room. MATERIALS MUST BE RETURNED TO THEIR APPROPRIATE LOCATION BY THE END OF THE DAY. Remember that the use of these materials is a privilege. Materials cannot be checked out overnight unless approved by a CHSC clinician. Overnight materials can be taken after 4:30 and MUST be returned by 8:30 the next morning. MATERIALS IN PEDIATRIC MATERIALS ROOM (ROOM 204) and Room 205 Organization of materials: Room 204: 1. All toys/objects are located on the shelves (including script kits, dolls, etc. on the back wall and the right-hand side of the room). Shelves are labeled and items should be returned to their appropriate location. 2. Intervention materials are on the shelves. They are organized by topics (i.e., infant; reading; writing). Please return items to their correct location. phonology/arctic; voice; Room 205: 1. The file cabinet with diagnostic forms has been reinstituted. Forms are filed in alphabetical order. DO NOT TAKE THE LAST FORM!. Each test has 1 form (for Xeroxing only) in the file. Please do not use the forms in the test box/kit. 2. Diagnostic materials are filed alphabetically on the shelves. Please return to the appropriate location when you have finished with the materials. Externship Sites After students have completed approximately 100 clinical hours of service under the supervision of Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center Clinical Instructors they may begin their externship assignments. ASHA requires that during a student’s clinical training they participate in at least three different types of settings (each for a minimum of 50 hours each) The COSI Department draws upon clinical resources in University Circle and the Greater Cleveland Area offering students a diversity of settings to select from. The following facilities are among those that serve as externship sites for clinical education: Clinical Education Facility (Type of Setting) Achievement Center for Children (Center-based early intervention) Diagnosis and remediation of speech and language problems of 0-5 population in a multidisciplinary team setting. Akron City Hospital Diagnosis and treatment for pediatric, inpatient, rehabilitation, outpatient, and craniofacial team. Berea, Cleveland, Cleveland Heights, East Cleveland, Euclid, Lakewood, Mayfield, Positive Education Program (PEP), Shaker Heights, and University Heights Boards of Education (Public School) Diagnosis and remediation of speech, language, and language and learning problems in public school setting; and aural rehabilitation opportunities. Cleveland Clinic Center for Autism Outpatient treatment for children with autism Cleveland Veteran's Medical Center (Acute care; outpatient center) Diagnosis and remediation of communication disorders with special attention to effects of drugs on communication and knowledge of medical terminology. Cuyahoga County Board of Mental Retardation (Center-based and home-based early intervention; vocational setting for adults) Diagnosis and remediation of children and adults with with mental retardation at schools and sheltered workshop settings and in home-based services for 0-3 years. Deepwood Center/CLEO Lake Count Board of Mental Retardation & Developmental Disability Assessment and treatment therapy of adults with MR in homes and sheltered workshops. Grace Hospital (rehab setting) Specialty in patient with vents and/or tracheostomies. Harborside Healthcare (Skilled Nursing Facility) Diagnosis and treatment of adult neurogenic patients in a skilled nursing setting Health Hill (rehab setting) Inpatient and outpatient rehabilitation of medically-fragile children with communication disorders in a team setting. Heather Hill (rehab setting) Rehabilitation of adults with Aphasia and closed-head injuries in a team-based setting. Lakewood Hospital Inpatient and outpatient services for adults and children with varying communication disorders. Manor Care Diagnosis and treatment of adult neurogenic patients in a skilled nursing facility. Menorah Park (skilled nursing facility) Meridia Euclid Hospital Range of supported living options, speech-language screenings, evaluations and therapy services. Diagnosis and treatment therapy of adults with varying communication disorders in acute, sub-acute, and skilled nursing settings. MetroHealth Medical Center (outpatient clinic) Diagnosis and remediation of speech, language, and hearing disorders and a comprehensive program for extended rehabilitation of brain injured clients. Parma Community Hospital (Outpatient & inpatient comm. Hosp) Inpatient and outpatient services for adults and children with varying communication disorders. Rainbow Babies & Children's Hospital (outpatient rehab) Assessment and treatment of infants, toddlers, and preschoolers with varying communication disorders. RoseMary Center (school setting) Rehabilitation of children and young adults with severe to profound mental retardation and multiple handicaps. Southwest General Hospital Diagnosis and remediation of speech, language, and hearing (inpatient & outpatient community hospital) disorders in children and adults in in-patient & out-patient settings. University Hospitals of Cleveland (acute care) Diagnosis and treatment of hearing and communication problems in adult neurogenic and ENT patients. University Mednet Diagnosis and treatment therapy of children and adults with varying communication disorders in an outpatient setting. APPENDIX A: CLINICAL DOCUMENTATION FORMS These forms are to be used for your documentation of clinical hours for COSI 452 and observation hours for COSI 352. INSTRUCTIONS: • • • • • Complete the practicum log after each session to track your hours. Complete the Ohio Board of Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology hours sheet each semester and have your supervisor sign the hours that you attained over the course of the semester. ONLY ONE SHEET SHOULD BE USED OVER THE COURSE OF YOUR ACADEMIC/CLINICAL PROGRAM. Each semester/supervisor should fill one line only. See example. Hours should be calculated to the nearest quarter hour (e.g. 10.25, 10.5, 10.75) Ohio Board of Speech-Language Pathology hours sheet should be returned to the Department Assistant after review by the Coordinator of Clinical Education. Students may copy their hours sheet every semester for their records, however the original hours sheet should be kept in the student’s permanent file in the Department Office. PRACTICUM LOG SEMESTER STUDENT NOTE DURATION OF TIME SPENT: .25, .50, .75, 1.0 etc. (hrs) DATE SURPV AD/CH SPEECH Diag Tx LANG Diag Tx AUD/AR DESCRIPTION/CLIENT SUMMARY OF CLINICAL OBSERVATIONS UNDERGRADUATE PRACTICUM STUDENT: DATE TIME SPENT (.25, .50, .75, 1.0 hours) TOTAL NUMBER OF HOURS BSERVED THIS PAGE: TOTAL NUMBER OF HOURS OBSERVED: CLINICIAN SIGNATURE AND LICENSE NUMBER CLIENT AGE LEVEL HOURS (COMPLETE ON LAST PAGE ONLY) DISORDER TYPE APPENDIX B: COSI 452 CLINICAL PRACTICUM ASSIGNMENTS INSTRUCTIONS FOR INITIAL CASE MANAGEMENT: CHSC ASSIGNMENTS This form is designed to help students plan for their first supervisory conference, and the first session of therapy and should be completed by the student prior to the first supervisory conference. Instructions 1. Check out your client’s case file from the front desk in the lobby. Fill out a Records Retrieval form with you name and your supervisor’s name. The case file will be placed in your supervisor’s mailbox. Read this file thoroughly and return it to the Records Room mailbox within 24 hours. You may complete case summaries in the graduate carrel room. Under no circumstance is a case file to leave the Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center. Violation of this rule will result in an automatic grade reduction of one letter grade for the semester. 2. Complete the Summary of Case Management side of the form from information that may be obtained through thorough review of past therapy reports, diagnostic reports, reports from other professionals, and case history information. Summarize the data that you collect. Think about the factors (e.g. cognitive, audiological, environmental etc.) that are contributing to the client’s current communication status. Record these factors on your form in the appropriate spaces. Record the client’s current communication skills on the form in the appropriate categories. This information should include, but is not limited to, testing information (i.e. standard scores and percentiles) from the previous semester report. Statements regarding the severity of the client’s disorder should also be noted (i.e. mild, moderate, severe, profound). 3. Prior to completing the reverse side of the form entitled “Assessment Plan”, think about what you now know and what you do not yet know about this client. What additional questions/measures are needed in order to have a more complete knowledge about the client? How do you plan to get this information? (e.g. standardized testing, stimulability testing, etc.) List these items/ideas/instruments on your Assessment Plan side of the form, in the appropriate categories. What are possible goals for intervention? 4. Be prepared to discuss this information in an organized manner during your first conference with your supervisor. 5. Following formulation of client goals, a treatment hierarchy should be written for each goal. This hierarchy should be used to help guide your lesson planning. Examples of hierarchies may be found in theGoldberg text (on reserve in room 414) in addition to the example in this section. 6. Clinicians/supervisors should familiarize themselves with evidence based practices and apply them to clinical practice consistent with ASHA guidelines (see following section on Evidence Based Practices). Also see ASHA Preferred Practice Guidelines and Knowledge and Skills documents available on ASHA website (www.asha.org) for more information. 6. Learning Outcomes for all CHSC assignments are located in Appendix D. 7. Clinical forms are located in Appendix E. Evidence-Based Practice Evidence-based practice entails the use of current best research results to make clinical decisions about patient care. Based on the evidence from a comprehensive literature search and review of published research studies, practice guidelines are developed to assist clinicians and patients in choosing the appropriate care for specific conditions. Guidelines are designed to address a specific issue in areas such as screening, diagnosis, or treatment. Ideally, they should be: • Systematic • Logical • Defensible • Practical • Feasible • Understandable • Include both clinician and patient in the decision-making Evidence-Based Practice: Practice Guidelines The current emphasis on developing practice guidelines in all healthcare fields, including speech-language pathology and audiology, has evolved naturally from a historical emphasis on treatment efficacy . To be efficacious, a procedure must provide a benefit to the intended population under ideal circumstances. In contrast, a procedure may be deemed effective if the intended population benefits from the procedure under average or typical conditions. Practice guidelines are developed from the systematic review of efficacy research in a particular area. The development of practice guidelines came into full-swing in the early 1990s when the first practice guideline was funded by the Agency for Health Care Policy and Research (AHCPR), now the Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality (AHRQ, www.ahrq.gov ). Previously completed guidelines can be accessed on the National Guidelines Clearinghouse web site at www.guideline.gov/index.asp . In addition to practice guidelines, AHRQ also funds the development of Evidence Reports, which are a summary of research evidence within a particular field or area of study, and Technology Assessments, which review the risks, benefits, and clinical effectiveness of current technological interventions. It is important to note that AHRQ reports and guidelines have not been uniformly accepted in the clinical and medical fields. ASHA has expressed concerns, for example, about the limitations of focusing on only one population in the dysphagia evidence report and studying only the value of dysphagia services in the prevention of aspiration, to the exclusion of other equally serious outcomes of swallowing problems. Read the complete summary of ASHA’s response to the AHCPR Dysphagia report. Increased interest in the development and use of practice guidelines has been the result of increased accessibility to published research, particularly via the Internet, a need for improved services and outcomes, and reimbursement policy changes. Practice guidelines provide many benefits to clinicians, patients, and lawmakers in that they can help to increase the quality of services provided, diminish variations in practice, help identify cost-effective strategies, prevent unfounded practices, and highlight research needs. Policymakers, payers, and patients can then justify the cost of and improve access to quality care. Levels of Evidence Typically, research evidence is rated or classified according to levels based on the type of research completed and the research design quality. The following is an example of a research classification system: • Class I evidence comes from at least one well-designed, randomized controlled clinical trial • Class II evidence is from at least one well-designed observational, clinical study with concurrent controls • Class III evidence is provided by expert opinion, case studies, and studies with historical controls Practice Guidelines are developed using a classification system such as the one described above. It is important to note that guidelines differ from Practice Standards and Practice Options. These differences include: • Standards are accepted principles of patient care based on a high degree of certainty and Class I or strong Class II evidence. • Guidelines reflect a moderate degree of certainty, are not fixed protocols or rigid treatment rules, and are typically based on Class II evidence. • Options are possible treatment strategies, but are based on limited certainty or conflicting evidence or opinion. In some arenas, the strict adherence to levels of evidence is problematic. For example, in the area of neurologic communication disorders, it may be difficult to find a large enough group of subjects with a particular disorder to complete a randomized controlled trial (often the preferred type of study). Some advocate for an approach to the available literature that allows for review of the relationship of intervention and outcome when direct evidence is not available. The American Psychological Association developed a series of questions to ask when considering the merits of research. These questions include: • How well are the subjects described? • How well is the treatment described? • What measures of control are imposed in the study? • Are the consequences of the intervention well described? Literature Review Sites and EBP Tools Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality (AHRQ) www.ahrq.gov American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA) • ASHA Journal Online • Treatment Efficacy Bibliography ASHA’s National Center for Treatment Effectiveness in Communication Disorders • "Evidence-Based Practice: The Marriage of Research and Clinical Services." ASHA Leader article by Kenn Apel and Trisha Self, September 9, 2003. ERIC www.eric.ed.gov PubMed www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/PubMed The Cochrane Collaboration www.cochrane.org American College of Physicians Journal Club www.acpjc.org Combined Health Information Database (CHID) online www.chid.nih.gov REHABDATA www.naric.com/search/rhab elibrary www.ask.elibrary.com Ingenta www.ingenta.com Free Medical Journals Site www.freemedicaljournals.com ProQuest Digital Dissertations www.lib.umf.com/dissertations/ National Institute on Deafness and Other Communication Disorders (NIDCD) www.nidcd.nih.gov VA Audiology and Speech Pathology Service Field Advisory Council Evidence-Based Treatment Outcomes in Aphasia www.washington.med.va.gov/audio-speech/aphasia.doc Bandolier www.jr2.ox.ac.uk/bandolier/ Clinical Evidence, BMJ Publishing Group www.clinicalevidence.org Evidence-Based Practice Newsletter www.ebponline.net Health Sciences Library at the University of North Carolina www.hsl.unc.edu/visitors.cfm Research Navigator www.ablongman.com/researchnavigator The Communication Disorders Dome www.comdisdome.com Evidence-Based Practice Myths and Realities cite as: Dollaghan, C. (2004, April 13). Evidence-based practice myths and realities. The ASHA Leader, pp. 12. by Christine Dollaghan How do you feel when you hear the words "evidence-based practice" or "EBP"? In talking about EBP with clinicians, colleagues, and students during the past few years, I've seen reactions ranging from euphoria (admittedly rare) to outrage (thankfully also rare). The most common feeling, however, seems to be a mixture of curiosity and anxiety: curiosity about the reasons for the "buzz" about EBP, and anxiety over the possibility that EBP will turn out to be just one more unrealistic demand placed on already over-burdened professionals. By a brief description of some of the myths and realities of EBP, I hope to encourage the "EBP-curious" to feel considerably more confident about what this perspective on clinical decision-making can offer to those willing to keep both euphoria and outrage at bay. Myths and Definitions By now, most people are familiar with the definition of EBP as ". . .the conscientious, explicit, and judicious use of current best evidence in making decisions about the care of individual patients . . . [by] integrating individual clinical expertise with the best available external clinical evidence from systematic research" (Sackett et al., 1996). However, some parts of this definition ("best available external clinical evidence from systematic research") seem to get a lot more attention than others ("individual clinical experience"). So the first myth about EBP that needs to be dispelled is the idea that evidence from systematic research is the only acceptable basis for clinical decision-making. As Guyatt and colleagues (2000) note, "evidence is never enough;" the EBP framework acknowledges that the experiences, values, and preferences of ourselves and our patients can and should contribute to our clinical decisions. EBP does require us, however, to identify and make use of the highest quality scientific evidence as one component of our efforts to provide optimal patient care. Unfortunately, this worthy goal is linked to another myth about EBP: namely, that it requires clinicians to spend hours each week scouring the hundreds of newly published articles and textbooks for nuggets of evidence "gold." No practitioner has the time and few have either the inclination or the expertise for such a task. Instead, proponents of EBP (e.g., Sackett et al., 2000) suggest several strategies by which clinicians can find the relatively rare evidence that is of sufficient quality to influence clinical practice, while at the same time ignoring, or better yet avoiding altogether, the deluge of weaker evidence. These authors suggest that practitioners are likely to have no more than 30 minutes per week to devote to locating and evaluating evidence; thus, their suggestions are oriented around this minimal time investment. One of their suggestions is that practitioners focus their limited time on evidence from "high-yield" sources. Such sources contain evidence that is current, of high quality (according to the criteria described below), and directly applicable to clinical practice. Sackett et al. (2000; 1999) urge us to examine journals and evidence compilers such as those described below to identify the one(s) most likely to contain quality evidence, and to limit ourselves to these rather than devoting time to low-yield and/or dated sources such as traditional textbooks and journals oriented to "basic science." The de-emphasis in EBP on evidence sources that are difficult to update rapidly, such as traditional textbooks, derives from the explicit acknowledgment that what we "know" at any point is virtually guaranteed to change as science progresses, so our efforts to identify current best evidence should focus on the most contemporary sources. Similarly, the EBP orientation disavows the longstanding belief that all basic science findings are relevant to clinical practice. The goals, designs, and methods of studies aimed at providing strong answers to questions about clinical practice are in some respects quite different from those of studies aimed at understanding basic mechanisms of disease. In the EBP framework, evidence from studies of basic mechanisms plays a similar role to evidence derived from personal experience or the opinions of authorities; all of these sources can provide fruitful "leads," but these must be followed up in subsequent studies explicitly designed to address questions about clinical practice. Internet access to high-yield sources and sites exponentially decreases the time needed to locate current best evidence. For example, www.guideline.gov, a free resource sponsored by the Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality, provides a compilation of evidence reviews and practice guidelines published by a variety of groups on a wide range of topics. Clinicians can search the Web site for information on specific topics or browse for guidelines in category headings. Although the bulk of information concerns medical conditions, the site contains a number of guidelines on such topics as hearing screening, autism, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, learning disorders, and others, providing busy practitioners with rapid access to a synthesis of information on screening, diagnosis, treatment, and prognosis. Individuals can also register to receive free weekly e-mail updates listing new or revised guidelines, and those of interest can be accessed in a matter of seconds. Similarly, PubMed (www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov) is a free site sponsored by the National Library of Medicine, in which users can search for specific information from among literally millions of biomedical and other life science citations, and in many cases, the complete article can be accessed online. The PubMed site has a number of extraordinarily helpful features, such as a "cubby" in which an individual user can store results from previous searches and ask "what's new" on that topic at a later date, again in a matter of seconds. PubMed also has a "clinical query" search, specifically designed to allow searches concerning diagnosis, therapy, etiology, and prognosis for a given condition using research methodology filters that increase the likelihood that results will be directly relevant to clinical practice. Finally, sites such as the Cochrane Library (www.updatesoftware.com/cochrane) develop and report systematic evidence reviews on a wide range of topics. These abstracts are available at no charge. The availability of millions of articles and tens of sites containing evidence makes it easy to debunk a third myth about EBP: namely, that clinicians can or should be able to "stay current" on every aspect of clinical practice at all times. Instead, Sackett et al. (2000) assert that we seek evidence mainly when we have specific questions about specific patients, disorders, or procedures. Formulating a specific question (e.g., "Compared to direct, clinician-administered therapy, are parent-administered programs effective treatments for 3-year-olds with specific language deficits?") makes it much easier to zero in on what will usually be a relatively small set of articles. These can then be scanned rapidly to determine whether their quality appears sufficiently high to warrant a full reading. Day-to-day clinical activity will often proceed on the basis of our existing knowledge and experience; EBP implies not that we upend everything that we think we know, but rather that we upgrade our knowledge base in response to particular clinical questions in the explicit, judicious, and conscientious manner described in the definition of EBP. Critical Appraisal Evaluating evidence quality depends on a process of critical appraisal, which has been described by a number of authors working in EBP but has been applied only rarely in the literature on communication disorders (e.g., Yorkston et al., 2001). A myth about critical appraisal is that only people who have completed years of specialized study can do it. In fact, Sackett et al. (2000) describe critical appraisal in some detail, and worksheets for evaluating systematic reviews and articles concerning studies of diagnosis, treatment, prognosis, and harm can be found in the section titled "Teaching Materials" at www.cebm.utoronto.ca. Some of the criteria will be familiar to clinicians (e.g., Were there statistically significant differences between treated and untreated groups? Were the outcome measures valid and reliable?) but others are less familiar, being more specifically tied to studies addressing clinical questions (e.g., Were patients assigned randomly to groups? Were evaluators blinded to group assignment? Were the group differences large or practically significant?). The many excellent sources of accessible information on critical appraisal, including clear and concise self-tutorials (e.g., at www.poems.msu.edu/InfoMastery) make it possible for interested individuals to learn to evaluate evidence quality at whatever level of intensity or commitment they choose. Familiarity with the process of critical appraisal allows us to reject the myth that studies with certain designs, in particular randomized controlled trials (RCTs) of treatment, always provide high quality evidence. Like any other type of study, RCTs can be designed and conducted well or poorly; only those studies that meet the critical appraisal criteria can yield strong evidence concerning treatment. By applying the critical appraisal criteria, we identify the strengths and weaknesses in all kinds of studies, providing a principled basis for resolving disagreements about the optimal approaches to client care. Because few studies meet all of the critical appraisal criteria, reasonable people can disagree about the quality of evidence from a particular study, making it important for individuals to think independently about the validity, importance, and precision of results from empirical studies as a prelude to applying them to clinical care. In reality, EBP is neither the panacea nor the bugaboo that its mythology has suggested. Rather, EBP offers us a framework and a set of tools by which we can systematically improve in our efforts to be better clinicians, colleagues, advocates, and investigators-not by ignoring clinical experience and patient preferences but rather by considering these against a background of the highest quality scientific evidence that can be found. SEMESTER OUTLINE OF REQUIREMENTS FOR CHSC SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY PRACTICUM PLACEMENTS Please place a check before each item when completed: _____ 1. Summary of Case Management (Initial Meeting). _____ Clinical contracts should be signed at this time. _____ 2. Baseline Data Collection (By 2nd therapy session). _____ 3. Treatment Plan (signed following 4th therapy session). _____ 4. Treatment Hierarchy (by 5th therapy session). _____ 5. Midterm Grade (on or about 8th week of semester; on or about 4th-5th week of summer session). _____ 6. Progress component of treatment plan according to client schedule. _____ 7. Research article summary. _____ 8. Final grade (last week of semester or finals week). _____ Supervisor evaluations completed at this time. Copies of the following forms should be turned into the Coordinator of Clinical Education: • • • • Clinical Contract Mid-term Grading Form Final Grading Form Supervisor Evaluation Form Guidelines • Admission/Discharge Criteria in Speech-Language Guidelines Pathology 2004 - 65 Admission/Discharge Criteria in SpeechLanguage Pathology Ad Hoc Committee on Admission/Discharge Criteria in Speech-Language Pathology This guideline document is an official statement of the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA). The ASHA Scope of Practice states that the practice of speechlanguage pathology includes making admission and discharge decisions. The ASHA Preferred Practice Patterns are statements that define universally applicable characteristics of speech-language pathology practice. The guidelines within this document fulfill the need for more specific procedures and protocols for serving individuals with speech, language, communication, or feeding and swallowing disorders across all settings. It is required that individuals who practice independently in this area hold the Certificate of Clinical Competence in Speech-Language Pathology and abide by the ASHA Code of Ethics, including Principle of Ethics II Rule B, which states: “Individuals shall engage in only those aspects of the professions that are within the scope of their competence, considering their level of education, training, and experience.” updated to reflect current research and preferred practice. These guidelines were approved by ASHA’s Legislative Council in March 2003. Executive Summary Admission and discharge criteria originally were prepared by the Ad Hoc Committee on Admission/Discharge Criteria in Speech-Language Pathology: Evie Hagerman, chair; Sandra Bennett; Douglas Duguay; Sara JonesMcNamara; Noma LeMoine; Rita Marshall; and Michelle Ferketic, ex officio. Crystal Cooper, 1994–1996 vice president for professional practices in speech-language pathology, and Diane Eger, 1991–1993 vice president for professional practices, served as monitoring vice presidents. The criteria were approved as a technical report by the Executive Board in October 1994. In 2002, with input from the National Joint Committee for the Communication Needs of Persons With Severe Disabilities (NJC)1, the criteria were The ASHA Admission/Discharge Criteria in Speech Language Pathology document was developed to provide general factors for speech-language pathologists to consider when making admission and discharge decisions across practice settings and clinical populations. The criteria were designed as a basis for developing program-specific admission and discharge criteria for children and adults with various speech, language, communication, and feeding and swallowing disorders. ASHA originally published admission/discharge criteria in 1994. These criteria were revised to reflect current research and clinical practice in order to ensure that communication services and supports are provided to all individuals in need. One concern prompting the update of the criteria is that cognitive referencing (i.e., referencing scores on language measures to scores on cognitive measures) was being used to deny speech and language services. Contemporary research and practice question the use of a language/cognitive discrepancy as a criterion for admission or discharge because individuals with similar language and cognitive levels or without certain cognitive skills may still make progress with appropriate communication intervention. Therefore, cognitive referencing is not one of the criteria for admission or discharge in the revised document. Reference this material as: American Speech-LanguageHearing Association. (2004). Admission/discharge criteria in speech-language pathology. ASHA Supplement 24, 65–70. Index terms: admission criteria, SLP; discharge criteria, SLP; eligibility for admission, discharge; referral; entrance criteria; exit criteria. Document type: guidelines The admission criteria are factors that indicate eligibility or the need for further assessment to determine the need for treatment. Discharge criteria present situations when a speech, language, communication, or feeding and swallowing disorder is remedied; when compensatory strategies are successfully established; when the individual or family chooses not to participate in treatment, relocates, or seeks another provider. It is the clinician’s ethical responsibility to review and analyze all aspects of past services in order to identify 66 - 2004 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association specific modification(s) that have the greatest probability of yielding improved outcomes and then implement those improvements with ongoing monitoring. A flow chart depicts the sequence to follow when treatment no longer results in measurable benefits and discharge is being considered (see Figure 1). ASHA developed general admission/discharge criteria to help speech-language pathologists identify patients/clients for treatment; to provide accrediting agency reviewers with information to evaluate service delivery and patient/client management; to assist government agencies, third-party payers, or school districts in the development of regulations and health care reform plans; to provide educators with information about appropriate candidates for speech-language pathology services; and to provide information for consumer education. Background Speech-language pathologists are frequently asked to provide admission and discharge criteria2 for persons with speech, language, communication, and feeding and swallowing disorders to school and health care administrators, third-party payers, and accrediting and regulatory agencies. Determining these criteria is a complex process that is influenced by many clinical and administrative factors, including the etiology, severity, and prognosis of the disorder, and any regulations imposed by federal, state, and local government, accrediting organizations, and education agencies. In all cases, admission and discharge decisions should be consistent with the ethical practices described in the current ASHA Code of Ethics (ASHA, 2003). ASHA previously addressed the development of admission and discharge criteria. The document, Issues in Determining Eligibility for Language Intervention, prepared by the former Committee on Language Learning Disorders, focused on economic, administrative, and political issues related to the eligibility requirements of children for language services (ASHA, 1989). Many of these same issues influence the admission of children and adults for speech, language, communication, feeding and swallowing services. Further, the former ASHA Professional Services Board (PSB) required accredited programs to follow established policies and procedures for patient/client admission, discharge, and follow-up (ASHA, 1992). In August 1992, ASHA established the Ad Hoc Committee on Admission/Discharge Criteria to develop a report that would guide speech-language pathologists in developing program-specific admission and discharge criteria for various ages and communi- cation disabilities seen across the spectrum of service delivery settings. Recognizing the range of professional services and practice settings and the diversity of clinical populations addressed by speech-language pathologists, the Committee identified factors that could be used as a basis for developing admission and discharge criteria. The Committee determined that it was neither feasible—given the established time frame—nor advisable to develop prescriptive criteria to replace existing individual program criteria. The identified factors are general so they are applicable to all practice settings and clinical populations. The original Committee obtained and reviewed existing admission and discharge criteria from various speech-language pathology service delivery programs. The Committee also reviewed the areas of practice for speech-language pathologists, the expected outcomes, and the clinical indicators identified in ASHA’s original version of the Preferred Practice Patterns for the Professions of Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology (ASHA, 1993) to develop the criteria. In 2002, the criteria were updated to reflect the new and revised speech-language pathology practice policies approved since 1994, including the Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology (ASHA, 2001), the Preferred Practice Patterns for the Profession of Speech-Language Pathology (ASHA, 1997), and the new position statement and supporting documentation entitled Access to Communication Services and Supports: Concerns Regarding the Application of Restrictive “Eligibility” Policies (NJC, 2002; approved by ASHA in June, 2002). A related resource is ASHA’s Guidelines for Referral to Speech-Language Pathologists (ASHA, 1998). The referral guidelines were developed to help educate potential referral sources (e.g., case managers, consumers, physicians) about the scope of practice of speech-language pathologists. Referral is often the initiating event leading to admission to speech-language pathology services across settings. Awareness of these referral guidelines may help to increase timely and appropriate use of these services. A major reason prompting the revision of the 1994 admissions and discharge criteria was a concern that statements in the report could lead to inappropriate denial of communication services and support to those individuals in need. Specifically, the report included as a criterion for admission that “The individual’s communication abilities are not commensurate with his or her developmental abilities,” and a criterion for discharge that, “The individual’s communication abilities are commensurate with developmental abilities.” However, the use of “cognitive referencing” or a language/cognitive discrepancy as a means of diagnosing language impairment has been seriously ques- Guidelines • Admission/Discharge Criteria in Speech-Language Pathology tioned (see summary in ASHA, 1996). Nelson (1996) indicates that cognitive referencing means that “scores on measures of language development are referenced to scores on measures of cognitive development for the purpose of determining who is eligible for language intervention services” (pp. 3-4). Problems cited in the literature with using cognitive referencing for eligibility decisions include measurement concerns (e.g., measurement error, test reliability, individual variability, and cultural and linguistic assessment bias), theoretical concerns about the relationship between cognition and language (e.g., language may exceed cognitive level), and lack of empirical support for the use of cognitive referencing (see Casby, 1996; Cole, 1996; Lahey, 1996; Terrell, 1996). In fact, individuals with similar language and cognitive levels or without certain cognitive skills may still make progress with appropriate communication intervention (NJC, 2002). The NJC position statement was written in response to concerns that communication supports and services were being denied to those in need based on restrictive and inappropriate eligibility criteria. The statement and accompanying documentation (NJC, 2002) emphasize that eligibility criteria should be based on individual and functional needs rather than on a priori criteria such as discrepancies between cognitive and communication functioning and absence of cognitive skills purported to be prerequisites. Based on recent research findings and contemporary policy statements, the revised criteria do not use cognitive referencing as a basis for admission or discharge. Admission to Speech-Language Pathology Services In general, individuals of all ages are eligible for speech-language pathology services when their ability to communicate and/or swallow effectively is reduced or impaired or when there is reason to believe (e.g., risk factors) that treatment will prevent the development of a speech, language, communication, or feeding and swallowing disorder; reduce the degree of impairment; lead to improved functional communication skills and/or functional feeding and swallowing abilities; or prevent the decline of communication, and/or swallowing abilities. The decision to admit an individual to speech-language pathology services in a school, health care, or other setting must be made in conjunction with the individual and family3 or designated guardian, as appropriate. Listed below are factors that indicate eligibility or the need for further assessment of a person’s communication or feeding and swallowing abilities to determine the need for treatment. Eligibility for services or for evaluation is indicated if one or more of these factors is present: 2004 - 67 1. Referral from the individual, family member, audiologist, physician, teacher, other speechlanguage pathologist, or team (e.g., interdisciplinary, educational management) because of a suspected speech, language, communication, or feeding and swallowing disorder. 2. Failure to pass a screening assessment for communication and/or swallowing function. 3. The individual is unable to communicate functionally or optimally across environments and communication partners. 4. The individual is unable to swallow to maintain adequate nutrition, hydration, and pulmonary status and/or the swallow is inadequate for management of oral and pharyngeal saliva accumulations. 5. The presence of a communication and/or swallowing disorder has been verified through an evaluation by an ASHA-certified speech-language pathologist. 6. The individual’s communication abilities are not comparable to those of others of the same chronological age, gender, ethnicity, or cultural and linguistic background. 7. The individual’s communication skills negatively affect educational, social, emotional, or vocational performance, or health or safety status. 8. The individual’s swallowing skills negatively affect his or her nutritional health or safety status. 9. The individual, family, and/or guardian seeks services to achieve and/or maintain optimal communication (including alternative and augmentative means of communication), and/or swallowing skills. 10. The individual, family, and/or guardian seeks services to enhance communication skills. Discharge From Speech-Language Pathology Services Patient/client discharge from treatment ideally occurs when the individual, family, or designated guardian, and speech-language pathologist as a team conclude that the communication or feeding and swallowing disorder is remediated or when compensatory strategies are successfully established, as in the following situations: 1. The speech, language, communication, or feeding and swallowing disorder is now de- 68 - 2004 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association fined within normal limits or is now consistent with the individual’s premorbid status. The goals and objectives of treatment have been met. The individual’s communication abilities have become comparable to those of others of the same chronological age, gender, ethnicity, or cultural and linguistic background. The individual’s speech, language, communication, and/or feeding and swallowing skills no longer adversely affect the individual’s educational, social, emotional, vocational performance, or health status. The individual who uses an augmentative or alternative communication system has achieved optimal communication across environments and communication partners. The individual’s nutritional and hydration needs are optimally met by alternative means (e.g., percutaneous endoscopic gastrostomy), and swallow is adequate for management of oral and pharyngeal saliva accumulations. The individual has attained the desired level of enhanced communication skills. In some situations, the individual, family, or designated guardian may choose not to participate in treatment, may relocate, or may seek another provider if the therapeutic relationship is not satisfactory. Therefore, discharge is also appropriate in the following situations, provided that the patient/client, family, and/ or guardian have been advised of the likely outcomes of discontinuation. 8. The individual is unwilling to participate in treatment; treatment attendance has been inconsistent or poor, and efforts to address these factors have not been successful. 9. The individual, family, and/or guardian requests to be discharged or requests continuation of services with another provider. 10. The individual is transferred or discharged to another location where ongoing service from the current provider is not reasonably available. Efforts should be made to ensure continuation of services in the new locale. When considering discharge in situations other than those described above, it is the clinician’s ethical responsibility to review and analyze all aspects of past services in order to identify specific modification(s) that have the greatest probability of yielding improved outcomes and then implement those improvements with ongoing monitoring.4 The flow chart depicts the sequence to follow when treatment no longer results in measurable benefits and discharge is being considered (see Figure 1). Specifically, the clinician should insure that the following factors have been addressed: (a) appropriate intervention goals and objectives were specified; (b) sufficient instructional time was provided; (c) current and suitable intervention methods or materials were used; (d) meaningful and functional performance data were collected and analyzed on an ongoing basis to monitor and evaluate progress; (e) appropriate assistive technology or other technology supports were provided, when necessary; (f) a plan to address the needs and concerns of culturally/linguistically diverse families (e.g., use of interpreter or translator) as they affect participation in communication services was designed and implemented (ASHA, 1983); (g) relevant and accurate criteria were used to evaluate intervention; and (h) health, educational, environmental, or other supports relevant to communication interventions were provided. In addition, when provision of treatment that includes all of these factors is beyond the expertise of an individual clinician or the clinician’s recommendations are not acceptable to the individual, referral to professionals with specific expertise in the area of concern should be made prior to discharge. Situations relevant to the criteria include the following: 11. Treatment no longer results in measurable benefits. There does not appear to be any reasonable prognosis for improvement with continued treatment. Reevaluation should be considered at a later date to determine whether the patient/client’s status has changed or whether new treatment options have become available. 12. The individual is unable to tolerate treatment because of a serious medical, psychological, or other condition. 13. The individual demonstrates behavior that interferes with improvement or participation in treatment (e.g., noncompliance, malingering), providing that efforts to address the interfering behavior have been unsuccessful. Each program should have established policies and procedures for following the patient/client after discharge. Follow-up is necessary for a variety of reasons, including the fact that circumstances may change in the individual’s environment, new treatment options may become available, or the individual may respond differently due to maturational or motivational changes or new life transitions. Guidelines • Admission/Discharge Criteria in Speech-Language Pathology 2004 - 69 Conclusion References These criteria were developed as a guide for speech-language pathologists in all settings when considering initiating or discontinuing services for persons with speech, language, communication, feeding and swallowing, and related disorders. They may be used as a basis for developing more specific admission/discharge criteria to meet the particular needs of a school, health care, or other program. By identifying general admission/discharge factors for speech-language pathologists, the criteria also help speech-language pathologists identify patients/clients to include on their caseload; provides accrediting agency reviewers with information to evaluate service delivery and patient/client management; provides guidelines to government agencies, third-party payers, or school districts in the development of regulations, health care reform plans, and so forth; provides educators with consistent information to share with students in determining appropriate candidates for speech-language pathology services; and provides information that can be used for consumer education. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1983, September). Social dialects. Committee on the Status of Racial Minorities. Asha, 25, 23–27. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. Committee on Language Learning Disorders. (1989, March). Issues in determining eligibility for language intervention. Asha, 31, 113-118. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992, September). Standards for professional service programs in audiology and speech-language pathology. Asha, 34, 63-70. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. Task Force on Clinical Standards. (1993, March). Preferred practice patterns for the professions of speech-language pathology and audiology. Asha, 35 (Suppl. 11). American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1996, April). In P.A. Prelock (Ed.), Special interest divisions, Division 1: Language learning and education, 3(1), 1–27. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997). Preferred practice patterns for the profession of speech-language pathology. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1998). Guidelines for referral to speech-language pathologists. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2001). Scope of practice in speech-language pathology. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2003). Code of ethics. Rockville, MD: Author. Casby, M. W. (1996, April). Cognition and language: Basis, policy, practice, and recommendations. In P. A. Prelock (Ed.), Special interest divisions, language learning and education, 3(1), 5. Cole, K. (1996, April). What is the evidence from research with young children with language disorders? In P. A. Prelock (Ed.), Special interest divisions, language learning and education, 3(1), 6–7. Joint Commission on Accreditation of Healthcare Organizations. (2002). 2002 Hospital accreditation standards. Oakbrook Terrace, IL: Author. Lahey, M. (1996, April). Who shall be called language disordered? An update. In P. A. Prelock (Ed.), Special interest divisions, language learning and education, 3(1), 5–6. National Joint Committee for the Communication Needs of Persons With Severe Disabilities. (2002). Access to communication services and supports: Concerns regarding the application of restrictive “eligibility” policies. Rockville, MD: American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. Nelson, N. W. (1996, April). Discrepancy models and the discrepancy between policy and evidence. Opening remarks: Are we asking the wrong questions? In P. A. Prelock (Ed.), Special interest divisions, language learning and education, 3(1), 3–5. Terrell, S. L. (1996, April). Discrepancy model: Questions of concern regarding use for culturally different children. In P. A. Prelock (Ed.), Special interest divisions, language learning and education, 3(1), 8–9. Notes 1 NJC member organizations include the American Association on Mental Retardation; the American Occupational Therapy Association; the American Physical Therapy Association; the American SpeechLanguage-Hearing Association; the Council for Exceptional Children, Division for Communicative Disabilities and Deafness; RESNA; TASH; and the United States Society for Augmentative and Alternative Communication. 2 For the purpose of these guidelines, the terms admission and discharge are synonymous with the terms entrance and exit, respectively. 3 The term “family” refers to “the person(s) who plays a significant role in the individual’s life. This may include a person(s) not legally related to the individual” (Joint Commission on Accreditation of Healthcare Organizations, 2002, p. 339). 4 The ASHA Code of Ethics, Principle 1, Rule B states that: “Individuals shall use every resource, including referral when appropriate, to insure that high-quality service is provided” (ASHA, 2003). 70 - 2004 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association Figure 1. Discharge considerations when treatment no longer results in measurable benefits. Treatment no longer results in measurable benefit ^ ^ Review and analyze aspects of past service and seek consultation ^ Modify treatment or made referral ^ No Measurable benefit? ^ No Discharge ^ Continue treatment ^ ^ Yes Follow up Knowledge Skills Knowledge and Skills Needed by SLPs and Audiologists to Provide Culturally and Linguistically Appropriate and Services 2004 - 1 Knowledge and Skills Needed by Speech-Language Pathologists and Audiologists to Provide Culturally and Linguistically Appropriate Services ASHA’s Multicultural Issues Board This knowledge and skills document is an official statement of the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA). It describes the particular knowledge and skills needed to provide culturally and linguistically appropriate services in our professions. This document acknowledges the need to consider the impact of culture and linguistic exposure/acquisition on all our clients/patients, not simply for minority or diverse clients/ patients. In doing so, this document augments and expands the ASHA Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology (ASHA, 2001), the ASHA Scope of Practice in Audiology (ASHA, 1996 in references), and the ASHA Preferred Practice Patterns (ASHA, 1997a, 1997b). This document was prepared by the members of ASHA’s Multicultural Issues Board: Bopanna Ballachanda, Julie K. Bisbee, Catherine J. Crowley, Diana Diaz, Nancy Eng, Debra Garrett, Nikki Giorgis, Edgarita Long, Nidhi Mahendra, Joe A. Melcher, Wesley Nicholson, Constance Dean Qualls, Luis F. Riquelme, Marlene Salas-Provance, Toni Salisbury, Linda McCabe Smith, Carmen Vega-Barachowitz, Kenneth E. Wolf, and Vicki Deal-Williams (ex officio), and monitoring vice presidents for administration and planning Michael Kimbarow and Lyn Goldberg provided guidance. In addition, previous members of the Multicultural Issues Board—Ellen Fye, Charles Haynes, Celeste Roseberry-McKibbin, Emma Muñoz, Ravi Nigam, Jennifer Rayburn, Gari Smith, Kenneth Tom, and Janice Wright are gratefully acknowledged for their contributions to previous drafts and related policy that served as a basis for this document. Reference this material as: American Speech-LanguageHearing Association. (2004). Knowledge and skills needed by speech-language pathologists and audiologists to provide culturally and linguistically appropriate services. ASHA Supplement 24, in press. Index terms: assessment, bilingual/multilingual, CLD populations, cultural competence, diversity, English Language Learner (ELL), multicultural, treatment/management Document type: knowledge and skills Introduction The ethnic, cultural, and linguistic makeup of this country has been changing steadily over the past few decades. Cultural diversity can result from many factors and influences including ethnicity, religious beliefs, sexual orientation, socioeconomic levels, regionalisms, age-based peer groups, educational background, and mental/physical disability. With cultural diversity comes linguistic diversity, including an increase in the number of people who are English Language Learners, as well as those who speak non-mainstream dialects of English. In the United States, racial and ethnic projections for the years 2000-2015 indicate that the percentage of racial/ethnic minorities will increase to over 30% of the total population. The makeup of our school children will continue to diversify so that by 2010, children of immigrants will represent 22% of the school-age population (U.S. Bureau of the Census, 2000). As professionals, we must be prepared to provide services that are responsive to this diversity to ensure our effectiveness. Every clinician has a culture, just as every client/patient has a culture. Similarly, every clinician speaks at least one dialect of English and perhaps dialects from other languages, as does every client/patient. Given the myriad factors that shape one’s culture and linguistic background, it is not possible to match a clinician to clients/patients based upon their cultural and linguistic influences. Indeed, recent ASHA demographics indicate that only about 7% of the total membership are from a racial/ ethnic minority background and less than 6% of ASHA members identify themselves as bilingual or multilingual (ASHA, 2002). Only by providing culturally and linguistically appropriate services can we provide the quality of services our clients/patients deserve. Regardless of our personal culture, practice setting, or caseload demographics, we must strive for culturally and linguistically appropriate service delivery. For example, we must consider how communication disorders or differences might be manifested, identi- 2004 - 2 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association fied, or described in our client’s/patient’s cultural and linguistic community. This will inform all aspects of our practice including our assessment procedures, diagnostic criteria, treatment plan, and treatment discharge decisions. This document sets forth the knowledge and skills that we as professionals must strive to develop so that we can provide culturally and linguistically appropriate services to our clients/patients. The task may seem daunting at first. Given the knowledge and skills needed, we may shy away from working with clients/patients from certain cultural or linguistic groups. We may question whether it is ethical for us to work with these clients/patients. These guidelines provide a way to answer that question for each clinician. It is true that “Individuals shall engage in only those aspects of the profession that are within the scope of their competence, considering their level of education, training, and experience” (ASHA Principles of Ethics II, Rule B). So, without the appropriate knowledge and skills, we ethically cannot provide services. Yet, this does not discharge our responsibilities in this area. The ASHA Principles of Ethics further state, “Individuals shall not discriminate in the delivery of professional services” (ASHA Principles of Ethics I, Rule C). Thus, this ethical principle essentially mandates that clinicians continue in lifelong learning to develop those knowledge and skills required to provide culturally and linguistically appropriate services, rather than interpret Principles of Ethics II, Rule B as a reason not to provide the services. This document sets forth those knowledge and skills needed to provide culturally and linguistically appropriate services. It can be used to identify one’s strengths and weaknesses, and to develop a plan to fill in any gaps in one’s knowledge and skills in this area (ASHA, December 2001). Cultural Competence 1.0 Role: Sensitivity to cultural and linguistic differences that affect the identification, assessment, treatment and management of communication disorders/differences in persons. This includes knowledge and skills related to: 1.1 Influence of one’s own beliefs and biases in providing effective services. 1.2 Respect for an individual’s race, ethnic background, lifestyle, physical/mental ability, religious beliefs/practices, and heritage. 1.3 Influence of the client’s/patient’s traditions, customs, values, and beliefs related to providing effective services. 1.4 Impact of assimilation and/or acculturation processes on the identification, assessment, treatment, and management of communication disorders/differences. 1.5 Recognition of the clinician’s own limitations in education/training in providing services to a client/patient from a particular cultural and/or linguistic community. 1.6 Appropriate intervention and assessment strategies and materials, such as food, objects, and/or activities that do not violate the patient’s/client’s values and/or that may form a constructive bridge between the client’s/ patient’s home culture and community or communication environment. 1.7 Appropriate communications with clients/patients, caregivers, and significant others, so that the values imparted in the counseling are consistent with those of the client/patient. 1.8 The need to refer to/consult with other service providers with appropriate cultural and linguistic proficiency, including a cultural informant/broker, as it pertains to a specific client/patient. 1.9 Ethical responsibilities of the clinician concerning the provision of culturally and linguistically appropriate services. 2.0 Role: Advocate for and empower consumers, families, and communities at risk for or with communication/ swallowing/balance disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: 2.1 Community resources available for the dissemination of educational, health, and medical information pertinent to particular communities. 2.2 High risk factors for communication/swallowing/balance disorders in particular communities. 2.3 Prevention strategies for communication/cognition/ swallowing/balance disorders in particular communities. 2.4 The impact of regulatory processes on service delivery to communities. 2.5 Incidence and prevalence of culturally-based risk factors (e.g., hypertension, heart disease, diabetes, fetal alcohol syndrome) resulting in greater likelihood for communication/cognition/swallowing/balance disorders. 2.6 Appropriate consumer information and marketing materials/tools for outreach, service provision, and education. Language Competencies of the Clinician 3.0 Role: Ability to identify the appropriate service provider for clients/patients. 3.1 Bilingual/Multilingual clinician. Native or near-native proficiency in the language(s) spoken or signed by the client/patient. Knowledge and skills related to the impact of the differences between the dialect spoken by the clinician and by the client/patient on the quality of services provided. Knowledge and Skills Needed by SLPs and Audiologists to Provide Culturally and Linguistically Appropriate Services 3.2 Clinician without native or near-native proficiency in the language(s)/dialect(s) spoken or signed by the client/patient. Knowledge and skills related to: A. Obtaining information on the features and developmental characteristics of the language(s)/dialect(s) spoken or signed by the client/patient (see Language section). B. Obtaining information on the sociolinguistic features of the client’s/patient’s significant cultural and linguistic influences. C. Developing appropriate collaborative relationships with translators/interpreters (professional or from the community): 1) Maintain appropriate relationships among the clinician, the client/patient, and interpreter/translator. 2) Ensure that the interpreter/translator has knowledge and skills in the following areas: a) Native proficiency in client’s/patient’s language(s)/dialect(s) and the ability to provide accurate interpretation/translations. b) Familiarity with and positive regard for the client’s/patient’s particular culture, and speech community or communicative environment. c) Interview techniques, including ethnographic interviewing. d) Professional ethics and client/patient confidentiality. e) Professional terminology. f) Basic principles of assessment and/or intervention principles to provide context to understand objectives.. Language 4.0 Role: Obtain knowledge base needed to distinguish typical and disordered language of clients/patients. This includes knowledge and skills related to: 4.1 Sociolinguistic and cultural influences including: A. Client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment, including its discourse norms, and the impact of topic, participant, setting, and function on language use. B. Effective interviewing techniques so caregiver/parent and/or client/patient feels comfortable providing accurate and complete information. C. Impact of social and political power and prestige on language choice and use. D. Impact of sociolinguistics on code-switching and code-mixing. 2004 - 3 E. Language socialization patterns that affect language use in the clients/patient’s speech community. Types of language socialization patterns include narrative structure; importance of labeling; attitudes toward appropriateness of child-adult and child-child communications, ways of gathering information, and ways of giving commands such as known questions and veiled commands/ indirect speech acts. F. Cultural differences and similarities held by both client/patient and clinician, with resultant impact on language use in all communicative environments. G. Impact of client’s/patient’s attitudes, values, and beliefs toward non-oral approaches to communication such as augmentative/alternative communication, sign language, and assistive listening devices. 4.2 Language and linguistics including: A. Typical language development in simultaneous and sequential bilinguals. B. Normal processes of second-language acquisition, including language transfer, language attrition, interlanguage, and affective variables. C. Difference between an accent and a dialect, and a language and a dialect. D. Patterns of language recovery following neurological insult. E. Grammatical constraints on code-switching and code mixing. F. Typical development in the client’s/patient’s language(s)/dialect(s) in all areas (see 4.3). 4.3 Identifying, obtaining and integrating available resources to determine what is typical speech/language development in the client’s/patient’s speech community and communication environment, including: A. Research on the client’s/patient’s culture(s), speech community, or communication environment. B. Interview with a parent or other caregiver on how the client’s/patient’s speech/language development compares to peers in his/her speech community or communication environment. C. Interview with a family member, or other person who knew the client/patient previously, to describe and compare the client’s/patient’s language skills before the insult or injury that may have led to an acquired language disorder. D. Family history of speech/language problems or academic difficulties. E. Cultural informant/broker to gain insight into the impact of culture on the client’s/patient’s communication skills. 2004 - 4 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association F. Linguistic/sociolinguistic informant/broker from the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment, such as for grammaticality judgments and for judgments based upon sociolinguistic considerations related to the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment. G. Use of speech/language data provided by translator/interpreter. H. Clinician’s personal knowledge base. I. Application of the clinician’s clinical judgment to synthesize, evaluate, analyze, and make determinations based upon all the data/information gathered. 5.0 Role: Identification/Assessment of typical and disordered language. This includes knowledge and skills related to: 5.1 Foundational content: A. Current research and preferred practice patterns in the identification/assessment of language disorders/delays. B. Legal, regulatory, ethical, and professional guidelines relating to language assessment. C. Appropriate criteria for distinguishing a disorder from a difference by using the norms of the client’s/ patient’s speech community as the standard. D. Appropriate ethnographic interviewing techniques, such as knowing effective ways to ask for crucial but sensitive information so the caregiver/parent and/or client/patient, is comfortable enough to provide that information. E. Impact on language use by the client/patient with regard to topic, participants, setting, and function on the linguistic interaction, based upon knowledge of the standards of communicative competence in the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment (see 4.3). 5.2 Assessment materials/tests/tools: A. Appropriate use of published test materials in language assessment including standardized normreferenced tests and criterion-referenced tests, including analyzing normative sampling limitations, general psychometric issues especially related to validity and reliability, and inherent cultural and linguistic biases in these test materials. B. Application of appropriate criteria so that assessment materials/tests/tools that fail to meet standards be used as informal probes, with no accompanying scores. C. Inherent problems in using translated tests so that translated tests are used only as informal probes, with no accompanying scores. D. Appropriate use of alternative approaches to assessment including dynamic assessment, portfolio assessment, structured observation, narrative assessment, academic and social language sampling, interview assessment tools, and curriculumbased procedures, including analysis of validity, reliability, and inherent cultural and linguistic biases. E. How cultural and linguistic biases in assessment tools impact on an appropriate differential diagnosis between a language disorder and a language difference. 1. Cultural biases include question types, content, specific response tasks, and test formats that are not commonly used in the client’s/ patient’s speech community or communication environment. 2. Linguistic biases include differences in when certain features of language are acquired and/ or in certain linguistic forms that may not be common, or present at all, in the language(s) and/or dialect(s) spoken or used by the client/ patient. 5.3 Differential diagnosis: A. How linguistic features and learning characteristics of language differences and second-language acquisition are different from those associated with a true learning disability, emotional disturbance, central auditory processing deficit, elective mutism, or attention deficit disorder. (Diagnoses that might be confused with a linguistic or cultural difference or second language learning.) B. Preparation of written reports that incorporate information about the client’s/patient’s cultural and linguistic influences. C. Determination of whether a language disorder is present based upon one’s clinical judgment after reviewing and analyzing all the critical information (See 4.3). D. Determination of the severity level of any identified language disorder. E. Ethical issues raised if scores are provided for tests that are psychometrically flawed, translated and not adapted, culturally biased, and/or linguistically biased. 6.0 Role: Treatment/Management of disordered language. This includes knowledge and skills related to: A. Current research and best practices in the treatment/management of language disorders/delays, including various delivery models and options for intervention. Knowledge and Skills Needed by SLPs and Audiologists to Provide Culturally and Linguistically Appropriate Services B. Appropriate language(s)/dialect(s) to use in treatment and management. C. Impact of the client’s/patient’s current and historical language/dialect exposure and experience. D. Standards of the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment in determining discharge/dismissal criteria, rather than base that decision on the client/patient mastering the clinician’s or interpreter’s/translator’s language(s)/dialect(s) and language socialization practices. E. Integration of the client’s/patient’s attitudes, values, and beliefs toward non-oral approaches to communication such as augmentative/alternative communication, sign language, and assistive listening devices when those approaches are incorporated into treatment. F. Consideration of client’s/patient’s and/or parent’s/caregiver’s desire and need for fluency in the native language and/or English when considering the language for intervention. G. Legislative and regulatory mandates and limitations to resources that may impact the language used for intervention. Articulation and Phonology 7.0 Role: Identification/Assessment of individuals at risk for articulation/phonological disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: A. Current research and best practices in the identification/assessment of articulation/phonological disorders in the languages(s) and/or dialect(s) spoken by the client/patient. B. Phonemic and allophonic variations of the language(s) and/or dialect(s) spoken in the client’s/patient’s speech community and how those variations affect a determination of disorder or difference. C. Difference between an articulation disorder, phonological disorder, an accent, a dialect, transfer patterns and typical developmental patterns. D. Standards of the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment to determine whether he or she has an articulation or phonological disorder/delay. Identifying and using available resources to determine what is typical speech development in the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment (See 4.3). 8.0 Role: Treatment/Management of individuals with articulation or phonological disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: 2004 - 5 A. Current research and best practices in the treatment/management of articulation and phonological disorders/delays in the languages(s) and/or dialect(s) spoken by the client/patient. B. Community standards of typical articulation and phonology patterns, so that in treatment/management dialect, and accent features are not treated as articulation or phonological disorders. C. Standards of the client’s/patient’s speech community in determining discharge/dismissal criteria so that discharge/dismissal is based upon whether the client/patient is speaking his/her dialect appropriately. Resonance/Voice/Fluency 9.0 Role: Identification/Assessment and Treatment/Management of individuals at risk for resonance, voice, and/ or fluency disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: A. Current research on preferred practice patterns in the identification/assessment and treatment/management of resonance, voice and/or fluency disorders. B. Community standards of typical resonance, voice, and/or fluency patterns. C. Application of the standards of the client’s/ patient’s speech/communication community for dismissal/discharge criteria. Swallowing 10.0 Role: Identification/Assessment and Treatment/Management of individuals at risk for swallowing/feeding disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: A. Current research and preferred practice patterns in the identification/assessment of swallowing/feeding disorders. B. Community standards of typical swallowing/feeding patterns and preferences. C. Incorporation of the client’s/patient’s dietary preferences, related to the identification/assessment of swallowing/feeding disorders. D. Application of the standards of the client’s/ patient’s community for dismissal/discharge criteria. Hearing/Balance 11.0 Role: Identification/Assessment of clients/patients with or at risk for hearing/balance disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: 2004 - 6 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association A. Current research and preferred practice patterns in the identification/assessment of hearing/balance disorders. B. Application of the community standards and beliefs regarding hearing/balance impairment. C. Culturally and linguistically appropriate assessment materials, tools, and methods. D. Inherent problems in using speech testing materials (e.g., word lists, speech discrimination lists) that have been translated, not adapted, and/or not fully researched and not reflective of the phonological patterns of the client’s/patient’s language/dialect. E. Influences of language and speech differences including issues related to bilingualism and dialectal differences between the client/patient and the clinician on hearing evaluation decisions, such as in speech recognition tests in quiet and noise. (See sections 7.0 and 8.0). F. How other factors, (e.g., the color and consistency of cerumen), may influence findings on otoscopic examination and external canal management. 12.0 Role: Treatment/Management of individuals at risk for hearing/balance disorders. This includes knowledge and skills related to: A. Current research and preferred practice patterns in the treatment/management of those hearing/balance disorders that are more prevalent in certain racial/ethnic communities and which are more prevalent due to cultural variables. B. Application of the community standards and beliefs regarding hearing/balance disorders. C. Attitudes and beliefs related to the treatment/management of hearing/balance disorders, such as attitudes towards using a manually coded system of communication; and assistive listening devices such as hearing aids, FM units, and cochlear implants. D. Application of the standards of the client/patient speech community for dismissal/discharge criteria. E. Components of a culturally appropriate audiological rehabilitation program. F. Availability of personal assistive devices such as earmolds and hearing aids with greater cosmetic appeal for varying skin tones. Terminology Accent: (1) A set of shared variables, related to pronunciation, common to a particular speech community. It is standard practice to distinguish accent from dialect. Accent refers only to distinctive features of pronunciation, whereas dia- lect refers to distinctive lexical, morphological, and syntactical features. (2) A set of phonetic traits of one language that is carried over into the use of another language a person is learning (foreign accent). Bidialectalism: The use of two different dialects of a given language. In terms of linguistic structure, one dialect of any language is not “superior” to another; however, from a social point of view, several dialects are considered to be prestigious and others are considered to be non-prestigious. Bilingualism: The use of at least two languages by an individual. The degree of proficiency in the languages can range from a person in the initial stages of acquisition of two languages to a person who speaks, understands, reads, and writes two languages at native or near-native proficiency. Code mixing: (1) Code-switching. (2) Term used to describe the mixed-language utterances used by a bilingual individual. It involves the utilization of features of both languages (usually at the lexical level) within a sentence (intra-sentential level). Code switching: The juxtaposition within the same speech exchange of passages belonging to two different grammatical systems. The switch can be intrasentential, (within a sentence) (Spanish-English switch: Dame a glass of water. “Give me a glass of water”). It can be intersentential, across sentence boundaries (Spanish-English switch: Give me a glass of water. Tengo sed. “Give me a glass of water. I’m thirsty”). The switches are not random; they are governed by constraints such as the Free Morpheme Constraint and the Equivalency Constraint. Many who are bilingual and/ or bidialectal are self-conscious about their code switching and try to avoid it with certain interlocutors and in particular situations. However, in informal speech it is a natural and powerful feature of a bilingual’s/bidialectal’s interactions. Communication environment: The communicative environment of users of assistive or augmentative communication systems, and some forms of manual communication. Communicative competence: The ability to use language(s) and/or dialect(s) and to know when and where to use which and with whom. This ability requires grammatical, sociolinguistic, discourse, and strategic competence. It is evidenced in a speaker’s unconscious knowledge (awareness) of the rules/factors which govern acceptable speech in social situations. Cultural informant/broker: A person who is knowledgeable about the client’s/patient’s culture and/or speech community and who provides this information to the clinician for optimizing services. Culturally diverse: When an individual or group is exposed to, and/or immersed in more than one set of cultural Knowledge and Skills Needed by SLPs and Audiologists to Provide Culturally and Linguistically Appropriate Services beliefs, values, and attitudes. These beliefs, values, and attitudes may be influenced by race/ethnicity, sexual orientation, religious or political beliefs, or gender identification. Dialect: A neutral term used to describe a language variation. Dialects are seen as applicable to all languages and all speakers. All languages are analyzed into a range of dialects, which reflect the regional and social background of their speakers. Linguistic/sociolinguistic informant/broker: A trained and knowledgeable person from the client’s/patient’s speech community or communication environment who under the clinician’s guidance can provide valuable information about language and sociolinguistic norms in the client’s/patient’s speech community and communication environment. A properly trained informant/broker can provide information such as grammaticality judgments as to whether the client’s/patient’s language and phonetic production is consistent with the norms of that speech community or communication environment; information on the language socialization patterns of that speech community or communication environment; and information on other areas of language including semantics and pragmatics. Interlanguage: An intermediate-state language system created by someone in the process of learning a foreign language. The interlanguage contains properties of L1 transfer, overgeneralization of L2 rules and semantic features, as well as strategies of second language learning. Interpreter: A person specially trained to translate oral communications or manual communication systems from one language to another. Language loss (also known as language attrition): A potential consequence of second-language acquisition whereby a person may lose his/her ability to speak, write, read, and/or understand a particular language or dialect due to lack of use or exposure. Linguistically diverse: Where an individual or group has had significant exposure to more than one language or dialect. Sequential bilingualism (also known as successive bilingualism): Occurs when an individual has had significant exposure to a second language after the first language is well established. Simultaneous bilingualism: Occurs when a young child has had significant exposure to two languages simultaneously, before one language is well established. 2004 - 7 Speech community: A group of people who share at least one speech variety in common. Members of bilingual/ bidialectal communities often have access to more than one speech variety. The selection of the specific variety depends on such variables as the participants, the topic, the function, and the location of the speech event. Translator: A person specially trained to translate written text from one language to another. References American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1996, spring). Scope of practice in audiology. Asha 38 (Suppl. 16), 12–15. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2001). Scope of practice in speech-language pathology. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997a). Preferred practice patterns for the profession of audiology. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997b). Preferred practice patterns for the profession of speech-language pathology. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997a, 1997b). Preferred practice patterns. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2001, December 26). Code of ethics (revised). The ASHA Leader, 6(23), p. 2. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2002). Communication development and disorders in multicultural populations: Readings and related materials. Available online at http:/ /www.asha.org/about/leadership-projects/multicultural/ readings/OMA_fact_sheets.htm National Standards for Culturally and Linguistically Appropriate Services in Health Care. (2001, March). Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, OPHS Office of Minority Health. U.S. Bureau of the Census. (2000). Statistical abstract of the United States 119th ed. Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Commerce. SUMMARY OF CASE MANAGEMENT CLIENT CLINICIAN SEMESTER SUPERVISOR Audiological/ENT/ Neurological/Other Evaluations Include latest date of testing; any medical follow-up; Diagnoses: results; recommendations Cognitive/Academic Considerations Cognitive status C Indicate any presence of learning disability; emotional disturbance; developmental delay; grade in school; school classroom placement; therapy received at school Family/Parent Support System Indicate client’s family situation (e.g. foster care, group home, intact); family stressors; involvement of social services; incidence of communication disorder in family Voice/Fluency Typical quality of voice; any vocal fold pathology; presence of dysfluencies C type of frequency and severity Oral Mechanism Include assessment of structures and functions. Any oral/motor problems, apraxia or surgeries. Articulation Include testing from last report; indicate sounds in error and severity. Include past treatment methods found to be effective in therapy. Semantics Include test results from past report; knowledge and use of words and word relationships (vocabulary) Syntax Include test results. Language sample analyses; MLU; use of simple or complex sentences; use of standard vs non-standard forms, etc. Phonology Include tests and analyses from past report; list developmental and non-developmental processes displayed; statement of awareness Pragmatics Include analyses of conversational Skills; verbal and non-verbal interactions Comments/Special Needs May include clinical impressions; progress; parentchild interaction; physical limitations; recommendations from previous semester; goals not attained previous semester. ASSESSMENT Audiological Evaluation Other Referral Include reason for referral Cognitive/Academic Referral/Consultation Does this client need to be seen for psych./educational assessment? If so, note here. Also indicate need for consultation with school SLP. Social Service Referral Does this client need to be seen by social worker or other social service agency? Do you need to consult with SW? Voice/Fluency Measures Diagnostic measures of voice/fluency. Visipitch, commercially available instruments, speech sample, etc. Oral Mechanism Describe procedures for oral mech. exam if needed. Need for Dental/Orthodontic/ Otolaryngolic consult. Articulation Tests to be given; other measures of articulation and intelligibility. Stimulability List phonemes to be tested and reason. Semantics Receptive List tests to be given; contexts to investigate. Syntax Receptive List tests to be given and probes to be utilized. Expressive List tests to be given; contexts to investigate. Expressive Lists tests to be given; procedures for obtaining and scoring language sample. Pragmatics Conversational analysis; tests; procedures, surveys to be used. Interview What questions will you ask client/family? Phonology List tests/analyses to be given. Stimulability Phonemes to assess; phonetic contexts. Tentative Goals List possible goals for intervention. SUMMARY OF CASE MANAGEMENT SEMESTER SUPERVISOR CLIENT CLINICIAN Audiological/ENT/ Neurological/Other Evaluations Cognitive/Academic Considerations Family/Parent Support System Voice/Fluency Oral Mechanism Articulation Semantics Syntax Phonology Pragmatics Comments/Special Needs ASSESSMENT Audiological Evaluation Other Referral Cognitive/Academic Referral/Consultation Social Service Referral Voice/Fluency Measures Oral Mechanism Articulation Stimulability Semantics Receptive Syntax Receptive Phonology Expressive Expressive Stimulability Pragmatics Interview Tentative Goals GRADUATE CLINICAL PRACTICUM SUMMARY ** Complete and turn into Coordinator of Clinical Education to request your clinical placement Name: _______________________________ Year: Junior Senior Phone: _______________________ Graduate: 1st year 2nd year 3rd year Expected Date of Graduation: _______________ COURSE WORK COMPLETED (Note whether UG (undergraduate) or G (graduate level) _____ Phonetics & Phonology _____Neuroscience of Communication and _____ Language Development Communication Disorders _____Speech & Hearing Science _____ Medical Aspects I (Voice Disorders) _____Anatomy & Physiology _____ Fluency _____Practicum in Communication Disorders _____ Child Language Disorders (Clinical Procedures) _____ Diagnosis of Speech/Lang Disorders _____Communication & Aging _____ Methods of Research _____Introduction to Audiology _____ Medical Aspects II (Neuromotor and _____Speech Language Therapy in Schools Craniofacial Anomalies) _____Articulation and Phonology _____ Acquired Adult Language & Cognitive Disorders _____ Other: (Please List) CLINICAL EXPERIENCE (Approximate hours experience) Required Minimum _____ Observation hours 25 _____ Audiological Testing* _____ Aural Rehabilitation* *Must have total of 20 hours in audiology or aural rehab combined _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ Child Language Disorders Therapy Adult Language Disorders Therapy Child Speech Disorders Therapy Adult Speech Disorders Therapy Evaluation in Child Language Disorders Evaluation in Adult Language Disorders Evaluation in Child Speech Disorders Evaluation in Adult Speech Disorders 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 Must have total of 350 clock hours in speech/language pathology (250 hours at Graduate level) with minimum levels in each disorder area as follows CURRENT & PAST SUPERVISORS/SITES (CHSC, Externship)/TYPE THERAPY (Group, etc.) PLACEMENT PREFERENCES A. I would like __________ hours of clinic this semester. B. Preferred placement -- note client types and/or settings. (Level II and III students only) C. Priority needs (3rd and 4th semester students only) SCHEDULE: Please note courses/work schedule, etc. for when you are already booked. Monday 8:00 9:00 10:00 11:00 12:00 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday To be completed by each student twice during each semester of COSI 452: Graduate Practicum. Details are located on the course syllabus. Attached is an example. Case Western Reserve University Graduate Student Practicum EVALUATION OF VIDEOTAPED/AUDIOTAPED SESSION Date Student Clinician Client Diagnosis Age of Client Length of Session Supervisor 1st 2nd year student (circle one) Directions: Summarize the events taking place in your session in the space below. Next, briefly comment on each skill/behavior listed. Finally, list at least three suggestions that you believe will help you to make your next session more effective. 1. Timing of session 2. Non-verbal behavior of clinician 3. Amount of social speech 4. Introduced session goals 5. Clarity of instructions 6. Discrimination/feedback 7. Appropriate reinforcement 8. Concluded/reviewed session performance 9. Appropriate & professional interpersonal skills 10. Were session goals accomplished? Think about three areas to improve upon for your next session. How will you affect the changes that need to be made? Write your suggestion here. EXAMPLE EVALUATION OF VIDEOTAPED/AUDIOTAPED SESSION #1 EXAMPLE EVALUATION OF VIDEOTAPED/AUDIOTAPED SESSION #2 1. Timing of Session: Mr. K was seen for a 45 minute session in the patient lounge of the Subacute Rehabilitation Unit. 2. Non-verbal behavior of clinician: Mr. K has been a client of the department of communicative disorders for several weeks. In this time period, I had an excellent chance to build a strong rapport with Mr. K. The session was conducted in a relaxed environment with both myself and the client sitting next to a table. Mr. K responded very well to head nods and facial expressions which were used as a means of cueing the client about the appropriateness of his answers. 3. Amount of social speech: Mr. K liked to talk about stimulus items (when appropriate), often adding bits and pieces of information about their relation to his own life at home when he could. I encouraged this spontaneous verbal expression as well as the social speech Mr. K made great strides in during his hospitalization. He went from his most frequent response of, “oh okay okay” to asking how I was doing in this session. He mentions several times how he will bet better little by little. On this date he told me that if he could just get back to 85-90% functioning he’d be happy. I used Mr. K’s social speech this date to expand of his expressive capabilities. 4. Introduced session goals: At the beginning of this session, as with all others, I provided a brief review of what we had been working on in the previous session and what other areas I might like to begin probing today. Goals for the session this date included naming common objects, naming functions of common objects, sentence completion, and matching words to their corresponding picture from a choice of two. Mr. K was also introduced to the task of selecting the correct word from a choice of three on this date. Further probing was done by having Mr. K identify which word did not “fit” into a list of category related words. Mr. K did very well with this task and “homework” assignments regarding his reading ability were assigned. Mr. K is very motivated to complete these assignments and brings them to the next day’s session to review his work and assist in monitoring his progress. 5. Clarity of instructions: I presented Mr. K with instructions for the exact task I wanted him to complete at the beginning of each one. So when we begin naming objects, I talked about taking out “the box” again (Lark box), and explained I would be pulling out items one by one. As I showed him each one, I wanted him to tell me what it was. I ask Mr. K is he understands, and he responds yes and we begin. While the task isn’t always easy, he knows what he needs to do. 6. Discrimination/feedback: Mr. K is at a level this date where he does a lot of self-correction of his errors. Often, if he does mislabel an object, he recognizes quickly that he has done this and says “no no wait”. I give him feedback letting him know that he has indeed mislabeled but I also encourage him to realize that sometimes the error was semantically related (i.e. calling a glass a cup or a spoon a fork). If Mr. K is having difficulty, I ask him to recall the cueing strategies we work on. This date, Mr. K is making progress with using them. If the task is to identify a spoon, I prompt him to use the technique or re calling what you do with it and then rehearsing the phrase in his head to facilitate recall (i.e. you stir coffee with a …). 7. Appropriate reinforcement: I reinforce any part of a response that approximates the correct answer. If Mr. K is on track, I reinforce it. I remind him of the strategies that will hopefully cue the desired response. Mr. K and I talk about the difficulty of verbal expression since the stroke, but we also talk about the progress he has made since he was first admitted. This provided him with encouragement and sessions become more of challenge. One thing that we have begun doing recently and continue to do in this session is s a comparison to previous sessions’ performance . Mr. K likes the reinforcing feedback of knowing that last week, for example he was at 65% accuracy in naming and this week it’s more like 70-75%. 8. Concluded/reviewed session performance: Again, the comparisons to previous sessions provide Mr. K with valuable information on his performance. I let him know how he did today and point out very notable areas of improvement. For example, today Mr. k was able to spontaneously name two objects he had previously needed moderate assistance in naming. The fact that he was able to identify them independently today was a great sign of progress, so I point it out and encourage it. I also gave Mr. K some idea of what we’d work on in the next session and where I’m trying to get him to on his goals. We reviewed how important these abilities will be, especially when Mr. K goes home. 9. Appropriate and professional interpersonal skills: Working with Mr. K, in today’s session, as well as on a day to day basis has given me a wonderful opportunity to strengthen my ability to relate and convey information to my client. Mr. K’s wife is present almost every session, and together we talk about challenges Mr. K will face as he returns to the home environment. While I work with Mr. K, I provide as much modeling as possible for Mrs. K so that she learns how to be an effective facilitator of communication and will be able to keep frustration for Mr. K at home to a minimum. I often encourage Mr.s K to participate in the session. On this date, Mrs K has done a terrific job of using personally relevant information about how Mr. K uses an item at home to facility him being able to name it. 10. Were session goals accomplished? Mr. K made progress on all goals today. He was able to spontaneously name some items that had previously required moderate cueing. Mr. K demonstrated greater use of self-cuing and self-correction this date. Continued progress in all of these areas will facilitate improved communication in the home environment and work on more challenging functional goals in terms of reading etc. Think about three areas to improve upon for your next session. How will you affect the changes that need to be made? 1. Although I provided appropriate cueing today, there are some areas in which I would like to improve. I provide Mr. K with a lot of time to respond, which is good, however, often I let him go too long without introducing some kind of cuing for assistance. Timing is an issue I would like to improve. I need to realize that while I want him to succeed independently, at this time, I need to keep expectations to a level at which Mr. K can perform. If he will be more successful with some level of cuing, I need to provide it and reinforce it until I can more gradually begin to fade the cues. 2. Another related area is in terms of the general timing of my session. At times, I tend to really get into working with my client and thus do not end the session onetime. This leads to decreased time to write session notes and has at times interfered with beginning my next session on time. I ran a little over today, but nothing too significant. 3. Another thing I’d like to improve upon is in type of discrimination/feedback. I’d like to brainstorm new ways in which I can provide Mr. K with cueing etc. I tend to use the same strategies again and again. While some degree of consistency may be good, I might be able to find curing techniques that work better for Mr. K and assist in learning their use. GUIDELINES FOR CASE PRESENTATION COSI 452 Requirements All graduate students are required to complete a formal case presentation through the Graduate Practicum course one time during their graduate program. The Case Presentation should be 20-30 minutes in length. It will include a written outline for the audience and a clearly presented oral summary of the case supported by a video- or audiotaped sample of the client (when possible). Students should be able to answer questions from the audience (including faculty members, CHSC staff, and other class members enrolled in COSI 452) and provide well-thought out rationale for their clinical decision-making. Objectives 1. To provide students a formalized opportunity to demonstrate their ability to integrate academic knowledge with clinical problem solving 2. To provide students with an opportunity to demonstrate their clinical problem solving skills and to develop skills to verbally describe and support clinical decision-making 3. To provide students a forum for increasing their verbal interaction skills (both as a presenter and as member of the audience) 4. To provide students with an opportunity to refine their case presentation skills Suggested Organization/Components of Presentation I. Intervention Case A. Summary of relevant history B. Description of communication skills (prior to intervention) C. Diagnosis and prognosis for improvement D. Description of intervention program (techniques, strategies, protocols) -- with rationale, description of theoretical approach, schedule of therapy, and format of therapy E. Presentation of results (baseline data, intervention data, end of program measures) F. Summary and conclusions II. Diagnostic Case Presentation A. Summary of relevant history and background information B. Presentation of hypotheses concerning the client C. Diagnostic plan that was prepared D. Summary of procedures used and results E. Interpretation of results--description of areas of strength, weaknesses, areas not measured completely, diagnosis, and prognosis F. Recommendation with detailed plan of how intervention should be approached including identification of specific goals, therapy schedule, strategies and techniques to be used G. Case Disposition--description of status of client after the diagnostic (i.e., enrolled in therapy, case closed, transferred to another agency) For each presentation, the student should complete a relevant article summary. See following pages.k Schedule of Presentation Students should plan to complete their case presentation during the 3rd or 4th semester of their graduate program. Before the first day of class in the semester they wish to present, they should inform the instructor of Graduate Clinical Practicum of their intent to present. The instructor will determine the specific date of the presentation and will incorporate it into the syllabus plans for that semester. Students are responsible for informing the faculty and CHSC staff of the day/time of their presentation at least 2 weeks before the scheduled date so that interested staff can make plans to attend the presentation. RESOURCES/FORM FOR ARTICLE SUMMARY ARTICLE SUMMARY FORM INSERT HERE THE CITATION SO THAT YOU CAN LATER FIND THE ARTICLE AND YOU CAN IDENTIFY WHAT ARTICLE YOU ARE SUMMARIZING Research Questions/Purpose Results Discussion/Implications AUTHORS GENERALLY STATE THESE QUITE CLEARLY AND YOU CAN COPY THESE VERBATIN FROM THE ARTICLE. KNOWING THE QUESTIONS AND PURPOSE WILL HELP YOU ORGANIZE AND EVALUATE THE RESULTS Subjects SUMMARIZE THE RESULTS. IT IS IMPORTANT TO INCLUDE DATA AS WELL AS WHETHER THE RESULTS WERE STATISTICALLY SIGNIFICATNT. DAT-GROUP MEANS, STANDARD DEVEIATIONS, ETC. FROM THE ARTICLE, WHAT DO THE AUTHORS REVEAL AS TO THE SUMMARY OF THEIR MAJOR FINDINGS AND THE IMPLICATION SOF THESE FINDINGS. HOW DO THESE FINDINGS RELATE TO OTHER LITERATURE? YOU MIGHT WANT TO MAKE BULLETED POINTS THAT ARE EASY TO REFER BACK TO. LIST THE IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT PARTICIPANTS-GROUP, NUMBER OF PARTICIPANTS, CRITERIA FOR PARTICIPANT SELECTION, AGES, GENDER, AND SO ON. HERE AND THROUGHOUT YOU WILL WANT TO USE BULLETED POINTS. YOU WANT TO MAKE THIS DOCUMENT EASY TO READ AND REFER TO LATER ON, HENCE PROSE ARE NOT MOST BENEFICIAL. Procedures Questions/Critique DESCRIBE THE PROCEDURES FOR THE STUDY…HOW WAS THE DATE COLLECTED? HOW WERE THE VARIABLES DERIVED WHAT QUESTOINS DO YOU HAVE AFTER REVIEWING THIS STUDY? THIS IS FOR YOUR CRITIQUE OF THE STUDY AND PRESENTATION OF THE STUDY, NOT FOR THE LIMITATIONS RAISED BY THE AUTHORS. YOU DO NOT NEED TO SUMMARIZE RELIABILITY. ARTICLE SUMMARY FORM INSERT HERE THE CITATION SO THAT YOU CAN LATER FIND THE ARTICLE AND YOU CAN IDENTIFY WHAT ARTICLE YOU ARE SUMMARIZING Research Questions/Purpose Results Discussion/Implications . Subjects Procedures Questions/Critique Case Western Reserve University COSI 452 CASE PRESENTATION FEEDBACK FORM Case Western Reserve University COSI 452 CASE PRESENTATION FEEDBACK FORM Student: ________________________________ Date: ________________ Student: ________________________________ Date: ________________ Case Description: Adult Child Therapy Diagnostic Diagnosis: _________________________________________________ Case Description: Adult Child Therapy Diagnostic Diagnosis: _________________________________________________ Key: + = Excellent Key: + = Excellent OK=Adequate NI = Needs to be Improved OK=Adequate NI = Needs to be Improved NOTE: Provide Feedback in areas relevant to the student’s presentation. All slots do not need to be filled-in. NOTE: Provide Feedback in areas relevant to the student’s presentation. All slots do not need to be filled-in. ____ 1. Presents information in an organized manner ____ 2. Appropriate nonverbal behaviors utilized (loudness, rate, eye contact) ____ 3. Case presentation is complete and thorough: ___ Case History ___ Diagnostic measures ___Description of tx strategies ___ Prognosis ___ Severity Level(s) ___ Summary of progress ___ Contributing factors ___ Plan of Treatment ___Other_____________________________________________________ __ ____ 4. Includes analysis of variables affecting client behavior ____ 5. Clearly summarizes info from at least one article ____ 6. Cites research appropriately ____ 7. Describes how the research article relates to the case ____ 8. Demonstrates ability to critically evaluate research related to case ____ 9. Able to respond to question-answer sequences ____ 10. Able to reflect on current clinical strengths/areas to improve ____ 1. Presents information in an organized manner ____ 2. Appropriate nonverbal behaviors utilized (loudness, rate, eye contact) ____ 3. Case presentation is complete and thorough: ___ Case History ___ Diagnostic measures ___Description of tx strategies ___ Prognosis ___ Severity Level(s) ___ Summary of progress ___ Contributing factors ___ Plan of Treatment ___Other_____________________________________________________ __ ____ 4. Includes analysis of variables affecting client behavior ____ 5. Clearly summarizes info from at least one article ____ 6. Cites research appropriately ____ 7. Describes how the research article relates to the case ____ 8. Demonstrates ability to critically evaluate research related to case ____ 9. Able to respond to question-answer sequences ____ 10. Able to reflect on current clinical strengths/areas to improve COMMENTS: COMMENTS: Adapted from CPR-#2 Feedback Form CSD Clinic Committee University of Pittsburgh Adapted from CPR-#2 Feedback Form CSD Clinic Committee University of Pittsburgh SUPERVISION INTRODUCTION: At the beginning of each placement, it is your responsibility to give your supervisor a Supervisor Packet. This includes: • Thank You letter from the Coordinator of Clinical Education • Academic Calendar • Clinical Evaluation Forms • Clinical Evaluation Scoring Systems • Supervisory Needs Rating Scale • Supervisory Expectations Rating Scale • Session feedback form • Clinical Contract The following is an EXAMPLE of such a packet. The packets will be available outside the office of the Coordinator of Clinical Education during the first week of each semester. Semester: Fall Spring Summer Year: 20_______ Midterm/Final (Circle) SAMPLE “THANK YOU” LETTER DATE Dear , Thank you for agreeing to supervise a graduate student clinician from our Department. Below is information concerning the student assigned to you: Student: Phone: Email: Approximate number of clinical hours already completed: Prior externship site experiences: The assignment should extend from the week of through . Students are expected to complete at least two days per week with a schedule that meets your needs. Please contact me if there are any difficulties with this. Attached, please find paperwork requirements for the semester. There is also a calendar that defines deadlines and holidays. After the student has completed two weeks of their assignment with you, please complete the clinical contract form and return a copy to me. This form allows you to define your expectations during the training period. A clinical evaluation form for the mid-semester review is also enclosed. Your student will bring another copy of the form for the end of semester grading. Please complete this form using the numeric clinical evaluation scoring system attached—you are not required to provide a letter grade. You may find it helpful to use the Supervisor Expectations/Needs form included in this packet at the beginning and middle of the semester. Thank you for participating in our student training program. The success of our graduate program is highly dependent on the excellent clinical training that students receive at externship sites by the site supervisors. If you have any questions or concerns, please call me at (216)368-2385. In addition, if our faculty can be of assistance to you or your department, please let us know. Sincerely, Kay McNeal, M.S., CCC-SLP Coordinator of Clinical Education Semester: Fall Spring Summer Year: 20_______ Midterm/Final (Circle) CLINICAL EVALUATION FORM -- Level I (0-100 hours) Student Clinician Date _____________ Clinical Site Clinical Supervisor # Clinical Hours Evaluated 1 = Poor 2 = Needs to Improve 3 = Adequate 4 = Good 5 = Very Good I. INTERPERSONAL SKILLS A. With Client 1. Relates comfortably to client 2. Attends to client’s total behavior with emphasis on interaction with client 3. Keeps personal concerns and problems from interfering with therapy _____ 4. Maintains a confident image while working with client _____ 5. Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences B. With Others (professionals and family members) 1. Clearly explains therapy goals and progress 2. Responds appropriately to feedback _____ 3. Uses language appropriate to the listener (i.e. professional vs family members) ______ 4. Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences II. TECHNICAL SKILLS A. Therapy Planning 1. Short term _____ a. Formulates behavioral objectives on a session-tosession basis _____ b. Uses materials that are motivating and appropriate for the client _____ c. Has rationale for selected procedures consistent with evidence based practices _____ d. Structures plan to obtain maximum number of responses _____ e. Modifies program when change is indicated _____ f. Organizes therapy setting (room & materials) to enhance therapy effectiveness 2. Long Term: _____ Formulates reasonable long term objectives B. Therapy Execution _____ 1. Uses appropriate language for client’s abilities _____ 2. Obtains appropriate number of client responses per session _____ 3. Gives client sufficient time to respond _____ 4. Discriminates errors from target behavior _____ 5. Uses appropriate correction techniques _____ 6. Gives meaningful and motivating feedback _____ 7. Accurately records responses _____ 8. Appropriate ratio of clinician-client talk time _____ 9. Demonstrates flexibility when following lesson plan _____ 10. Able to make smooth transitions between activities _____ 11. Modifies activities when appropriate and provides a rationale for modifications NA = Does Not Apply COMMENTS Semester: Fall 1 = Poor Spring Summer Year: 20_______ 2 = Needs to Improve 3 = Adequate 4 = Good Midterm/Final (Circle) 5 = Very Good C. Behavior Management _____ 1. Manipulates the environment in order to facilitate optimal performance _____ 2. Deals appropriately with unacceptable behavior NA = Does Not Apply COMMENTS D. Daily Clinical Documentation _____ 1. Develops data collection procedures to measure client progress _____ 2. Accurately records responses _____ 3. Writes accurate and complete SOAP notes E. Professional Responsibilities 1. Observes rules: _____ a. Dresses appropriately _____ b. Respects guidelines of facility (e.g. returning materials, files, etc.) _____ c. On time for therapy and meetings _____ d. Paperwork submitted in a timely fashion _____ e. Respects client confidentiality _____ 2. Prepares for supervisor conference _____ 3. Identifies alternative procedures during discussion of clients _____ 4. Demonstrates ability to problem solve after session, making appropriate changes in therapy plan _____ 5. Identifies strengths and weaknesses of session III. CLINICAL REPORTING _____ A. Uses appropriate clinical language in reports _____ B. Documents pertinent, accurate, and complete information _____ C. Logical organization is used (i.e. examples of behaviors, avoids excessive use of professional jargon) _____ D. Makes appropriate and specific recommendations for client _____ E. Incorporates supervisor’s suggestions in drafts of report _____ F. Proofreads report for errors before turning it in Score: Total points/# Items Scored ______/ 47 = ______ Strengths: Areas to improve: Suggestions for improving these areas: __________________________________/______ Student Clinician Date ____________________________/_______ Supervisor Date Semester: Fall Spring Summer Year: 20_______ Midterm/Final (Circle) CLINICAL EVALUATION FORM -- Level II (101 - 225 hours) Clinical Supervisor Student Clinician Date _____________ Clinical Site # Clinical Hours Evaluated_________ 1 = Poor 2 = Needs to Improve 3 = Adequate 4 = Good 5 = Very Good I. INTERPERSONAL SKILLS A. With Client 1. Relates comfortably to client _____ 2. Keeps personal concerns and problems from interfering with therapy _____ 3. Demonstrates appropriate initiative _____ 4. Demonstrates ability and willingness to function independently _____ 5. Deals with attitudes and behaviors displayed by clients _____ 6. Projects confident, professional image in clinical setting _____ 7. Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences B. With Others (professionals and family members) _____ 1. Interacts appropriately with other professionals _____ 2. Conveys therapy goals and progress _____ 3. Responds appropriately to feedback _____ 4. Uses language appropriate to the listener (i.e. professional vs family member) _____ 5. Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences II. TECHNICAL SKILLS A. Daily Planning 1. Short term _____ a. Objectives and materials are appropriate _____ b. Has rational for selected procedures consistent with evidence based practices _____ c. Structures plan to obtain maximum number of client responses _____ d. Initiates proposals for changes in program when appropriate 2. Long term planning (e.g. semester) _____ a. Formulates reasonable long term objectives _____ b. Able to plan sequential steps to lead to long term objectives B. Therapy Execution _____ 1. Activities are appropriate for client’s objectives and abilities _____ 2. Uses appropriate language for client’s developmental and language abilities _____ 3. Elicits and cues client appropriately when needed _____ 4. Identifies target behavior _____ 5. Gives client sufficient time to respond _____ 6. Discriminates error from target behavior _____ 7. Uses appropriate correction techniques and feedback _____ 8. Demonstrates flexibility responding to client needs and improvises procedures when necessary _____ 9. Makes smooth transitions between activities _____ 10. Initiates contacts with other professionals involved with the client NA = Does Not Apply COMMENTS Semester: Fall 1 = Poor Spring Summer Year: 20_______ 2 = Needs to Improve 3 = Adequate 4 = Good Midterm/Final (Circle) 5 = Very Good C. Behavior Management _____ 1. Structures environment in order to facilitate optimal performance _____ 2. Deals appropriately with unacceptable behavior _____ 3. Develops strategies to deal with behavior issues NA = Does Not Apply COMMENTS D. Clinical Documentation _____ 1. Develops data collection procedures to measure client progress _____ 2. Collects accurate baseline measures _____ 3. Accurately records responses on-line during session _____ 4. SOAP notes completed independently 5. Demonstrates ability to interpret data for use in evaluating therapy progress and changes therapy plan accordingly _____ 6. Demonstrates ability to interpret data accurately E. Additional Practicum Responsibilities _____ 1. Prepares for supervisory conference _____ 2. Identifies alternative procedures during discussion of client _____ 3. Demonstrates ability to problem solve during and after session _____ 4. Recognizes own strengths, weaknesses and professional limitations III. ORAL AND WRITTEN REPORTING _____ A. Writes report with clarity and organizes information appropriately _____ B. Report contains pertinent, accurate, and complete information _____ C. Includes all necessary information with accuracy and completeness _____ D. Demonstrates ability to interpret information and make appropriate recommendations for the client’s needs _____ E. Appearance of report is professional (e.g. spelling, punctuation, grammar, neatness, proofreading, etc.) Score: Total points/# Items Scored ______/ 46 = ______ Strengths: Areas to improve: Suggestions for improving these areas: __________________________________/______ Student Clinician Date ____________________________/_______ Supervisor Date Semester: Fall Spring Summer Year: 20_______ Midterm/Final (Circle) CLINICAL EVALUATION FORM -- Level III (226+ hours) Clinical Supervisor Student Clinician Date _____________ Clinical Site # Clinical Hours Evaluated_______ 1 = Poor 2 = Needs to Improve 3 = Adequate 4 = Good 5 = Clinical Competence NA = Does Not Apply I. PROFESSIONAL SKILLS COMMENTS A. With Client _____ 1. Demonstrates initiative and independence _____ 2. Recognizes strengths, weaknesses and professional limitations _____ 3. Deals with attitudes displayed by clients _____ 4. Maintains confident, professional image in clinical setting _____ 5. Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences B. With Others (professionals and family members) _____ 1. Interacts appropriately with other professionals _____ 2. Able to handle confrontations _____ 3. Responds appropriately to feedback _____ 4. Presents appropriate information clearly _____ 5. Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences II. TECHNICAL SKILLS A. Therapy Planning 1. Daily Planning _____ a. Objectives and materials are appropriate _____ b. Establishes priorities _____ c. Evaluates and modifies program as needed 2. Long Term Planning (e.g. semester) _____ a. Applies theoretical knowledge of disorders to therapeutic practice _____ b. Incorporates prognostic indicators in long term planning B. Therapy Execution _____ 1. Uses language appropriate for client(s) _____ 2. Discriminates errors _____ 3. Creates maximal opportunities for client to communicate _____ 4. Gives consistent, concrete and concise feedback _____ 5. Encourages client to self-evaluate (as appropriate) _____ 6. Alters pace of session in relation to client needs _____ 7. Resolves unexpected problems _____ 8. Demonstrates flexibility in responding to client needs _____ 9. Initiates and pursues contacts with other professionals involved with client C. Behavior Management _____ 1. Initiates and carries through a behavior management program _____ 2. Systematically alters behavior program when needed Semester: Fall Spring Summer Year: 20_______ 1 = Poor 2 = Needs to Improve 3 = Adequate 4 = Good Midterm/Final (Circle) 5 = Clinical Competence NA = Does Not Apply D. Clinical Documentation _____ 1. Obtains and records accurate baseline measures _____ 2. Accurately records responses on-line during session _____ 3. Develops data collection procedures which measure client progress _____ 4. Demonstrates ability to interpret data for use in evaluating therapy/progress and changes therapy plan accordingly COMMENTS E. Supervisory Conference _____ 1. Prepares for conference _____ 2. Identifies alternative procedures _____ 3. Evaluates own clinical performance _____ 4. Identifies and implements strategies for improvement _____ 5. Requests help as needed III. ORAL AND WRITTEN REPORTING _____ A. Writes reports with clarity and organizes information appropriately _____ B. Report contains pertinent, accurate, and complete information _____ C. Makes appropriate, specific recommendations for the client’s needs _____ D. Overall appearance of the report is professional (i.e. spelling neatness, grammar, proofreading, etc.) _____ E. Completes reports independently and efficiently with minimal revisions _____ F. Oral case presentations are well organized, accurate, and professionally presented Score: Total points/# Items Scored ______/ 41 = ______ Strengths: Areas to improve: Suggestions for improving these areas: __________________________________/______ Student Clinician Date ____________________________/_______ Supervisor Date CLINICAL EVALUATION SCORING SYSTEMS Level I* (0 - 100 clinical hours) 5 = Very good. Displays minor technical problems which do not hinder the therapeutic process. Demonstrates the behavior consistently and frequently. 4 = Good. Frequently demonstrates the clinical behavior. Exhibits awareness of the need to monitor and adjust and make changes. Modifications are generally effective. 3 = Adequate. The clinical skill/behavior is emerging. Efforts to modify may result in varying degrees of success. 2 = Needs to improve. With supervisor input, implements the behavior/skill with difficulty. Efforts to modify are generally unsuccessful. 1 = Poor. The clinical behavior is not evident. Unable to modify behavior when directed by supervisor repeatedly. Little awareness of need to change behavior. Level II* (101 - 225 hours) 5 = Very good. Appropriately implements the clinical skills/behavior. Beginning to initiate some independent and creative problem solving. 4 = Good. Displays minor technical problems which do not hinder the therapeutic process. Beginning to show some independence and initiative in clinical duties. 3 = Adequate. Inconsistently demonstrates the clinical behavior. Exhibits awareness of the need to monitor and adjust and make changes. Modifications are generally effective. Demonstrates basic understanding of clinical problems and/or procedures. 2 = Needs to Improve. The clinical skill/behavior is beginning to emerge. Efforts to modify may result in varying degree of success. Incomplete understanding of clinical problems and/or procedures. 1 = Poor. Implements the skill with difficulty. Efforts to modify are generally unsuccessful. Level III** (226 + hours) 5 = Clinical Competence. Demonstrates professional/CFY level of competence in the area. Demonstrates independence by taking initiative and completing both assigned and unassigned duties. Demonstrates good understanding of clinical problems and meets the individual needs of clients. Displays superior competencies in ability to evaluate self/client accurately. Makes changes as needed. 4 = Good. Demonstrates independence but needs general direction from supervisor to improve clinical skills and to evaluate self/client accurately. Beginning to show initiative in planning and knows how to assign priorities. Thoughtful application of therapy techniques but needs further refinement in understanding of clinical problems or application of clinical procedures. 3 = Adequate. Needs general and some specific direction from supervisor to perform clinical skills and evaluate self/client accurately. Student demonstrates basic understanding of treatment principles and the needs of the client. 2 = Needs to Improve. Needs repeated specific direction and/or demonstration from supervisor to perform clinical tasks and to evaluate self/client accurately. Incomplete understanding of clinical problems, the needs of client(s) or treatment procedures. Difficulty in defining goals and/or assigning priorities for treatment. 1 = Poor. Specific direction from supervisor does not alter unsatisfactory performance skills. Despite repeated input from supervisor, is unable to alter own performance adequately. Unable to relate effectively with the client(s) and is inadequately prepared for sessions. Does not seek guidance or does not implement suggestions appropriately. *Adapted from Leith, McNiece & Fusilier (1989) **Adapted from K. Chapman (Dx format) and Chris McDonald/Mt. Sinai grading protocol SUPERVISORY EXPECTATIONS RATING SCALE SUPERVISORY NEEDS RATING SCALE DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATION SCIENCES CLINICAL CONTRACT Student _________________________ Semester/Year ____________________ Supervisor ________________________ Facility ________________________________ The following document is to be completed by the clinical instructor in consultation with the student clinician. The original is to be retained by the clinical instructor and returned to the Coordinator of Clinical Education, as quickly as possible. The student may wish to make a copy to serve as a guide. In addition to the general performance criteria outlined in the Semester Evaluation Form, this contract is designed to provide specific requirements for each practicum assignment. Revisions may be agreed upon during the course of the semester. Questions should be directed to the Coordinator of Clinical Education. Contract Points: STUDENT SCHEDULE (days/times): STUDENT RESPONSIBILITIES & TIME LINE (lesson plans, report due dates, lesson materials, outside readings, self evaluation, etc.): EVALUATION DATES/PROCEDURES (i.e., midterm eval): STUDENT CLINICAL GOALS: OTHER COMMENTS: We, the undersigned, agree to meet the above stated contract: Initial conference date ______________________ Student _________________________________ Instructor ______________________________ Case Western Reserve University Department of Communication Sciences EVALUATION OF CLINICAL SUPERVISOR (Adapted from Emerson College School of Communication Sciences and Disorders) Supervisor’s Name ______________________________ Term ___________ Student’s name (optional) __________________________________________ Number of clients for which supervisor is responsible _____________________ Please mark your degree of satisfaction with your supervisor in each of the following categories. Provide comments about supervisory behavior in the spaces provided. If you choose #1 or #2 as a rating, we strongly urge you to elaborate below the category or at the end of the form. Please return THE FORM TO THE COORDINATOR OF CLINICAL EDUCATION’S MAILBOX as soon as possible. Please make a copy to give to your supervisor during your final meeting of the semester. RATING SCALE-Select from categories 0-5 and insert number on blank line. 0-not applicable 1-not at all 2-less than adequate 3-adequate 4-better than adequate 5-very satisfied A. Discussion at the beginning of the term. 1. Did discussion of case help you prepare to begin therapy? ___________ 2. If you requested, were you directed to additional resources? __________ B. Case Management 1. Were case management conferences held regularly and on time? ________ 2. Did she/he help you formulate appropriate rationale for procedures? _______ 3. Did she/he provide adequate information regarding the therapy process? _____ 4. Did she/he provide adequate information regarding the diagnostic process (e.g. hypothesis formulation testing, standardized/non-standardized testing/analysis, family counseling, written report, etc.) __________ 5. Was supervisor’s involvement helpful in therapy sessions? _________________ 6. Was feedback regarding reports and lesson plans adequate and constructive? _______ 7. Did she/he appear knowledgeable about subject matter or willing to guide students to other sources? __________ 8. Do you feel your time in case management conferences was worthwhile? ___________ Comments: 1. Describe one or more aspects of your student-supervisor interaction that you found valuable. 2. Please provide one or more suggestions for improving your student-supervisor interaction. APPENDIX C: COSI 464 DIAGNOSTIC CLINICAL PRACTICUM REQUIREMENTS 1. Each student must participate in/complete 5 evaluations to receive a grade in COSI 464. 2. As students are primarily working in teams, student responsibilities will be divided as follows: a. Interviewer: Responsible for information getting and information giving interviews; Responsible for history, summary, prognosis and recommendations/plan of care section of report. b. Tester: Responsible for all standardized and non-standardized testing including hearing screening and oral mechanism evaluation. Responsible for scoring, interpretation of standardized and non-standardized assessments and those parts of the report. Roles will alternate weekly For those students not partnered, the supervisor may act as the partner for the first two-three weeks, or for the entire experience. This should be worked out according to the student's skill level and should be left to the supervisor's discretion. 3. Students are required to complete the long form of the evaluation report (see attached). The first draft should be turned in 48 hours after the evaluation. Requests for re-writes from the supervisor should be made in as timely a manner as possible. The goal is to have one week's diagnostic report out prior to the next diagnostic session. 4. Students should meet with their supervisors prior to the diagnostic, if possible, to review the diagnostic plan. Students should complete the case history review form to aid in this process. 5. Students should complete self supervision forms weekly. 6. Students should review test manuals and practice tests during the month of September. It is expected that students know that they are required to demonstrate proficiency with the tests in order to remain as part of the diagnostic team in each evaluation. Students should practice tests no less than 3 times prior to administering them to patients/clients. 7. Grades will be determined by the COSI course instructor. Please turn a copy of each diagnostic grade sheet in to her. CASE SUMMARY SHEET DOB/AGE: CLIENT NAME: FAMILY MEMBER: / CASE #: STUDENT CLINICIAN REVIEWING FILE: PHONE CONTACT MADE? YES NO (circle) REFERRED BY: STATEMENT OF PROBLEM(s): CASE HISTORY REVIEW Child currently communicates using (circle all relevant) Sentences Phrases Single words Vocalizations/gestures Medical History: Developmental History: Family/Social History: Other: AREAS TO BE EXPLORED FURTHER ISSUE OF CLIENT CONFIDENTIALITY Remember that all information obtained during the diagnostic process is confidential. That is, the information should not be discussed in public unless you have the written permission of the client/family. You may discuss issues related to the client with others (i.e., fellow students, faculty members), without mentioning personal information about the client (including name, address, phone, etc.) You can only discuss results and recommendations of the diagnostic with other professionals, when you have family permission. With each diagnostic, you should check to be sure that you have a signed release of information form (see attached). Ask the family if there are any other people who should receive a copy of the report. You might specifically ask if there is a doctor who should receive a copy, or whether the school should (as appropriate). SELF-CRITIQUE FORM Diagnostic Practicum Name: Date of Evaluation: Age of Client: Disorder: CLINICAL AREAS OF STRENGTH: CLINICAL AREAS TO IMPROVE: PLAN OF ACTION FOR IMPROVING AREAS OF WEAKNESS: DIAGNOSTIC SESSION SELF-SUPERVISION FORM (Leith, McNiece & Fusilier, 1989) CLINICAL LEVEL* DATE NAME SUPERVISOR AGENCY CLIENT *Clinical Level: B/beginning (0-100 hours); I/intermediate (100-200 hours); A/advanced (200-300 hours) P/professional: CFY or beyond NOTE: 1. Rate only pertinent behaviors. Use "Key to Clinical Competencies" to rate amount of supervision (S), first column, and quality of performance (P), second column. 5 = Very Good, 4 = Good, 3 = Satisfactory, 2 = Less Than Satisfactory, 1 = Poor 2. Numbers in () refer to the description of the particular behavior in the "Behavioral Descriptors." 3. SO = Significant Others 4. For rating conference, use Clinical Session Self-Supervision form, "C" items. PLANNING S P Did you read the case history and select an appropriate test battery? (5) Did you meet with the diagnostic supervisor before the diagnostic and present a rationale for a selected test battery? (5) INTERACTIONS Did you relate information to client/SO in an organized and professional manner? (10) Did you maintain a confident image with clients/SO/other professionals/fellow students during the diagnostic? (14) Did you interact appropriately with other professionals involved? (17) MANAGEMENT Did you manipulate the clinical environment so that it was conducive to testing? Did you present the test instructions/materials appropriately? (19) Did you effectively deal with any behavior problems? Did you use a consistent reward/penalty system? (20) Did you maintain the client's attention and motivation? Did your client exhibit approach motivation? (21) PROCEDURES Did you present instructions so that the client clearly understood the goals of the session? (22) Did you use rewards and penalties that were appropriate, consistent, verified? (30) Did you determine and implement an effective and accurate behavioral data collection system? (33) Did you administer all formal tests accurately and efficiently? (35) Did you demonstrate accurate clinical observation skills with sensitivity to and awareness of all relevant client behaviors? (36) Did you elicit and evaluate all appropriate speech/language/hearing behaviors? Did you accurately interpret test results and make all appropriate recommendations? (37) REPORT WRITING (38) Did you report formal and informal test results accurately? Did you describe all aspects of communicative behaviors using terminology that would be clearly understood by those reading it? Did you organize your report according to established guidelines? Did you use correct syntax, spelling, punctuation? Did you make recommendations and referrals that were appropriate, specific, and complete? Did you make necessary revisions and resubmit the report on time? OTHER DIAGNOSTIC RESPONSIBILITIES Were you prompt and professional in sending information to outside agencies/individuals? (42) Did you evaluate your own diagnostic performance and set goals for your professional development? (43) GOALS FOR DEVELOPMENT: INVENTORY OF DIAGNOSTIC SKILLS (Syracuse University: format adapted from the W-PACC/University of Wisconsin-Madison) Clinician Date Supervisor(s) Age(s) of Client(s) Preparation (score 1-5) Reads folder thoroughly Suggests appropriate evaluation procedures based on client information and knowledge of communication problem Is able to explain rationale for tests and procedures suggested Contributes equally to diagnostic team effort during pre-staffing Prepares diagnostic setting to meet client and observer needs Diagnostic (score 1-5) Establishes professional test atmosphere with client Explains rationale for assessment to client/family Explains rationale for assessment to client/family in language appropriate to their level of understanding Administers tests according to standardized procedures Administers tests in critically important order for client and problem Adaptability -- makes modifications in assessment based on client performance or parent information Administers appropriate feedback or reinforcement consistent with test procedures Increases/decreases rate of time for test administration Removes distracting items during testing Scores tests/records unobtrusively, accurately, quickly Handles and manipulates test equipment efficiently Uses language and intonation appropriate to the age and functioning level of the client Is able to informally assess (nonstandard measures) skills comparably assessed on formal measures Demonstrates trial teaching techniques within the diagnostic setting Interviewing (score 1-5) Begins and ends the interview gracefully Uses interpersonal skills/professional demeanor appropriate for informant Prepares the clinical setting for the interview Questions are formed clearly and are productive in terms of the quality/quantity of informant's response Sequences and switches topics smoothly Extracts pertinent/accurate information from the interviewer _____ Demonstrates sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences Postdiagnostic (score 1-5) Is able to interpret test findings Offers information or comments to team members based on own observations of client performance Qualifies assumptions with observed behaviors in report Is able to integrate information observations from team members Makes appropriate recommendations and suggestions based on diagnostic team findings Is able to relate interpreted test findings to family/client Reports information in written form that is accurate and inclusive Reports information in written form that is pertinent Incorporates recommended treatment/management suggestions in report Clinician self-evaluates strengths and weaknesses Personal Qualities (score S [Satisfactory], U [Unsatisfactory], I [Inconsistent], LI [Lack of Information], DNA [Does Not Apply]) Punctual for prestaffing Punctual for diagnostic evaluation Appears to recognize professional limitations Prepares for diagnostic by setting up materials and equipment Returns test equipment and materials after diagnostic evaluation Dress, voice and manner is appropriate for evaluation Meets deadlines for reports Rating Code: NA Not Applicable 1 Specific direction from supervisor does not alter unsatisfactory performance/evaluation skills; inability to make change. 2 Needs repeated specific direction and/or demonstration from supervisor to perform competently and evaluate self/client accurately. 3 Needs general and some specific direction from supervisor to perform competently and evaluate self/client accurately. 4 Demonstrates independence but needs general direction from supervisor to perform competently and evaluate self/client accurately. 5 Demonstrates independence by taking initiative; displays superior competencies and evaluates self/client accurately. *PREPARATION (P) *DIAGNOSTIC (D) ___ *INTERVIEWING (I) ___ *POSTDIAGNOSTIC (PD) ___ AVERAGE P + D + I +PD ___ PERSONAL QUALITIES SUMMARY Number of "SATISFACTORY" items ___ Number of "INCONSISTENT" items ___ Number of "UNSATISFACTORY" items ___ Number of "LACK OF INFORMATION" items ___ Number of "DOES NOT APPLY" items ___ *SCORE = SUM OF SCORED ITEMS / NUMBER OF ITEMS SCORED / = DIAGNOSTIC SKILLS DESCRIPTORS PREPARATION 1. Reads client folder thoroughly. • The clinician can extract and summarize pertinent and accurate information from available background information for supervisor/team members. 2. Suggests appropriate evaluation procedures based on client information and knowledge of communication problem. • The clinician is able to list and enumerate possible evaluation procedures specific to the problem. 3. Is able to explain rationale for tests and procedures suggested. • The clinician is able to explain why one assessment procedure is preferable over another, taking into account the following factors: o evaluation procedure(s) specific to problem(s) o validity/reliability of standardized tests o developmental age appropriateness o formal vs informal procedures o test is suitable in view of other handicapping conditions o knows when alternate form of test should be given 4. Contributes equally to diagnostic team effort during pre-staffing. • The clinician's verbal input is comparable to other team members' input. • The clinician evaluates and questions other team members' input. • Prepares a flexible outline for order of test administration. 5. Prepares diagnostic setting to meet client and observer needs. • • • • • The environment is pleasant to the eye (clutter free), distractable objects removed. The informant is made physically comfortable. Prepares diagnostic setting to meet observer needs. Materials/tests are readily available and organized. Audio/video taping equipment is set up. DIAGNOSTIC 6. Establishes professional test atmosphere with client. • The clinician introduces himself/herself. • The clinician engages in social conversation to reduce test anxiety if applicable. • The clinician briefly outlines the diagnostic format when appropriate. • The clinician demonstrates warmth, appropriate eye contact, ease and sensitivity to the client's feelings. 7. Explains rationale for assessment to client/family. • The clinician initiates an explanation of why a particular test is being given. • The clinician is able to answer client/family questions as to why a test is being given. 8. Explains rationale for assessment to client/family in language appropriate to their level of understanding. • Clinician defines terms, provides examples to facilitate parent/family understanding of diagnostic procedure(s). 9. Administers tests according to standardized procedures. • Clinician gives appropriate directions. • Clinician uses basal and ceiling levels. • Clinician adheres to time limitations. 10. Administers test in critically important order for client and problem. • Clinician administers tests most critical to assessing presenting problems when client is fatigued, disinterested, distractable, or physically limited (e.g., clinician adminsters auditory perception or discrimination tests after the client's auditory acuity has been assessed). • When appropriate, clinician adjusts or changes pre-staffing diagnostic outline. 11. Adaptability. Makes modifications in assessment based on client performance or parent information. • Clinician introduces or modifies type or schedule of reinforcement to increase client on-task behavior. • Clinician changes from using formal to using less formal assessment when client's off-task behavior increases. • Clinician discusses client's hobbies, skills, social interests to informally assess articulation syntactic structure, language comprehension, etc. • Clinician spontaneously introduces new procedures. 12. Administers appropriate feedback or reinforcement consistent with test procedures. • Clinician gives social approval ("good, that's a good answer:"), smiles, nods, encourages, ("try, just do your best," "you're dong well"). • Clinician reinforces on a variable schedule without patterning or cueing the client (e.g., nodding for only correct responses, allowing delay after incorrect client response for client to change answer). • Clinician may tally and show correct responses to client to reinforce on-task test performance. • Clinician knows when to use and change and/or eliminate token/food reinforcers when inappropriate to client's interest or developmental level. • Clinician is familiar with instructions for reinforcement when these are specified in the test manual. 13. Increases/decreases rate of time for test administration. Speeds up or slows down the "pace of the session. • When no time limit is specified for test/subtest administration, clinician modifies rate of test time presentation when appropriate. • Clinician allows reasonable time for client to respond after stimulus is presented. 14. Removes distracting items during testing. • No descriptors. 15. Scores tests/records responses unobtrusively, accurately, quickly. • Clinician fills in pertinent identification information on test form. • Clinician accurately scores tests according to test manual instructions. • Clinician scores both correct and incorrect responses to avoid cueing client. • Clinician relates information/data obtained to some standardized/developmental age reference norm. 16. Handles and manipulates test equipment efficiently. • Materials are organized sequentially for facile test administration. • Clinician knows how to operate test equipment (tape recorder, videotape, pitch meter, spectrogram, accelerometer, etc.) • Clinician co-ordinates test material presentation and scoring. 17. Uses language and intonation appropriate to age and functioning level of the client. • No descriptors. 18. Is able to informally access (non-standardized measures) skills comparably assessed on formal measures. • Clinician is familiar with source for developmental norms (e.g., phonological or language development norms). • Clinician records observations of client behaviors which are not being directly assessed. 19. Demonstrates trial teaching techniques within the diagnostic setting. • Clinician attempts to recommend management strategies/techniques based on observed test performance. • Clinician uses several methods/approaches to stimulate sound production. • Clinician models language structures to determine client's ability to acquire and retain skills on a short term basis. • Clinician presents same concept(s) through various modalities (auditory, visual combined) for suggestions for possible therapeutic approaches. 20. Begins and ends the interview gracefully. a. Beginning the interview • The interviewer establishes a professional/supportive atmosphere during the initial greeting (introduction). b. Ending the interview • The interviewer expresses appreciation for informant's cooperation. • The interviewer asks for further information/questions in relation to the problem. 21. Uses interpersonal skills/professional demeanor appropriate for informant. • Interviewer uses adequate eye contact. • Listens carefully and talks with the client, not at or down to the client. • Reacts appropriately during client expressions of emotion (responds to the emotion expressed rather than to the answer to the question). 22. Prepares the clinical setting for the interviewer. • The environment is pleasant to the eye (clutter free). • The informant(s) is/are made physically comfortable. • Audio-recording equipment is properly assembled. • Question guideline is prepared. 23. Questions are formed clearly and are productive in terms of the quality/quantity of informant's response. • Double or multiple questions are avoided. • Appropriate vocabulary is used; terms are defined when necessary. • Questions are not "leading" or "loading" (i.e., wording that would suggest what would be an acceptable answer). • An appropriate variety of questions are used, preferable open-ended ones. • The rationale for questions asked is understood by the clinician. 24. Sequences and switches topics smoothly. • Obtains neutral, factual information before emotionally laden information. • Follows a reasonable chronology of questioning. • Uses transitional statements when changing the topic or area of questioning. 25. Extracts pertinent/accurate information from the interview. • Probing questions are appropriately used to obtain information about a relevant topic. • Appropriate amount of time is spent for questions in important and less important areas. • The informant's interpretation of events is obtained. • Details are "pinned down" by relating events to significant family milestones. • Causal relationships are defined in terms of time and space. • Unobstrusive checking of inconsistent responses. • Gets the informant "back on track" without discouraging free expression. POST DIAGNOSTIC 26. Is able to interpret test findings. • Clinician scores test(s) before post diagnostic meeting. • Clinician correctly scores individual tests and procedures according to test standards. • Clinician takes into consideration additional factors (i.e., client's fatigue, attention to task, understanding of instructions). 27. Offers information or comments to team members based on own observations of client performance. • Clinician suggests management approaches, recommendations, or referral services based on client behavior which was observed or reported. • Clinician is able to make general summary statements about the client/family based on specific examples of client/family behavior. • Clinician can suggest if therapy or subsequent services are recommended based on client-demonstrated performance. 28. Qualifies assumptions with observed behaviors in report. • See 27 29. Is able to integrate informational observations from team members. • Clinician displays skills in integrating the information (informal/formal tests, case history, observations, previous evaluations) gathered to determine nature and severity of the client's problem. 30. Makes appropriate recommendations and suggestions based on diagnostic team findings. • Clinician displays skills in generating appropriate recommendations and possible referrals based on information gathered and on the needs of the client. • Clinician knows when to initiate these contacts with appropriate referrals. 31. Is able to relate interpreted test findings to family/client. • Clinician relates information using appropriate vocabulary, clear concise language. • Clinician displays skills in relating relevant and organized facts while counseling parents and/or clients. • Clinician displays skills in sequencing positive aspects of client behavior before negative. • Clinician is able to appropriately respond to questions asked by the parent/client in relation to his/her problem/prognosis. 32. Reports information in written form that is accurate and inclusive. • Clinician's first draft includes information that is well organized, chronologically appropriate and grammatically correct, concise, and clear. • Clinician summarizes all aspects of the diagnostic and integrates information given by additional team members. • Clinician researches the problem and reads sample reports before writing and handing in the report to the supervisor. 33. Reports information in written form that is pertinent. 34. Incorporates recommended treatment/management suggestions in report. • Clinician includes information concerning the types of tests (informal vs formal) administered, purpose of test, results, possible therapy plans and recommendations. • Clinician exhibits adequate theoretical background in the particular disorder. • Clinician suggests and specifies objective criteria for achievement of goals. • Clinician suggests appropriate type and variety of materials/programs. 35. Clinician self evaluates strengths and weaknesses. • Clinician is able to indicate assets of his/her diagnostic performance. • Clinician perceives areas for modification and suggests alternate ways of improving future performance. DESCRIPTION OF PROGNOSTIC LEVELS SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY and AUDIOLOGY In keeping with standards for increased accountability, it is necessary to provide for each client a prognosis for improvement. The words traditionally used to describe prognosis, along with a brief description, are as follows: Excellent - This prognosis statement indicates that the client has a high likelihood of improving significantly. All indicators are positive for significant improvement. This classification can be used for clients who may require only a short period of therapy. Good - Choosing this option indicates that the client can be expected to make reasonable progress toward improving functional communication. This statement may be qualified to state that the prognosis for achieving a limited set of goals is good. The person may have positive and negative influences on their likelihood to improve but a majority of the indicators are positive. Fair - This term may be used for the client that has a similar number of both positive and negative prognostic indicators. The person may still be considered a candidate for therapy if the clinician determines that improvement is possible. Poor - This term is used for the client who is not likely to demonstrate functional improvement from therapeutic intervention. This client has more negative than positive indices for improvement. This designation is used for the person who is not going to be enrolled in therapy or should be discontinued from therapy because he/she is not expected to continue to demonstrate progress. The clinician should provide the reason(s) for the poor prognosis. The following are a list of common influences on a person's prognosis for improvement: Age Severity of impairment Cognitive abilities including memory Oral/motor control Hearing status Visual impairment Motivation Level of family involvement Family attitudes Client's emotional reaction to disorder Auditory comprehension Auditory discrimination Pre-requisite language skills Health factors Intensity, duration of previous therapy Appropriateness of previous therapy Integrity of neurological system Integrity of oral/facial structures Psychological difficulties Ability to self-monitor Ability to self-correct Previous response to therapy Willingness to work on communication outside clinical setting Professional/personal reasons for wanting to change behavior Ability to attend sessions regularly Transportation readily available to attend sessions Time since onset of disorder Stimulability Non-verbal interaction with others Play behavior Response to clinician's cues Ability to focus attention Ability to sustain attention Ability to sustain attention with possible distractions Client willing to change aspects of lifestyle Pre-morbid personality characteristics Level of daily communicative interaction with others Interest in attending therapy Client's belief that therapy will result in improvement Environmental factors Interest in interacting with others Additional Audiology Prognostic Indicators -- In addition to the prognostic indicators given for speech and language clients, manual dexterity must also be considered for audiology clients, especially for the purposes of hearing aid and battery manipulation, sign language and Cued Speech use. In stating the audiology prognosis, indicate clearly which aspect of communication to which you are referring (e.g.: development of oral communication, use of a hearing aid or assistive listening device, progression of hearing loss, etc.). Use the terms "Excellent, Good, Fair or Poor" as described in the description of Prognostic Levels. The progress may also be described. "Guarded" if it presently appears "poor," but may improve significantly after either medical intervention or fitting of appropriate amplification. In the case of a client who requires medical evaluation or intervention, you may state that "the prognosis is being withheld, pending medical consultation." SEVERITY RATING INFORMATION This information serves to provide general guidelines for severity ratings assigned to clients with communication disorders. This information may be applied to categories of impairment, handicap and disability that you may encounter through various managed health care organizations. Within Normal Limits • No noticeable impairment in this area • This classification can be used for the following types of clients: 1. Proficiency in this area is technically within normal limits but is near the lower boundaries of what is considered normal. For a child, a recommendation may be to monitor and/or to follow-up with a consultation at some specified time in the future. 2. Someone who subjectively reports some effort in performing the skill but this difficulty is not evident to the listener. 3. Foreign dialect client whose dialect never or rarely interferes with intelligibility. Mild In general, a classification of either of the mild ratings indicates a disorder which may be evident but does not significantly reduce the ability to be an effective communicator. In other words, there is a disorder but it does not interfere with everyday, functional communication. For a child, this classification would include those who are six to eight months below age expectancy in functional communication ability. • Examples of the use of this classification include the following: 1. Disorder is noticeable to a trained listener, may not be apparent to casual observer in a limited context. 2. Persons who have difficulty only in a few specific demanding situations. 3. Persons who have no or little difficulty with everyday, functional communication but may experience minor difficulty in several demanding situations such as a high level contextual conversation or in the presence of competing stimuli. 4. Persons who require some increased effort to communicate resulting in rarely noticed reduced facility of speech/language without significant decrease in ability to comprehend and/or express wants and thoughts. Moderate In general, this category represents the level in which a disorder of comprehension or expression becomes a definite impairment in communication. However, the skill level still enables the communicatively-impaired person to effectively communicate in many structured and/or limited contexts. For a child, this level would be used to describe one who is eight to twelve months below age expectancy in functional communicative ability. • Examples of the use of this classification include the following: 1. A person whose disorder is readily apparent to even the casual conversational partner. The impairment makes it somewhat more effortful to communicate with the communicatively-impaired person. 2. A person who shares the burden of communication with the listener but the listener is still sometimes required to fill in the blanks. 3. A person whose disorder is readily apparent. This person’s conversation partner finds that it is effortful to communicate with the person, especially when not dealing with everyday topics or with unknown referent. 4. A child who is clearly below normal limits on a given communicative skill but retains enough functional ability in this area to get across basic wants and needs. 5. A communicatively-impaired person who shares the burden of communication with others at least half of the time. The conversational partner is often required to fill in gaps. Severe In general, this classification should be used to describe the client who often does not equally share the burden of communication with his/her partner. The person has limited ability to express basic wants and needs and is not usually able to participate in an actual conversation. The client’s prognosis for developing any of these skills may range from poor to good. For the child, this level would be used to describe the child who 12 months or more below age expectancy level for functional communication. • Examples of this classification could include the following: 1. A person whose communication impairment interferes with all but the most elementary and routine conversational exchanges such as responding appropriately to How are you? 2. A person who can only be understood in limited contexts with referent known. 3. A child or adult with limited ability to express basic wants and needs. May be able to communicate some desires via sample verbal or non-verbal means. 4. A person whose communication impairment makes it difficult to communicate even with routine exchanges. 5. A person who has difficulty being understood even in limited contexts with referent known. 6. A child or adult with limited ability to express even the most basic of needs by any means. Profound This category denotes no observable ability in functional communication. TERMINOLOGIES USED IN REPORT WRITING The following lists represent a compilation of commonly used terms noted in clinical reports. The lists are by no means complete, and are presented purely as an outline for use by beginning clinicians. It is to be used as a foundation from which to build a clinical report writing style. For logistic purposes, the terms have been placed under major headings; however, many may be used interchangeably depending upon the nature of the report being written. The Person You Work With the client the patient the child the youngster Johnny (child's name) Mr. Mrs. Ms. You the (this) clinician) the (this) therapist the (this) examiner What's Wrong? speech communication articulation language voice rhythm fluency hearing impairment distractible deviancy deviation problem disorder difficulty abnormality dysfunction anomaly defect What You Did the therapy the remediation the intervention the speech rehabilitation the assessment the testing the appraisal "Professional Tone Words" unremarkable baseline causal reinforcement determine projected informant feedback utterance performed production performance tasks data progressive nature outlook onset status congenital goals etiology characteristics objectives criterion generalized symptomatology administered skill ability verbalization carryover observations exhibits manifests demonstrates revealed occurred increased target behavior evidenced similar indicated improved contingent terminated behavior response impression judgment stated indicated parameter appeared reported Haynes, Hartman: "The Agony of Report Writing: A New Look at an Old Problem," JNSSHA, December, 1975. SPELLING (Misspelling is not one of the most serious errors to commit, but it is one of the easiest to avoid. Follow the first entries of different acceptable spellings in a recent edition of a dictionary. Inconsistency (for example, alternating between modeled and modeling or between cuing and cuing is distracting. Choose the preferred style and stick to it. Keep a record of accurate spellings of difficult words.) Style Sheet Suggestions absence deterrence abscess embarrass Caesarean exceed commitment grammar concomitant hemorrhage concurrence independent conscious likable consistent misspell counseled notable debilitating occurrence dependent parallel persistent personnel precede preference proceed recommendation recurrence repetition resistant separate unnecessary STYLE A. CLINIC TRADITIONS (Sometimes we need to write in a manner that is familiar and acceptable to all clinicians.) Draft: Mr. Ripley relies on information from his listeners to adjust his intensity. *** Draft: Lester has received speech therapy twice weekly since the second grade. His parents do not feel there has been any progress. Don't be redundant. Don't use more words than necessary. Don't be repetitious. It's highly superfluous. --- Anonymous 1. WORD REPETITIONS Sometimes a word or a form of a word is repeated unnecessarily; the reader's interest is dulled. Draft: Langley was hospitalized at age five for corrective heart surgery which because of complications necessitated the need of three operations. *** Draft: The Test for Oral Apraxia was administered. Jenny was capable of producing all the volitional movements adequately. Adequate velopharyngeal elevation on /a/ was observed. *** 2. IDEA REPETITIONS Sometimes several words are used to express essentially the same thought. Draft: There was no family history of prior speech problems. Draft: Jesse sometimes gets frustrated on occasion when he's misunderstood. *** Draft: Nina's father describes her as being very emotional and as displaying her feelings frequently. B. WORDINESS In progress reports the problem is how to make it look like you've been doing much more than you really have been all these months. The secret is long sentences, the longer and more complicated the better. This gives the reader the impression that at least you have been thinking about these things pretty hard, while at the same time you are tiring him out so rapidly that he doesn't have the energy to go back over it carefully and see exactly what you did. -- James Jerger 1. SUPERFLUOUS WORDS AND PHRASES In composing, as a general rule, run your pen through every other word you have written; you have no idea what vigor it will give your style. -- Sydney Smith Draft: Mrs. Fargut's oral structures were examined and found to be within normal *** Draft: Prognosis for this client is considered excellent. Draft: Her general health was reported as being excellent. *** Draft: Oral structures were within normal limits for the production of speech. *** Draft: Speech was found to be characterized by fillers and initial phoneme repetitions. Draft: I recommend contact with the teacher on a regular basis. ORGANIZATION/SEQUENCING The neck bone's connected to the collar bone, the collar bone's connected to the shoulder bone, them bones, them bones, them dry bones... -- Anonymous (Connect relevant statements and order the information so that the reader easily follows the report's progression.) A. SENTENCE LEVEL Draft: Therapy should focus on speech-rate reduction to improve intelligibility, eye-contact maintenance to improve listener involvement and over-articulation. B. PARAGRAPH LEVEL Draft: Therapy began when he was three; he was seen at home twice weekly by a private-practice clinician. Over the next fifteen years, remediation focused on developing lip-reading skills, correcting misarticulations, and improving intelligibility through exaggerated enunciation. Mr. Kellog's primary means of communication now is lip reading; he is also proficient in American Sign Language (ASL). He then received one semester of speech therapy in our clinic during his first year here at Boston University. 1. ACTIVE VOICE PREFERENCE The active voice normally is shorter, livelier and more direct. *** Draft: Edna was evaluated by the team in the fall of 1982. *** Draft: Her syntactic skills deficit was revealed through an occasional omission of articles. *** PASSIVE-VOICE JUSTIFICATION The passive voice is justified if the actor is less important than what is acted upon. Draft: I manipulated the variables to see if the direction of causation could be determined. NEUTRAL-COPULATIVE OVERUSE ...the sentence's verbal force has been shunted into a noun and for a verb we make do with "is," the neutral copulative, the weakest verb in the language. Such sentences project no life, no vigor. They just "are." -- Richard Lanham Draft: Another notable feature of the language sample was the use of attributes and possessives. COLLOQUIALISMS It is possible, of course, to be too casual in a report. Some words are better than others because they are correct, because they are right for the audience, or because they are preferred by most good writers. Draft: There was a large space between her teeth. OVERWEIGHT WORDS AND PHRASES at this point in time with reference to with respect to on the order of it is often the case that in the event that be of the opinion that due to owing to the fact that in spite of the fact that is indicative of had occasion to be take into consideration be in agreement be in possession give authorization give a description give instruction have a belief be cognizant be in accord have the capability present a picture similar to serve the function of being OFFICIAL ABBREVIATIONS A a aa AAxL ac accom ACTH ad ad lib AE AFB A/G Ratio AICA AIDS AKA AK ALL ALS AM AMA before of each anterior axillary line before meals accommodation adrenocorticotrophic hormone right ear as desired above elbow acid fast bacilli albumin, globulin ratio anterior inferior cerebellar artery acquired immunodeficiency syndrome also known as above knee acute lymphocytic leukemia amyotrophic, lateral sclerosis before noon against medical advice ambul amt ant AODM A&P repair aq aq dist ARD(S) AROM A/R pulse as ASA ASD ASCVD au AV AWOL Ax A2 ambulatory amount anterior adult onset diabetes mellitus anterior and posterior repair water distilled water adult respiratory distress (syndrome) artificial rupture of membranes apical/radial pulse left ear acetylsalicylic acid (Aspirin) atrial septal defect arteriosclerotic cardiovascular disease each ear; both ears arterioventricular defect absent without leave axis (in cylindrical lenses) aortic second sound B BAER Ba BCP BaE BE bid BIH BBB BK Bm MB (BMT) BP or bp BPH BRP BSO BUN Bx brainstem auditory evoked response barium birth control pill barium enema below elbow twice daily bilateral inguinal hernia bundle branch block below knee bowel movement bone marrow (bone marrow transplant) blood pressure benign prostatic hypertrophy bathroom privileges bilateral salpingo-oophorectomy blood urea nitrogen biopsy C c with CA cancer Ca calcium CABG coronary artery bypass graft CAD coronary artery disease cal calories CAT catheterize CBC complete blood count CBF cerebral blood flow cc cubic centimeter CC chief complaint CD constant drainage CHD congenital heart disease CHF congestive heart failure chr chronic Cl chloride CML chronic myeloid leukemia CMU cardia monitoring unit CMV cytomegalovirus CNS central nervous system c/o complained of CO2 carbon dioxide CO2 Comb Power carbon dioxide combining power conjunct conjunctiva cont continued COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease CP cerebral palsy CPK creatine phosphokinase CPR cardiopulmonary resuscitation CRF chronic renal failure CS Cesarean section C&S culture and sensitivities CSF cerebral spinal fluid CSR corrected sedimentation rate CVA cerebral vascular accident CVP central venous pressure CVS cardiovascular system CVU clean void urine Cx C xr Cysto D D/C D&C Dept DIC cervix chest x-ray cystoscopy Diff dil DIP div DL DOA DOE DPT Dr DTR dx discontinue dilatation and curettage department disseminated intravascular coagulation differential white blood cell count dilute Distal Interphalangeal Joint division danger list dead on arrival dyspnea on exertion diphtheria, pertussis, tetanus toxoid doctor deep tendon reflex diagnosis E ea EDC EENT EEG EGA EKG or ECG EMG ENG EOG ENT EOM Epis E/S ESR ETOH Exam ext each expected date of confinement Eye, Ear, Nose & Throat electroencephalogram estimated gestational age electrocardiogram electromyography electronystagmography electro-oculography Eye, Nose & Throat extra-ocular muscles episiotomy essentially the same erythrocyte sedimentation rate ethanol examination external F FT4I FB FBS Fe FH FHR fl FSH FUO origin FWB Fx G GH GI free thyroxine index foreign body fasting blood sugar Iron family history fetal heart rate fluid follicle stimulating hormone fever of undetermined or unknown full weight bearing fracture growth hormone gastrointestinal Gm GSW gtt GTT GU GVH Gyn gram gunshot wound drops glucose tolerance test genitourinary graft versus host gynecology H (h) or (H) h HA H&E HBP Hct HCVD Hbg H2O H2F hs hwb Hx hypodermic hour headache hematoxylin & eosin stain high blood pressure hematocrit hypertensive cardiovascular disease hemoglobin water high power field at bedtime hot water bottle history I ICA ICP IM inf inj int INO I&O IPPA IPPB IR irrig ITP ITT IUD IUP IV IVC IVP internal carotid artery intracranial pressure intramuscular inferior injection internal internuclear ophthalmoplegia intake and output inspection, palpation, percussion and auscultation intermittent positive pressure breathing infra-red irrigate idiopathic, thrombocytopenia purpura Insulin Tolerance Test intrauterine device intrauterine pregnancy intravenous intravenous cholangiogram intravenous pyelogram K K kg KUB potassium kilogram kidney, urinary and bladder L (L) lab LAD lat LBCD LBP LDH left laboratory left anterior descending (artery) lateral left border of cardiac dullness low back pain lactic dehydrogenase LE LED LF LFT lg LH LHRH liq LL LLL LLQ LMP LOA LP lph LUQ LVH LUL M MAxL MCA MCL DMCP MG Mg mg MGSO4 MGW enema lower extremity lupus erythematosus prep low forceps liver function test large luteinizing hormone luteinizing hormone releasing hormone liquid lower lobe left lower lobe left lower quadrant last menstrual period leave of absence lumbar puncture low power field left upper quadrant left ventricular hypertrophy left upper lobe MHB MI min ml mm mm HG mod MOM MRI MS MTP MWB mid-axillary line middle cerebral artery mid-clavicular line metacarpophalangeal joint myasthenia gravis magnesium milligram magnesium sulfate magnesium sulfate, glycerine and water enema maximum hospital benefit myocardial infarction minute milliliter millimeter millimeter of Mercury (for tonometry) moderate milk of magnesia magnetic resonance imaging multiple sclerosis metatarsophalangeal joint minimal weight bearing N Na NCV neg NG no non rep NPD NPH NTG NWB sodium nerve conduction velocity negative nasogastric tube number do not repeat no pathologic diagnosis neutral protamine Hagedorn (insulin) nitroglycerin non-weight bearing O O2 OA Obl OD OD Oint OOB OP OR ortho OS OT OU P P P P PO4 P2 PA PAP (smear) PAxL pc pc - 2 hr pc PDA PE PERLA PFT PH PI PICA PID PIP plt PM PMI PMP po POC POD pos Post Post-op PP PPD Pre-op prep prn PROM pro time PSP Oxygen occiput anterior (ROA & LOA = right or left OA) oblique (muscle) overdose right eye ointment out of bed occiput posterior (ROP & LOP = right or left OP) operating room orthopedic left eye occupational therapy each eye, both eyes pulse para after phosphorous pulmonic second sound posterior-anterior Papanicolaou smear posterior axillary line after meals specimen of blood drawn two hours after a meal patient ductus arteriosus physical examination "pupils equal + reactive to light and accommodation" pulmonary function test past history present illness posterior inferior cerebellar artery pelvic inflammatory disease proximal interphalangeal joint platelet afternoon point of maximal impulse previous menstrual period by mouth products of conception post operative day positive posterior following operation postpartum postpartum day or purified protein derivative prior to operation surgical preparation according to necessity premature rupture of membranes prothrombin time Pt PT PTT PWB PZI phenosulphonphthalein or progressive supranuclear palsy patient physical therapy partial thromboplastin time partial weight bearing protamine zinc insulin Q q 1 (2, 3) h q 15 m qd qhs qid QNS qod QOH or qoh qpr qs qw every 1 (2, 3) hours every 15 minutes daily every bedtime four times a day quantity not sufficient every other day every other hour at earliest convenience as much as necessary weekly R (R) R RBC RCA RCM RDS rec'd Reg RES retic count RHD RLQ RLL RML Epis ROM ROS R/T RTC RUL RUQ RVH Rx right respirations red blood count right coronary artery right costal margin respiratory distress syndrome received regular insulin reticuloendothelial system reticulocyte count rheumatic heart disease right lower quadrant right lower lobe right mediolateral episiotomy range of motion review of systems related to return to clinic right upper lobe right upper quadrant right ventricular hypertrophy treatment S s without SAH subarachnoid hemorrhage SC subcutaneous SDH subdural hematoma Sec second sed rate or ESR s edimentation rate SGA small for gestational age SGOT serum glutamic oxidase transaminase SGPT serum glutamic pyruvate transaminase SIDS sudden infant death syndrome (crib death) SLR straight leg raising sm SOB or sob Sol sos Sp Gr ss SS enema stat STS sup surg SVD syr small shortness of breath solution administer once if necessary specific gravity (and) one half soapsuds enema at once serological test for syphilis superior surgery or surgical spontaneous vaginal delivery syrup T T T4 T&A tab TAB TAH TBC TD temp TGV tid TP TPR PSH TUG TUR temperature thyroxine tonsils and adenoids tablet therapeutic abortion total abdominal hysterectomy tuberculosis tardive dyskinesia temperature transposition of great vessels three times a day total protein temperature, pulse and respirations thyroid stimulating hormone (test) Total Urinary Gonadotropins Transurethral Resection U UA UE UL ung URI US UT UTI UV urinalysis upper extremity upper lobe ointment upper respiratory infection ultrasound uterus urinary tract infection ultra violet V VC VD VER vert Vag Hyst VF VMA VNA VS VSD vital capacity venereal disease visual evoked response vertical vaginal hysterectomy visual fields Vanilyl Mandelic Acid Visiting Nurse Association vital signs ventricular septal defect W WA WBC while awake white blood count wgt wh WNL weight white within normal limits X x times - as prn x 6, or q 15 m x 8 FREQUENTLY USED SYMBOLS ↑ ↓ > < + = ♀ ~ ♂ % # o 1o 2o 3o ∆ ‘ “ c s increase; also ∧ decrease; also ∨ greater than; also ≥ less than; also ≤ positive negative equals female approximately male percent pound/number degree primary; first degree secondary, second degree tertiary; third degree change foot inches with without THE LANGUAGE USED TO DESCRIBE INDIVIDUALS WITH DISABILITIES John Folkins, ASHA Publications Board December 1992 This statement of principles is intended as a resource for editors and authors. It is advisory only; that is, none of the principles given should be considered to be binding rules for material published by ASHA. Principle One: Person First Language Use person-first language. Disabilities are not persons and they do not define persons, so do not replace person-nouns with disability-nouns.1,2 Avoid: “the aphasic” “the schizophrenic” “stutterers” “cleft palates” “the hearing impaired” Further, emphasize the person, not the disability, by putting the person-noun first. Use: “people with cleft palate” “the lawyer who has dyslexia” “persons who stutter” “the speech of children with language impairment” “the speech of individuals who stutter” Avoid: “cleft palate children” “the hearing impaired client” “the dyslexic lawyer” “the retarded adult” Is there a difference between “to be” and “to have”? Between saying a person “with a hearing loss” and saying a person “is hearing impaired”? Some have suggested that “to have” may imply possession and “to be” may imply identity.3 Thus they argue that it is less stigmatizing to use “have” than “be”. “The deaf” and “the speech of the deaf” also violate the person first rule. However, the community of persons who are deaf prefer to use deaf with a capital D to denote the Deaf culture and the Deaf community, not the hearing loss. As a general rule, we may wish to follow the preferences of a disability group, even if it violates other principles. The problems with following the desires of different groups occur when one doesn’t know what the members of a group want or when the preferences of individuals in a group differ. In my opinion, “stuttered speech” is okay. “Stuttered” describes the speech. “Cleft palate speech” is not ok, because the person (not the speech) has the cleft. However, “deaf speech” violates this rule, yet, many people believe that “deaf speech” is acceptable. Person-first language makes sentences more complicated. The consensus of the Publications Board on November 19, 1992, was that deviations from person-first language should be allowed in cases when the only alternative is awkward sentence structure. When publishing research reports in ASHA journals, it is important to describe individuals with sensitivity. There are no absolute rules in regard to what language is sensitive and what language is not sensitive. Clearly, the most appropriate approaches may differ across different circumstances and different types of publications. The clarity of research papers may be affected if one is required to use person-first language every time a group of subjects from a specific population is mentioned. One approach may be to describe populations with person-nouns first in the initial description of the subjects. Then one can refer to these descriptions throughout the rest of the paper. It is more important to use person-first language when describing individuals making up a group than when referring to the group. That is, although it may be preferable to say “the group of individuals who are dysarthric” than to say “the group of dysarthrics” when stylistically necessary, it may be appropriate to use “the dysarthric group”. The general rule is that person-first language is more important than group-first language. There are many examples in which we do categorize people and omit the person-noun and the personfirst position; for example, the audiologist (as opposed to “the person who performs audiological services”), the speech-language pathologist, the professor, the professional, the teacher, the grandparent, the leader, the pacifist, the hypocrite, et cetera. One could make the case that we should not categorize the person by these attributes. Yet, “the person who grandmothers” is difficult to support as an alternative to “grandmother”. When the categorizing is negative, person-first language might be preferable. “The person with a criminal record” may be better than “The criminal”. However, we may need to do the same thing for both positive and negative attributes. If we use person-first language only for negative attributes, then person-first language could take on a negative connotation. The way out of this is to assert that it is proper for society to categorize people without person-first language in many instances, but that disabilities are not one of them. Disabilities need not be defining characteristics in the way that a profession or role in society is. There are many circumstances in which it may be appropriate to use the terms, “disability”, “disorder”, or “impairment”. One needs to be sensitive to when it is, and when it is not, appropriate to use terms with a negative connotation. Principle Two: Disability versus Handicap Disabilities, disorders, or impairments can be caused by birth defects, illnesses, or injuries; but disability is a possible result, not a synonym, for the birth defect, illness, or injury.4,5 The public may have negative connotations for sickness and disease (e.g., diseases are sometimes contagious, disabilities are not). Inability differs from disability in that inability implies a total loss. The World Health Organization has explicit definitions that distinguish among disabilities, disorders, and impairments; however, for most purposes these terms are synonymous. Further, people have disabilities, not handicaps. Handicaps are social or environmental obstacles imposed by society on those with disabilities. To summarize: Disability, disorder, and impairment can be synonyms. Disability does not equal inability. Disability does not equal birth defect, illness, disease, or injury. Disability does not equal handicap. People do not have handicaps; society imposes them. Handicap is a useful term in golf and horse racing. Some writers don’t like “birth defect” and “congenital anomaly”. Congenital disability can be substituted if appropriate. A disabled computer, light switch, or bomb are objects that do not work at all. Here disability really does not imply inability. Principle Three: We all like to think of ourselves as normal Individuals with disabilities are “normal” in many ways. Referring to persons without disabilities as normal makes the inference that persons who have disabilities are abnormal.3 The term abnormal has a pejorative flavor. At the least, normal should be used only in regard to explicitly defined limits for specific attributes. Avoid: normals normal speakers the speech of individuals who are normal Use: the speech of individuals with no history of speech, language, or hearing impairment individuals who were judged to show no speech, language, or hearing impairment children with normally developing speech and language normal-hearing hearing sensitivity within normal limits normal speech (can be used when speech sounds normal and it can be produced in some instances by individuals with speech impairments) normal-language group (“group first” language is not always necessary) Principle Four: Avoid terms that project an unnecessary negative connotation It is desirable to avoid language that projects struggle, pain, or suffering when it is not necessarily part of the circumstances being described. When suffering is a part of the message to be conveyed, it is appropriate to use the term; for example, “tinnitus sufferer”. However, this may not always be clear-cut. For example, some groups suggest avoiding the term “hard of hearing” because it implies struggle. Other groups (e.g., the Commission of Persons with Disabilities”6 version 2 and presumably Self-Help for Hard of Hearing People, Inc.) prefer “hard-of-hearing” to either “hearing impaired” or “hearing loss”. Some authors have suggested avoiding the terms “dysfluency”.7 They prefer to use “disfluency”. They claim that “dys” has more of a pathological flavor. The prefix “dis” means apart from. The prefix “dys” means “difficult, painful, bad, or disordered”. This is clearly a judgment call and there is presently little consistency among authors.7,8 In general, avoid the following: 1,2,4,6,9 • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • patient (use client for most recipients of clinical services because patient may denote sickness or medical intervention, patient is appropriate for individuals who are patients in a hospital confined to a wheelchair, restricted to a wheelchair, wheelchair bound (people receive mobility from wheelchairs, not confinement) victim (this implies a desire for sympathy) cripple, crippled, the crippled, lame, the lame deformed (may imply ugly) deaf and dumb, deaf mute (needs no justification) afflicted with, stricken with, suffering from (say the person has) invalid (not valid) courageous, brave, inspirational (not all people with disabilities have these traits) unfortunate, pitiful, poor (condescending when used in reference to a disability) incapacitated (there are still capacities) retardate, mongoloid, idiot, moron, mentally deficient, mentally defective, imbecile, feeble minded (use “persons with mental retardation” or “children with developmental delay”) mentally deranged, mentally ill, mentally deviant, maniac, crazy, lunatic, mad (use “persons with a mental disorder”) deafening silence, blind rage, blind faith, turned a deaf ear, lame excuse (avoid metaphors with pejorative connotations) fit (use “seizure” when applicable, “Fit” may be an appropriate synonym for tantrum) spastic (use only to describe muscular spasticity, not all types of cerebral palsy involve spasticity, muscles are spastic--not people) hare lip (does not compliment people or rabbits. Use cleft lip) Principle Five: Don’t overdo it Be careful with the term “special”. In some respects, we are all special. From another perspective, people with disabilities are not necessarily special even if they are enrolled in “special education”. “Language challenged” or “hearing challenged” may imply that one needs to try harder than they are trying at present. Blatant euphemisms (differently hearing, physically different, differently-abled, speech inconvenienced, vertically challenged, horizontally challenged, chronologically gifted) don’t hide disability, but they can produce confusion. It is not more sensitive to refer to individuals who are physically within normal limits as temporarily able-bodied (TaBs) or momentarily able-bodied (MaBs).3 References 1. National Easter Seal Society, “Portraying people with disabilities in the media”. undated pamphlet. 2. National Rehabilitation Association Newsletter, “Language Awareness,” March, 1985, unauthored statement. 3. Journal of the Disability Advisory Council of Australia (formerly the Australian Rehabilitation Review), “The language of disability: Problems of politics and practice,” volume 1, issue 3, pages 13-21, 1988, no author listed. 4. Monjar, Stephen, “What do you say after you see they’re disabled?” The Rehabilitation Institute of Chicago, undated pamphlet. 5. National Easter Seal Society, “Awareness is the first step toward change: tips for disability awareness,” undated pamphlet. 6. Commission of Persons with Disabilities, Iowa Department of Human Rights, “Use words with dignity,” undated, unauthored one-page handout. There are two different versions of this handout. 7. Quesal, Robert, “Inexact use of ‘disfluency’ and ‘dysfluency’ in stuttering research.” Journal of Speech and Hearing Disorders, 53: 349-350, 1988. 8. Bernstein Rattner, Nan. “Response to Quesal: Terminology in stuttering research.” Journal of Speech and Hearing Disorders, 53: 350-351, 1988. 9. National Easter Seal Society, “Awareness is the first step toward change: tips for portraying people with disabilities in the media,” undated pamphlet. SAMPLE REPORTS CLEVELAND HEARING and SPEECH CENTER SPEECH/LANGUAGE EVALUATION NAME: ADDRESS: PHONE: PARENTS: REFERRED BY: CASE NO: 96DATE OF BIRTH/(AGE): DATE OF EVALUATION: CLASSIFICATION: CLINICIAN: student/supervisor REPORTS TO: SUMMARY OF FINDINGS Write a 1-2 paragraph summary which notes the primary areas of concern with severity ratings. Should address receptive language, expressive language (note how child communicates, i.e., single words, phrases, simple sentences), speech sound skills, oral mech, hearing. Be sure to address all relevant components of language. May also note areas of strength or areas of particular concern. This section should provide the reader (i.e., the referring physician) with a focused summary of the most relevant information. The information should lead the reader to accepting the recommendations that are written in the Plan of Care section. PROGNOSIS as indicated by . (Support your prognosis with The prognosis for improvement is factors which may affect improvement--i.e., consistent attendance in therapy, follow-through on goals in the home, family support, motivation, etc.) RECOMMENDATIONS/PLAN OF CARE 1. Receive therapy if appropriate and note possible broad areas of goals for intervention. If measures still need to be completed, include them here (i.e., hearing screening, oral mechanism exam, further analysis of spontaneous language, etc.). 2. May recommend follow-up by other professionals. 3. 4. FIRST PAGE SHOULD END HERE. EVERYTHING THAT A PHYSICIAN WOULD NEED TO KNOW SHOULD APPEAR ON THIS TOP PAGE OF THE DIAGNOSTIC REPORT. Page 2/Last name, first Case No: YRSpeech/Language Evaluation INCLUDE THIS HEADING ON EACH PAGE CASE HISTORY First sentence should be a "statement of the problem" that led the family to seeking the diagnostic (Example: John was referred for a speech/language evaluation due to concern about delayed communication skills/unintelligible speech, etc.). Then move into a brief summary highlighting relevant information. Case history section is typically 2-3 short paragraphs, unless you have a client with a significant history that requires a longer narrative. Organize your case history information into sections--one paragraph on medical history, one paragraph on developmental milestones, one possibly on family history. When you write these sections, introduce the topic of the paragraph to the reader (Example: In regards to medical history... A review of developmental milestones indicated... John currently lives with his ...). STANDARDIZED MEASURES Provide listing of standardized measures (also MLU, Play level) completed during diagnostic. TESTS/SUBTESTS STANDARD SCORE PERCENTILE INTERPRETATION RESULTS AND INTERPRETATION Start off this section with information on how long the diagnostic was and whether parent was in room or observing. Make comments on whether results are considered valid measures or preliminary measures of ability. This section includes your interpretation of the results. Organize the info into sections with subtitles if appropriate (For young children with limited Skills, this may not be needed.). Once again, introduce each paragraph with the topic to be discussed. Include interpretation based standardized measures, non-standardized measures, and information from parent interview. Your interpretation may include statements noting where the child should be for their age. Cognitive Skills -- Discuss your observations on cognitive skills based on the limited screening measures that you use. This section should give the reader an orientation as to whether the child appeared to be functioning at a level appropriate for their chronological age or not. If delays were noted across domains of learning, note this here. This section should help provide a baseline level for our expectations for communication skills. Receptive Language Expressive Language Speech Sound Skills Oral Mechanism and Hearing CASE DISPOSITION Note where case is in terms of agency status. Is case open and child on waiting list, is case being closed and client referred to another agency -- if so, note this. It is the responsibility of the clinician to follow a case until it is on the waiting list or closed. Your name, degree Graduate Student Clinician Supervisor's Name, degree, CCC-SLP Supervisor's title (ask them what it is) Ohio License SP-XXXX (ask them their #) SAMPLE REPORT -- SCHOOL AGE CLEVELAND HEARING and SPEECH CENTER Speech/Language Evaluation NAME: ADDRESS: Mike N. Olmsted, OH 44070 PHONE: PARENTS: Cindy REFERRED BY: Jane Doe CASE NO: 96DATE OF BIRTH/(AGE): 7-13-87 / (8;6 yrs. DATE OF EVALUATION: 1-26-96 CLASSIFICATION: Expressive & Receptive Language Deficit CLINICIAN: Suzie Q. REPORTS TO: Parents SUMMARY OF FINDINGS The results of the speech/language evaluation indicated that Mike has a moderate deficit in receptive and expressive language skills and a mild-to-moderate deficit in articulation abilities. Difficulties in attending to structured tasks were also noted. Mike showed age appropriate skills in both understanding and producing vocabulary at a single-word level. Deficits were noted in language comprehension when word relationships were explored beyond the single word level. Mike also performed below normal across expressive language tasks including sentence repetition skills, and on sentence formulation tasks. It is felt that weaknesses in oral language abilities have influenced Mike's ability to acquire written language skills. It will be important to focus on improving oral language skills while working on acquisition of reading and writing skills. Additionally, intervention strategies may need to be developed to increase Mike's ability to participate independently in structured tasks. In regards to speech sound skills, Mike's speech was mildly-to-moderately unintelligible due to decreased loudness and errors in production of the /r/ sound and r-blends (consonant and vowel combinations). An oral mechanism examination indicated that structures and functioning were generally adequate for speech production. Hearing was screened and found to be within normal limits. PROGNOSIS Prognosis for improvement is good if language intervention services are implemented in conjunction with a reading/writing tutoring program. Prognosis for improvement is dependent upon coordination of services and intervention strategies between the school, the home, and tutoring programs to maximize Mike's skill acquisition. RECOMMENDATIONS/PLAN OF CARE 1. Mike should be enrolled in speech/language intervention services focusing on improving both receptive and expressive language skills for a period of not less than six months. Prior to identifying specific intervention objectives, measures of Mike's spontaneous communication skills should be completed including evaluation of complexity of syntax, vocabulary, and narrative skills. Information on classroom communication patterns would also be useful. Services could be received through private sources or through the public school program. 2. This information should be shared with Mike's school program and with professionals involved in evaluating Mike's abilities. When a plan of action is developed for Mike, this information should be incorporated into the plan. Page 2/ , Mike Case No: YRSpeech/Language Evaluation CASE HISTORY Mike was referred for a speech/language evaluation due to concern about his performance at school. Recently, the North Olmsted school district requested a multi factored evaluation of Mike (including an evaluation of speech/language skills), which the parents have elected to have completed outside of the school system. Specific concerns include significant difficulties with reading skills. Cindy, Mike's mother, reported that he has shown a consistent pattern of being slow to acquire skills, but then reaches the level of his peers over time. A speech/language evaluation was sought in order to rule out speech and hearing difficulties as influencing factors on Mike's reading skills and academic performance. Mike's initial school experiences were in a Montessori-based program for two years of preschool and kindergarten. During the last year of Montessori programming, concerns were expressed about Mike's skills in pre-reading areas. In the Montessori program, Mike was exposed to pre-reading skills using a phonics approach. When Mike was enrolled in the public school program in first grade, concerns about reading difficulties were noted immediately. Cindy initiated reading tutoring privately in December of that year and the tutor used a sight word approach, which Mrs. now feels may not have been the best option for Mike with his Montessori background. The reading tutoring continued through summer of 1995, but stopped in the fall. A new reading tutor has recently been hired who is trained in a method called "Reading Recovery." She is currently working with Mike three times per week. According to Cindy, the tutor is optimistic that Mike will have grade appropriate reading skills (beginning third grade level) by next fall, if Mike continues to progress at his current rate in the tutoring program. Case history review indicated that Mike has had no serious medical conditions, except for a few bouts of otitis media as a young child. Language milestones have been consistently slow with phrases and sentences not produced until he was three years old. Motor skills have developed within normal limits. Mike is the youngest of four children. He lives with his brothers, mother and stepfather in North Olmsted. STANDARDIZED MEASURES Clinical Evaluation of Language Fundamentals-Revised (CELF-R) Standard Score Subtests Oral Directions 8 Word Classes 6 Semantic Relationships 6 Percentile 25th 9th 9th Formulated Sentences Recalling Sentences Sentence Assembly 7 5 6 16th 5th 5th 3 2 2 Composite Scores Receptive Language Expressive Language 78 73 7th 4th 2 1 Age Equivalent Score: 6;2 years Peabody Picture Vocabulary Test-Revised (PPVT-R) Standard Score: 104 Percentile: 61st Age Equivalent: 9;1 years Stanine: 6 Expressive One-Word Picture Vocabulary Test (EOWPVT-R) Standard Score: 100 Percentile: 50th Age Equivalent: 8;6 years Stanine: 5 Page 3/ Stanine 4 2 2 , Mike Case No: 96Speech/Language Evaluation RESULTS AND INTERPRETATION Mike was seen for a two-hour speech/language evaluation. He was accompanied to the evaluation by his mother and step-father, who observed the evaluation through the two-way mirror. During the evaluation, it was frequently necessary to re-direct Mike's attention to the structured tasks. He often requested to go see his mother, and visited the restroom for long periods of time on three occasions during the two-hour period. (Mrs. noted that Mike may have had a stomach bug that morning, but that extensive bathroom visits are common for him in the home and at school). Compared to other children his age, Mike showed difficulties being able to attend to the structured tasks. Fewer activities were completed in the two hour period than are typically accomplished with a second grader. Mike's difficulties attending to the structured tasks seemed to be related motivation rather than to actual attention difficulties. Children with language deficits often experience motivational difficulties with language tasks, because the tasks are difficult for them to participate in; therefore, avoidance techniques (i.e., leaving the room) may be used. Despite motivational influences, the results of the measures are considered valid measures of Mike's current skills. As a whole, the results of the speech/language evaluation indicated that Mike has moderate deficits in both receptive and expressive language domains. Additionally, he showed a mild-to-moderate deficit in articulation Skills. In order to interpret the language measures accurately, it is necessary to have an I.Q. measure to use as the baseline expectation level. For purposes here, it will be assumed that Mike's I.Q. is at an average level (100). When the psychological test results are available, it may be appropriate to alter this interpretation of the language scores in relation to actual I.Q. measures. Language Comprehension Skills Language comprehension measures indicated that Mike's understanding of single-word vocabulary, as measured by the Peabody Picture Vocabulary Test (Revised), was an area of strength. Mike performed within normal limits with a score just above expectations for his age level. Mike's mother and step-father confirmed that vocabulary skills are an area of strength for him. Receptive single-word vocabulary skills were stronger than expressive single-word vocabulary abilities. Mike also performed within normal limits on the Oral Directions subtest. He was able to follow commands that included identification of at least two shapes described with one to three descriptors each (e.g., "Point to the small white square and the last little triangle). On this task, oral directions are evaluated in a context requiring knowledge of only a few linguistic concepts (e.g., shapes, colors, sizes, location (first, last), and the subtest measured Mike's ability to follow commands of increasing length. Mike was able to follow these types of commands without difficulty. Moderate deficits in language comprehension were experienced when vocabulary skills were evaluated further. Difficulties were noted when semantic skills were evaluated beyond a single-word level. Mike performed below normal limits on one task that required him to identify tow related words from a set of four words (e.g., find the two that go together: down old thin up). On this task, Mike was orally given the four words. Identification of the two correct items require that Mike retain the four target words and identify which two had some type of relationship to one another (synonyms, antonyms, or similar concepts). When Mike experienced difficulty, he often repeated to last two items (on 9/14 incorrect responses). On another receptive semantic task (Semantic Relationships), Mike showed significant difficulties across all four types of semantic concepts assessed (comparatives, spatial, passive, and temporal). Weaknesses in completing the tasks could have been related to difficulties with the task and/or difficulties with the concepts being measured. However, since Mike was able to follow long commands on the Oral Directions subtest where vocabulary was controlled, it was felt that difficulties here were related to weaknesses in utilizing more abstract semantic concepts in problem solving situations. In summary, Mike showed age appropriate skills in comprehension of single-word vocabulary and comprehension of commands of increasing length with controlled vocabulary. Significant weaknesses were noted in word knowledge beyond the single word level. Difficulties were most apparent when Mike had to retain items and indicate concepts related to word relationships. On the receptive language composite score of the CELF-F, Mike performed more than one standard deviation below normal. Deficits in comprehension of oral language could impact on Mike's ability to comprehend information in written language as well. Expressive Language Skills Similar to language comprehension results, single-word vocabulary knowledge was an area of strength in expressive language. Mike performed at an average level for his age level in identifying pictures with a single word label. Significant deficits were noted on expressive language measures on the CELF-R where language expression skills were measured at a sentence level. Mike performed more than one standard deviation below normal (Standard Score 74; 4th percentile) indicating significant deficits in this area. Mike showed difficulties repeating sentences verbatim, often altering vocabulary items and grammatical markers while retaining meaning. He also showed difficulty making sentences from scrambled phrases, when required to provide at least two versions. On the Formulated Sentences subtest, Mike was asked to make a complete sentence that went with a picture using one or two target words in the sentence. He typically responded with an incomplete phrase, rather than providing a complete sentence. There was limited opportunity to measure Mike's spontaneous communication skills. Observations indicated that his sentences were complete grammatically and that ideas were sequenced adequately. It was not possible to determine whether vocabulary skills were adequate and whether Mike was utilizing complex syntax constructions in his sentences. Parent report indicated that in conversation Mike is able to express his ideas clearly, that he provides details and that he is able to retell past events without difficulty. It should be noted that students with semantic deficits are typically able to express their ideas in a correct sequence, but they tend to provide reduced information (details, specifics) even when prodded to provide more information. Before specific language objectives are defined for Mike, it is recommended that measures of his spontaneous communication skills be completed. In summary, expressive language skills were moderately delayed compared to age level expectations on standardized measures. Such expressive language deficits have likely contributed to Mike's difficulties in acquiring written language skills. An additional concern from this evaluation is Mike's ability to attend to and participate in structured tasks. Difficulties on the day of the evaluation in a one-on-one context, suggested that such attention and participation in structured tasks may be of even more concern in a classroom where there are more children and less adult attention. As noted, motivation may have played a role during this evaluation. It is also possible that Mike's difficulties in attending to and participating in structured tasks are influenced by weaknesses in language comprehension and production. Participation in language activities may elicit decreased willingness to participate, because these activities are difficult for Mike. Such factors could influence classroom performance, where so many academic tasks require adequate language skills. Another factor that may contribute to difficulties is social maturity, which may influence ability to participate in tasks more independently. It was felt that Mike appeared less mature socially than other boys his age. While it may not be possible to determine how all these factors inter-relate to one another, it will be important to identify multiple factors which may contribute to or diminish Mike's ability to perform successfully in class. Discussions about intervention strategies should attempt to identify influencing factors and help to shape Mike's skills and coping strategies to maximize his performance. Speech Sound Skills, Ora; Mechanism and Hearing Spontaneous measures of Mike's speech sound abilities were completed during the evaluation. Mike's speech was often unintelligible due to decreased loudness. Mike incorrectly articulated the /r/ sound and produced consonant blends with the /r/ incorrectly, reducing the sound to a single vowel. Stimulability testing produced vowel + r combinations incorrectly, reducing the sound to a single vowel. Stimulability testing indicated that he was able to produce the /r/ at a sound level correctly with a model and could inconsistently produce single syllables with an initial /r/. He could not imitate words with an initial /r/ correctly. It is felt that Mike has a good prognosis for improving his speech patterns if speech therapy services are initiated. It is also felt, however, that Mike's language deficits are of more concern, at this time, than his inaccurate production of /r/ sounds. An examination of Mike's oral mechanism indicated that structures were adequate for speech production. Mike showed some difficulties in rapid movements of the tongue and lips. Slowness was noted in lateral movements of the tongue outside of the mouth and movement of the articulators during attempts to elicit rapid syllable patterns. Mike's speech, however, was intelligible the majority of the time; thus, it is not felt that there are any significant deficits in speech production skills. Mike's hearing was screened and found to be within normal limits. There are not concerns with hearing abilities at this time. CASE DISPOSITION The results of the evaluation will be discussed with Cindy . Attempts have been made to reach her by phone. This case will remain open; if no further services are needed within a month, this case will be closed. Mike's parents should feel free to contact this clinician at any time in the future for assistance as needed. M.S., CCC-SLP Pediatric Program Specialist Ohio License SPXXXXX SAMPLE HOSPITAL REPORT , John CLIENT: D.O.B.: 9-29-88 DATE OF EVALUATION: 9-27-90 SUMMARY OF SPEECH/LANGUAGE EVALUATION John was seen for a speech/language evaluation due to concern about delayed vocabulary development. John has a history of middle-ear infections and extensive hospitalizations due to nutritionally related medical factors. The speech/language evaluation was conducted using standardized testing, spontaneous communication measures and parent report. On the expressive subtest of the Battelle Developmental Inventory (BDI), John obtained an age equivalent score of 14 months, which was at the first percentile compared to other children his age. John communicated primarily using complex gestures and sounds. Sound productions consisted of CV and reduplicated CVCV syllables as well as the use of isolated consonant sounds. Sounds noted during the evaluation were used occasionally but not consistently. Mrs. W reported that words are often used for a period of time and then disappear from use. Language comprehension skills were estimated using the BDI and found to be at a 21-22 month level, which was at the 27th percentile compared to other children John's age. John was able to follow simple commands and to locate a variety of familiar objects, He also demonstrated comprehension of the possession relation (e.g., mama's nose vs John's nose). Mrs.W noted that at home John's comprehension of familiar routines is excellent. John demonstrated the use of multiple play sequences and extended play sequences to other agents (i.e., combed mom's hair). Thus, his play skills appeared to be age appropriate, suggesting no concerns about his cognitive skills. John presented as a child with specific language impairment. That is, his development across skills appears to be age appropriate except in the domain of communication Skills. It is felt that his extensive medical difficulties, including frequent hospitalizations as well as the ear infections, may have contributed to his language delays. However, they most likely did not cause the deficit. RECOMMENDATIONS on 10-2-90. The following recommendations The results and recommendations were discussed with Mrs. were made: 1. John should be enrolled in speech/language intervention services one to two times per week for a minimum of six months. The focus should be on developing an expressive vocabulary through direct services and parent training. should try to use one and two words when communicating with their son. That is, 2. Mr. and Mrs. they should focus on modeling single word productions. Additionally, play activities should focus on imaginative play and sequences of play within a related scheme (i.e., having Fisher Price man buy gas, then drive to mall, then buy ice-cream cone in the mall). CASE DISPOSITION elected to receive speech/language services through Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center even Mrs. though that would require a long drive for the family. Mrs. will initiate services by contacting this clinician directly when John is recovered from his most recent surgery. M.S., CCC-SLP Pediatric Program Specialist Ohio License SP CLEVELAND HEARING and SPEECH CENTER SAMPLE SPEECH LANGUAGE CONSULTATION #1 NAME: ADDRESS: C Willoughby OH 44094 PHONE: 440 REPORTS TO: Mother CASE NC.: 96BIRTHDATE/(AGE): 04/19/85 (11;2) DATE OF EVALUATION: 06/19/96 CLASSIFICATION: Fluency CLINICIAN: Suzie Q. EVALUATION SUMMARY This consultation revealed a severe fluency disorder. Core behaviors consisted of sound and syllable repetitions. Secondary behaviors consisted of had nodding, eye blinking, and finger rubbing. C was very polite but somewhat reticent when discussing his stuttering. Receptive and expressive language skills were not evaluated. Articulation skills were recently assessed by the Speech-Language Pathologist with the Schools; however, no formal report was available. During this consultation, C was observed utilizing /w/r/ substitutions and an occasional distortion of /s/. An oral mechanism examination revealed structures and functions adequate for speech sound production. A hearing screening revealed hearing acuity within normal limits PROGNOSIS Prognosis for increased fluency is good with consistent therapy. RECOMMENDATIONS/PLAN OF CARE 1. Enrollment in one hour individual therapy per week for a minimum of six months to target fluency shaping techniques (diaphragmatic breathing, pre-voice exhalation, and easy vocal onset), and elimination of secondary behaviors. 2. Enrollment in one hour group therapy per week targeting feelings and attitudes toward stuttering. This group therapy will also facilitate transfer. 3. To coordinate the services received at Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center with the services C will be receiving through his IEP for the 1996-97 school year. ,C Speech-Language Evaluation June 19, 1996 Page - 2 STATEMENT OF PROBLEM/HISTORY C, age 11 years 2 months, was seen at the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center on June 19, 1996 as part of the summer fluency program. C was enrolled in the summer fluency program in order to continue speech remediation during the summer months. He was accompanied by his mother and father. C has been receiving speech therapy for stuttering and articulation. He stated that during therapy, he worked on elongating and pull-out and to breathe before every sentence. C stated that he felt these techniques did help him to be more fluent. CLIENT / PARENTAL INTERVIEW C, as well as his mother and father, stated that his stuttering was worse when he talks in front of the class, reads out loud, or talks to strangers. C feels that he stutters everyday and ranks his stuttering at this time as a A5" on a ten-point scale (10 = severe, 1 = fluent). His parents added that there are days as well as periods when he is much more fluent and when he is extremely disfluent. He expressed having the most difficulty when speaking to strangers and when saying “w” words. C stated that if he kept his answers to a yes or no response in class, that he did not stutter. C’s mother and father have noticed that he is more disfluent when he is tired or nervous and he avoids placing his own orders with the server at restaurants. C employs a constructive strategy when he is teased at school; he informs the teachers so they can speak with the offending children. He expressed feeling sad and mad when he is teased. C stated that when he stutters in front of his friends, they just try to listen. When someone tries to help him finish a word or sentence, C lets them do it but he doesn’t like it. He stated that it upsets him. C stated that his mother, father and brothers are very supportive. He commented that it is easier for him to speak at home with his family than with others outside the home. The family does discuss C’ s stuttering openly in the home when the subject arises. During the moment of stuttering, C stated he feels tight and “like you just want to get the word out.” When asked if he really wanted to be here, he replied no because it’s summer and he just wants to have fun. STANDARDIZED TEST MEASURES A baseline was obtained using the CAFET diagnostic program in order to measure C’s breathing and voicing pattern. Characteristics breath groups/min. % voiced cycles % v.c. with held breath % v.c. with speech onset delay Ave. % of phonation breaks % speech time % v.c. with low air Spontaneous Speech 22.1 91.8 16.1 12.0 18.1/min. 46.0 41.1 Oral Reading 24.3 100.0 2.7 0.0 5.6/min. 88.8 30.1 During six (6), one-minute spontaneous speech samples, C was found to hold his breath during speech, exhibit delayed voicing, and speak on low air. He demonstrated several phonation breaks within a breath and had a low percentage of talk time. Based upon normal criteria, C’s test results for percentage of breath holding, low air, and delayed onset of voicing were all significantly above normal. His percentage of talk time was below normal. His oral reading results were much better, possibly reflecting previous therapy which utilized reading for a therapy medium. His number of breath groups were within normal limits; however, he still exhibited a significant percentage of speaking on low air. This would indicate that C tends to breath very shallow, perhaps using clavicular or thoracic breathing rather than diaphragmatic. The Stuttering Severity Instrument (Riley, 1972) Job task: percentage Reading task: percentage 37% 35% score 9 score 9 ,C Speech-Language Evaluation June 19, 1996 Page - 3 Duration: Physical concomitants: 10 to 30 seconds eye blinking head nodding finger movement Total overall score: Severity: 30 Severe score 5 The spontaneous speech sample and reading samples were characterized by mainly sound repetitions and occasionally syllable repetitions. The repetitions would often last 10 to 30 seconds in duration. Secondary characteristics during the spontaneous sample consisted of eye blinking, head nodding, and finger rubbing. C’s stuttering decreased slightly during the reading task. C appeared to have a significant amount of difficulty with words that began with /w/. This also includes any words beginning with /r/, since C substitutes /w/ for /r/. Words beginning with “wh” also appear to cause a great amount of difficulty. Additional Testing An informal assessment of C’s receptive and expressive language abilities was conducted and they appeared to be within normal limits. Articulations skills were not re-evaluated during this consult. However, words beginning with /r, s, w/ and “wh” were targeted in isolation and in sentences. In the pre-diagnostic questionnaire completed C and Mrs. B, they had indicated an increased amount of difficulty in articulation as well as disfluency of words beginning with those sounds. The informal assessment revealed a /w/r/ substitution and an occasional slight distortion (lateralization) of /s/. C demonstrated 90 - 100% disfluency in words and sentences in which he articulated “w” (w, r, wh) as the initial phoneme. An oral mechanism examination was conducted and all structures and functions appear to be within normal limits. A hearing screening revealed hearing to be within normal limits. CASE DISPOSITION Results of this evaluation were shared with C and his parents. Mr. and Mrs. B have expressed an interest in enrolling C in the Summer Fluency Program at the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center. C has been enrolled in one hour individual and one hour group therapy for the summer session. This case is open. Suzie Q., MA, CCC-SLP Speech-Language Pathologist Ohio License SP # Graduate Student Case Western Reserve University CLEVELAND HEARING and SPEECH CENTER SAMPLE SPEECH LANGUAGE CONSULTATION #2 NAME: ADDRESS: X Cleveland OH 44106 PHONE: 216 REPORTS TO: Mother CASE NC.: 96BIRTHDATE/(AGE): 02/13/82 (14;4) DATE OF EVALUATION: 06/18/96 CLASSIFICATION: Fluency CLINICIAN: Suzie Q. EVALUATION SUMMARY This consultation revealed a moderate fluency disorder. Core behaviors consisted of blocks characterized by increased upper body, neck and facial tension. Secondary behaviors consisted of leg movements, hand slapping, finger movements, and jerking back into the chair. X was fairly sociable and very willing to talk about his stuttering. Receptive and expressive language skills were not evaluated. Articulation skills recently assessed by the Speech-Language Pathologist with the Schools were reported to be within normal limits. An oral mechanism examination revealed structures and functions adequate for speech sound production. A hearing screening was not conducted due to time constraints. PROGNOSIS Prognosis for increased fluency is good with consistent therapy. RECOMMENDATIONS/PLAN OF CARE 1. Enrollment in one hour individual therapy per week targeting fluency, shaping techniques (diaphragmatic breathing, pre-voice exhalation, and easy vocal onset), and elimination of secondary behaviors. 2. Enrollment in one hour group therapy per week targeting feelings and attitudes toward stuttering. This group therapy will also facilitate transfer. 3. To conduct a hearing screening within a therapy session in order to confirm normal hearing. 4. To assist Mrs. B in obtaining additional speech services in his new school for the 1996-97 school year. , X Speech-Language Evaluation June 18, 1996 Page - 2 STATEMENT OF PROBLEM / HISTORY X, age 14 years 4 months, was seen at the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center on June 18, 1996. The appointment was made by his mother due to an increase in his disfluencies over the past few months. He was accompanied by his mother and his best friend, R. X received speech therapy for stuttering during third and fourth grade through his school. According to his mother, the speech therapist referred to X’s disfluencies as “blocks.” He stated that during therapy, he was asked to read and talk out loud while using the fluency strategies he had been taught. The strategies were to stop and start again when he stuttered. X stated that he felt these techniques did not help him with his disfluencies. CLIENT / PARENTAL INTERVIEW X and his mother both stated that his stuttering has increased in the past few months, especially when he reads out loud, talks on the phone, or gives a speech in class. X feels that he stutters a little everyday but ranks his stuttering at this time as a A7" on a ten-point scale (10 - severe, 1 = fluent). He expressed having the most difficulty when speaking to strangers and during classes. X did state that if he kept his answers short in class, he was more fluent. Neither his mother nor X have noticed any differences in X’s stuttering when he is tired, angry, happy. X maintains a healthy attitude about his stuttering even though he has occasionally been teased by school mates and received a poor grade on an oral report given for speech class this year. X expressed feeling nervous before he gave his report. After receiving his grade from his teacher, he attempted to explain to her that he stutters. However, X states that the teacher did not accept his explanation and the grade the same. During the moment of stuttering, X stated that he feels like he can’t breathe. He also agrees that he has tension in his chest and head. He said that sometimes after he stutters that his head hurts. X has expressed a desire to enroll in speech therapy at this time. STANDARDIZED TEST MEASURES A baseline was obtained using the CAFET diagnostic program in order to measure X’s breathing and voicing patterns. Characteristics breath groups/min. % voiced cycles % v.c. with held breath % v.c. with speech onset delay Ave. % of phonation breaks % speech time % v.c. with low air Spontaneous Speech 7.6 64.5 60.0 5.0 22.3/min. 48.4 20.0 Oral Reading 10.3 100.0 32.2 51.6 7.3/min. 36.5 25.8 During three (3), one-minute spontaneous speech samples, X was found to often exhale rapidly during a block, speak rapidly on low air, or hold his breath during his speech sample. He demonstrated several phonation breaks within a breath and had several delayed voice onsets. Based upon normed criteria, X’s test results for percentage of breath holding, low air, fast air flow, and delayed onset of voicing were all significantly above normal. His percentage of talk time was below normal. The Stuttering Severity Instrument (Riley, 1972) Job task: percentage 20% Reading task: percentage 23% Duration: 2 to 9 seconds Physical concomitants: jaw muscles tense poor eye contact leg, finger, and body movements Total overall score: 23 score 8 score 8 score 4 _______, X Speech-Language Evaluation June 18, 1996 Page -3Severity: Moderate The spontaneous speech sample and reading sample were characterized by inaudible blocks of approximately 2-9 seconds duration. Secondary characteristics during the spontaneous sample consisted of eye movements directed up and away from the listener, repetitive “together then apart” leg movements, and flicking-like motion with his fingers. X’s stuttering increased slightly during the reading task as well as the duration of the blocks. The “up and away” eye movements increased during reading. There appeared to be a noticeable increase in jaw tension. His leg and finger movements decreased. Additional Testing An informal assessment of X’s receptive and expressive language abilities were conducted and they appeared to be within normal limits. Articulation skills were not re-evaluated during this consult. An oral mechanism examination was conducted and all structures and functions appear to be within normal limits. A hearing screening was not evaluated at this time due to time constraints. CASE DISPOSITION Results of this evaluation were shared with X and his mother. Mrs. B has expressed an interest in enrolling X in the Summer Fluency Program at the Cleveland Hearing and Speech Center. X has been enrolled in one hour individual and one hour group therapy for the summer session. This case is open. Suzie Q., MA, CCC-SLP Speech-Language Pathologist Ohio License SP # Graduate Student Case Western Reserve University DIAGNOSTIC CASE FILE FORMS • • • • • • Pediatric Case History Form Audiologic Screening Test Release of Information Forms Client Intake Form Cover Letter Attendance Agreement PEDIATRIC CASE HISTORY FORM AUDIOLOGIC SCREENING TEST C COVER LETTER May 25, 2004 <First Name> <Last Name> <Address> <City, State, Zip> RE: Child DOB: XX/XX/XXXX Dear <Title> <Last Name>: Thank you for contacting the Cleveland Hearing & Speech Center. We sincerely care about the communication needs of you and your family. Your child’s evaluation is scheduled for <Appointment Day>, <Appointment Date> at <Appointment Time> with <SLP>, SLP at our University Circle office. Please: • Complete the enclosed forms before your arrival and bring with you to your appointment. • Arrive 15 minutes prior to your appointment time to complete patient registration. • Remember to bring your insurance card(s). • Be sure to contact your child’s primary care physician PRIOR to the appointment if your insurance company requires a referral. We look forward to seeing you. If you are unable to keep this appointment, please give us at least 48 hours notice at (216) 231-8787 ex. 299. Sincerely, Client Relations LANGUAGE SAMPLE COLLECTION: SOME TECHNIQUES, AND CONSIDERATIONS FOR INTERVENTION The clinician who needs to collect a representative spontaneous language sample from a child faces no small test. Beginning student clinicians may have the notion that language sampling procedures involve little advance thought and planning, just some sharpened pencils for transcription, a working recording device and some toys or books to “make the child want to talk”. Experience has shown that collecting a spontaneous language sample from children is a challenge. The language measures derived when the sample is analyzed will be as valid as the sample is both accurate and representative. Therefore, it is important that we consider the following: 1. When interacting with a child, do I share information as well as the opportunity to generate the topic of conversation? 2. Am I able to converse at an interest level appropriate for the child? 3. Do I constrain the child’s productions by using too many interrogative forms? Are there ways of increasing the open-endedness of questions? 4. How often do I tell children what to do, think or feel rather than give opportunities for them to tell me? 5. Do I really listen when children speak to me? Am I sure that my “listening behavior” is evident to the client? 6. How often do I use incomplete sentences, sentence fragments and automatic (stereotypical) speech? Do I sound redundant? 7. Do I set up activities conducive to speech and thus, exchange of information? 8. How many different speaking environments do I provide for the child with different settings, expectations and listeners? 9. Are the situations I choose reality-based? Do they lead to positive feeling between client and clinician? Several types of intervention strategies follow. Many are fancy labels for sensical, natural dialogues which occur daily at home or in the classrooms. Two categories of strategies, adult initiated and child initiated, are delineated. Adult Initiated 1. Parallel Talk: As the adult and child are interacting together in an activity such as water play or making juice, the adult describes the activities, names the objects, etc., which correspond with the immediate situation: “Sherry is stirring the juice”, “You are pushing the boat”, and so on. The adult could also narrate what she/he is doing as they interact together: “I’m using the big white spoon”, or could narrate the actions of a doll, puppet, etc., “The girl jumped in the water”. The child could be nonverbally cued (a nod, glance) to join in the verbalizing. A more direct procedure would be warmly instructing the child to: “Tell about what you are doing”. 2. Question-Answer-Question: To insure a more positive situation for question answering, this technique provides the child a question, the answer, the question again and his/her opportunity to spontaneously respond correctly: “What is on the table? A cup is on the table. What is on the table?” Child response: “ “. 3. Answer-Question: A variation on the preceding is offering the answer, asking the question and giving the child “. the opportunity to spontaneously answer: “this is a toy dog. What is this?” Child response: “ 4. Close Technique or Open Ended: When beginning a project such as making playdough, the adult could begin with an open-ended comment such as: Adult: “Let’s make playdough...we’ll need uh...” Child: “spoo”, etc., or When the adult and child are prepared for an activity and have materials spread out, the adult might say: Adult: “We have a lot of stuff; I wonder what we could do with it...” Child: “Cut,” etc. 5. Backward Chaining: The adult provides a picture or object stimulus. The child should be familiar with the label/action represented. The sentence presented by the adult has the target deleted at the end. The followup offering by the adult omits the final two words, and so on. The sequence builds to the entire sentence being given by the child: Child: “car”, etc. Adult: “This is a “ Child: “a car”, etc. Adult: “This is “ “ Child: “is a car”, etc. Adult: “This Adult: No verbal output but Child: “This is a car”, etc. holds the item. Child Initiated Note: Each of these procedures requires at least a single-word utterance generated by the child. 1. Expansion: This form of parent-child verbal interaction has been found to be very natural and frequent. Brown and Bellugi (1964) noted the manner in which parents spontaneously complete the child’s original utterance by adding the deleted syntactical elements. This is an immediate measure to acknowledge and expand the child’s reduced comment at the time when it was uttered to insure relevance. An example could be: “Car go” (child) “Yes, the car is going” (adult) There seems to be some controversy over the usefulness of this technique. Some pitfalls of this intervention strategy have been suggested. First, because this technique focuses heavily upon structure, it may restrict the idea/intent of the child rather than extend it. Secondly, as the adult builds upon the child’s utterance through the addition of grammatical elements, the final product may not represent the child’s intent. An utterance such as “car go” could mean a variety of things and the adult’s expansion may not focus upon the accurate intention of the child. Thirdly, the child’s attention span may not accommodate an overabundance of expansions since he would be hearing basically an instant replay of his original utterance in a grammatically correct form. No new information of interest would have been added. Thus, this method has been shown more successful in the building of syntax than in enhancing the child’s semantic variety. 2. Expatiation or Semantic Extension: Cazden (1965) used the term “Modeling” then later shifted to extension to cover the same technique. Muma offers expatiation as a parallel term. This procedure frequently occurs with expansion in parent-child verbal interactions. When the two procedures, extension and expansion, were artificially separated in Cazden’s study with preschoolers in 1965, extension was found to be more successful than syntactical expansion. This seems to be a higher level of intervention strategy. Example: Child “ball roll” Adult “The ball is red and round. It rolls on the floor or you could throw it. I like to play with the ball.” Once again, it is important to bear in mind that the two procedures, expansion and expatiation, occur naturally together. Expatiation or semantic extension addresses itself to areas of syntax and semantics and supplies experience in the instrumental employment of language, rather than being restricted to syntax only as in expansion. 3. Interrogative Stimulus/Divergent Thinking Model: The adult encourages the child’s ability to think abstractly. Alternative means of expressing a though are the target. No attempt is made to correct syntax. Example: Child: “car go” Adult: “Is it a fast car or a slow one? Why do cars go?” Combination of Techniques Scene: Child and adult are using the water table together. Adult: Child: Adult: Adult: Child: Adult: Child: Adult: Adult: Child: Adult: “I’m pushing my boat.” (Parallel Talk) “Me boat.” (holds boat close to self to indicate possession) “Yes, that’s your boat.” (Expansion) “Here’s my boat.” (adult draws boat close to self to indicate possession) “What are you doing? Pushing. What are you doing?” (Question-Answer-Question) “Push” “You are pushing the boat in the water.” (Expansion, Expatiation, Parallel Talk) “Me push.” (child says as she/he pushes boat again) “Look at the waves you make when you push your boat.” (Expatiation) “Ah, here’s a duck. I wonder what I could do with it...I could...” (Close Technique) “Put in water.” “The duck and the boat are both in the water now.” (Expansion, Expatiation, Parallel Talk) SOME ADDITIONAL HELPFUL HINTS FOR LANGUAGE SAMPLE COLLECTION 1. Ask the parent or teacher about areas of interest the child has. Perhaps the child has a favorite toy, a pet, a favorite television show, a special occasion may be coming. 2. Use age-appropriate materials. 3. Present only a few items at a time to the child, and avoid overloading the child with either materials or questions. Let the child make a selection from the several items presented. 4. Demonstrate what you would like the child to do if s/he fails to initiate with some language and/or activity. 5. Vary situations, materials, listeners. Avoid very specific questions, asking the child to tell you very familiar stories, using stimulus materials that limit both vocabulary and syntax as well as “boy-like” or “girl-like” toys or pictures. 6. Be aware of the different language constructions you want to target and before the collection session, think through methods which might elicit such constructions. **This handout pulled together information from several others. Acknowledgments are due to Nancy E. Green and Joan G. Erickson among others, for materials compiled while affiliated with the University of Illinois. BEHAVIOR MANAGEMENT PRINCIPLES 1. Observe behaviors that are conducive to therapy and learning. Catch the child being “good” and reinforce. Praise the behavior not the whole child. As much as possible, ignore inappropriate behavior. 2. Observe behaviors which are disruptive to therapy and learning. Look for reasons why these behaviors may be occurring: task too difficult, materials distracting, drill too slow, etc. Restructure the therapy environment to eliminate these. 3. Do not allow blank spaces between activities. Children dink around and “get in trouble” when they have nothing to do. 4. Don’t ask for cooperation if you aren’t willing to accept “no” for an answer. That is, don’t say “Will you sit down” if you really mean “Sit down!” A good way to handle this firmly but fairly is to give the child a choice: “Do you want to sit in this chair or that chair?” 5. Establish the “rules” behavioral limits, early with children. Also, establish the “punishment” for breaking the rules- we’ll use Time-Out from group activities. The idea is to be fair. 6. Establish the contingencies for getting a reward. “If you want to play with the car, then do this.” “After we do this, then we’ll blow bubbles.” IF YOU USE TIME-OUT 7. When a child is acting as a disruptor of group activities or a therapy activity, give him a warning or choice. Examples: “You have a choice. You can sit at the table and play with us, or you can sit in the corner by yourself.” “If you don’t stop whistling, you’ll have to sit in the corner.” 8. Act immediately and be consistent with behavior management. 9. Check periodically on the child in Time-Out, saying “When you’re ready to follow the rules, you may come back and join us.” 10. Follow through! 11. Use activities, tokens, etc., that the child considers reinforcing. Group activities must be FUN, or else Time-Out won’t work, for example. 12. Apply Time-Out matter-of-factly. Always separate “bad behavior” from “bad child.” If the limits are clearly established and you apply the consequences immediately, then you’ll be less likely to get angry and violate this principle. 13. Above all, respect children as people who have rights to fair treatment. Steps to Follow in Dealing with Inappropriate Behavior 1. Give clear directions to the child. State the rule simply. 2. Reinforce those who have followed directions, ignore inappropriate behavior at this time, excepting situations of danger. 3. Restate the rule. 4. Model desired behavior. 5. Remove materials. (“When you’re ready to sit in your chair, you can have this back.”) 6. Move chair slightly away from table or push chair slightly away from group. (We’d really like you to be here with us. When you’re ready to sit in your chair, you can push it back and join us at the table.) 7. Provide an alternative for him. (“Either you sit in your chair with us, or you’ll have to sit there by yourself.”) 8. Remove child from the group or reinforcing situation. (Time-Out) 9. Remove child from the classroom. 10. Reinforce appropriate behavior whenever possible. Prevention Techniques 1. Provide many, clear directions. 2. Make sure each child knows where he is supposed to be and what he is supposed to be doing at all times. Gestures or physical guidance may be necessary with some of them. Don’t assume he understands until you get sufficient feedback. 3. Designate a specific place for each child to sit. (“Here’s your place on the floor,” while pointing to his spot or “This is your chair.”) 4. Call on children individually to direct, instead of directing them as a group. 5. Call on children at the beginning who may have difficulty waiting for their turn. Giving them an extra turn during games or songs often helps. 6. During games, remind children that everyone will get a turn. 7. Utilize teacher aides. Call on them first to stand by the door or to go to a certain place before directing the children. Use them as models to go through the process as visual reinforcement for your “clear” directions. 8. When directing an activity, center yourself with the bulk of the children. Direct your aides to help a child having difficulty. 9. Have your children seated were you want them before you bring out materials. Bring out only the materials you need at one given time; replace them before bringing out others. 10. Seat yourself at a place at the table where you can easily reach all children. This will help you assist all the children, promotes more interactions, and puts you in a spot for easy intervention. 11. Keep all materials out of children’s reach unless you want them to be touched. 12. Careful planning is a great preventive measure. Have everything you need on your tray so you won’t have to leave the group. 13. Remind children when it is almost time to finish an activity so they have time to finish up and prepare for the next activity. Give them time to do this for themselves. Be aware of their timing as well as your schedule. 14. Keep the children occupied and interested. Make use of emergency equipment (books, play doh, puppets, etc.) 15. If a child finishes an activity sooner than the others and is having a hard time waiting, give him a special job (wiping the table, collecting papers, gathering equipment, helping others). 16. Keep things moving. There’s no excuse for nothing to do. Everything is intriguing to preschoolers if you work through the tips they give you. 17. Use much eye contact, especially while reinforcing. 18. If you need to refocus a child’s attention, calling his name and directing a question to him usually helps. A gentle pat on the back or pat on the leg adds a personal touch. 19. If necessary, casually separate children who set each other off. Seat such children apart and you in the middle if needed. 20. Your voice and mood will be a key factor in the children’s reactions to an activity. (If an activity is boring to you, it will probably be boring to them, too.) Putting a little pizzazz in your voice helps get the kids more excited. Don’t be afraid to smile and laugh with them when appropriate and don’t be afraid to use firmness. Talking quietly and slowly sets another mood. 21. Be absolutely sure all behavior expectations are feasible for each child. Avoid setting demands for the children; give them choices. Make sure you always follow through with any demands you have made. (Threats without follow-through can do more harm than good.) 22. Don’t be over stifled by structure! If a lesson plan calls for 3 turns and you can see it’s bombing after 1, go on to something else; make the session interesting, but try to stick to the main objective. Flow with the kids. 23. Try to out guess certain behaviors to avoid a conflict situation. If someone always goes to his favorite toy, stand by the toy shelf and assume he is on his way to the appropriate place. 24. POSITIVE REINFORCEMENT cannot be overemphasized. Children are innocent until proven innocent! It’s a circular phenomenon, using it will probably alleviate most of your problems before they even occur. Compiled by Cathy Healy, University of Illinois, Colonel Wolfe Preschool. 403 E Healy, Champaign IL 61820. APPENDIX D: LEARNING OUTCOMES/SESSION FEEDBACK FORMS/SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINES Dear Students/Supervisors: The following outlines are the learning outcomes for clinical placements at CHSC, suggested topics for supervisory meetings, and the new session evaluation forms. Please take a moment to review those learning outcomes that correspond with your clinical placements. Students, as a reminder, required reading (noted on the supervisory outlines in your packet) to help you achieve the learning outcomes is located in the big white binder in the graduate carrel room. Session evaluation forms are designed to help the student/supervisor partners focus, in written form, on the attainment of specific learning outcomes. Please copy those forms that you will need for the semester. LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR INDIVIDUAL SESSIONS In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Read relevant literature, review chart. 2. Collect and analyze data. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Formulate goals, initiate treatment plan. 5. Modeling and cueing target behavior 6. Increase client response rate. 7. Corrective feedback. 8. Explaining goals, rationale, and techniques to client/parent(s). 9. Writing daily progress notes (complete treatment plan). 10. Develop home program/homework assignments. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: INDIVIDUAL SESSIONS 5. Modeling and cueing target behavior. 6. Increase client response rate. 7. Corrective feedback. 8. Explaining goals, rationale, and techniques to client/parent(s). 9. Writing daily progress notes (complete treatment plan). 10. Develop home program/homework assignments. 11. Utilize behavior management techniques effectively. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Read relevant literature, review chart. 2. Collect and analyze data. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Formulate goals, initiate treatment plan. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR PARENT TODDLER GROUP In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of the semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Collecting and analyzing data. 2. Formulating treatment goals consistent with evidence based practices. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Modeling language facilitation techniques. 5. Managing challenging behavior. 6. Delivering corrective feedback. 7. Leading group therapy. 8. Leading parent discussion. 9. Explaining therapy goals and techniques to parents. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: PARENT TODDLER GROUP 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Managing challenging behavior. Delivering corrective feedback. Leading group therapy. Leading parent discussion. Explaining therapy goals and techniques to parents. 10. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Collecting and analyzing data. 2. Formulating treatment goals consistent with evidence based practices. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Modeling language facilitation techniques. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR LANGUAGE LEARNING DISABLED GROUP In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of the semester you will have gained proficiency in the following: 1. Completing a review of pertinent LLD literature. 2. Collecting and analyzing data in a group setting. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Leading group therapy. 5. Using a commercially available Written Language Program. 6. Delivering corrective feedback. 7. Using appropriate behavior management techniques. 8. Modeling a variety of conversational skills. 9. Formulating long and short-term goals. 10. Discussing LLD issues with parents. 11. Explaining goals and progress to parents and school personnel. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: LANGUAGE LEARNING DISABLED GROUP 6. Delivering corrective feedback... 7. Using appropriate behavior management techniques. 8. Modeling a variety of conversational skills. 9. Formulating long and short term goals 10. Discussing LLD issues with parents. 11. Explaining goals and progress to parents and school personnel. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Completing a review of pertinent LLD literature... 2. Collecting and analyzing data in group setting. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Leading group therapy. 5. Using a commercially available Written Language Program Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR SCHOOL AGED FLUENCY GROUP In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Collecting and analyzing speech samples. 2. Formulating semester goals. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Implementing a commercially available fluency treatment program. 5. Implementing appropriate behavior management strategies. 6. Modeling a variety of fluency shaping strategies. 7. Delivering corrective feedback. 8. Collecting data in a group setting. 9. Leading group therapy. 10. Leading parent group discussion/education sessions. 11. Explaining therapy goals and techniques to parents. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: SCHOOL AGED FLUENCY GROUP 6. Modeling a variety of fluency shaping strategies. 7. Delivering corrective feedback. 8. Collecting data in a group setting. 9. Leading group therapy. 10. Leading parent group discussion/education sessions. 11.Explaining therapy goals and techniques to parents. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Collecting and analyzing speech samples. 2. Formulating semester goals. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Implementing a commercially available fluency treatment program. 5. Implementing appropriate behavior management strategies. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR ADOLESCENT FLUENCY GROUP In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Collecting and analyzing speech samples. 2. Formulating semester goals. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Modeling a variety of fluency shaping strategies. 5. Delivering corrective feedback. 6. Leading relaxation exercises. 7. Leading group therapy. 8. Leading parent group discussion. 9. Explaining therapy goals and techniques to parents. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: ADOLESCENT FLUENCY GROUP 5. Implementing appropriate behavior management strategies. 6. Delivering corrective feedback. 7. Leading relaxation exercises. 8. Leading group therapy. 9. Leading parent group discussion. 10. Explaining therapy goals and techniques to parents. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Collecting and analyzing speech samples. 2. Formulating semester goals. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Modeling a variety of fluency shaping strategies. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR PRESCHOOL SPEECH GROUP In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of the semester, you will have attained proficiency in the following: 1. Demonstrating knowledge of basic characteristics of developmental apraxia, phonological processes, and pre-reading skills. 2. Collecting and analyzing data. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Formulating treatment goals. 5. Applying cueing hierarchy to elicit accurate responses. 6. Managing challenging behavior. 7. Delivering corrective feedback. 8. Leading group therapy activities. 9. Explaining therapy goals/progress and techniques to parents. 10. Developing a home practice program. 11. Implementing a commercially available phonological awareness program SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: PRESCHOOL SPEECH GROUP 6. 7. Managing challenging behavior. Using appropriate behavior management techniques. 8. Delivering corrective feedback. 9. Leading group therapy activities. 10. Explaining therapy goals/progress and techniques to parents. 11. Developing a home practice program. 12. Implementing a commercially available phonological awareness program. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Demonstrating knowledge of basic characteristics of developmental apraxia, phonological processes, and pre-reading skills. 2. Collecting and analyzing data. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences 4. Formulating treatment goals. 5. Applying cueing hierarchy to elicit accurate responses. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR HEAD START SERVICES LANGUAGE CLASSROOM In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Demonstrate knowledge of theoretical underpinnings of the Prevention Model. 2. Demonstrate knowledge of Head Start services and placement in language classroom. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Deliver corrective/reinforcing feedback. 5. Collaborate with teachers/parents and administrators. 6. Structure the environment toward effective service delivery. 7. Create/implement age appropriate lesson plans which target skills in the small group setting. 8. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 9. Promote communication development in the classroom and home (creating parent/teacher handout). 10. Data keeping in a small group format. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: HEAD START SERVICES LANGUAGE CLASSROOM 6. Structure the environment toward effective service delivery. 7. Create/implement age appropriate lesson plans which target skills in the small group setting. 8. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 9. Promote communication development in the classroom and home (creating parent/teacher handout). 10. Data keeping in a small group format. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Demonstrate knowledge of theoretical underpinnings of the Prevention Model. 2. Demonstrate knowledge of Head Start services and placement in language classroom. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Deliver corrective/reinforcing feedback. 5. Collaborate with teachers/parents and administrators. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR HEAD START SERVICES FOR THERAPY In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Read and summarize relevant research/literature. 2. Collaborate with parents/teachers and administrators. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Structure the environment toward effective service delivery. 5. Demonstrate the ability to take the child’s perspective. 6. Establish age appropriate therapy goals. 7. Formulate relevant lesson plans for therapy. 8. Increase response rate. 9. Deliver corrective and reinforcing feedback. 10. Collaborate with parents, teacher, and administrators. 11. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: HEAD START SERVICES FOR THERAPY Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Read and summarize relevant research/literature. 2. Collaborate with parents/teachers and administrators. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Structure the environment toward effective service delivery. 5. Demonstrate the ability to take the child’s perspective. Strengths 1. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Establish age appropriate therapy goals. Formulate relevant lesson plans for therapy. Increase response rate. Deliver corrective and reinforcing feedback. Collaborate with parents, teacher, and administrators. 11. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR HEAD START SERVICES SCREENING/EVALUATION In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Collect and analyze speech samples. 2. Administer and score screening and evaluation instruments. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Structure the environment toward effective service delivery. 5. Demonstrate the ability to take the child’s perspective. 6. Interpret test results. 7. Write cohesive/concise evaluation reports. 8. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 9. Collaborate with parents, teachers, and administrators. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: HEAD START SERVICES SCREENING/EVALUATION Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Collect and analyze speech samples. 2. Administer and score screening and evaluation instruments. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Structure the environment toward effective service delivery. 5. Demonstrate the ability to take the child’s perspective. 6. Interpret test results. 7. Write cohesive/concise evaluation reports. 8. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 9. Collaborate with parents, teachers, and administrators. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature LEARNING OUTCOMES FOR DEAF/HARD OF HEARING LANGUAGE GROUP In accordance with Evidence Based Practices, by the end of this semester, you will attain proficiency in the following: 1. Demonstrate knowledge of various deaf/HH information (methodology, language facilitation in sign vs. oral modes, speech, listening/auditory mode). 2. Demonstrate use of sign in language facilitation techniques. 3. Demonstrate sensitivity to cultural/linguistic differences. 4. Collect and analyze data. 5. Formulate therapy goals of deaf/HH clients. 6. Model language facilitation techniques. 7. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 8. Deliver corrective feedback. 9. Lead group therapy. 10. Explain therapy goals and techniques to parents. SESSION FEEDBACK FORM: DEAF/HARD OF HEARING LANGUAGE GROUP 4. Formulate therapy goals of deaf/HH clients. 5. Model language facilitation techniques. 6. Demonstrate effective behavior management strategies. 7. Deliver corrective feedback 8. Lead group therapy. 9. Explain therapy goals and techniques to parents. Supervisor: Circle appropriate learning outcome (2-3 per session) 1. Demonstrate knowledge of various deaf/HH information (methodology, language facilitation in sign vs. oral modes, speech, listening/auditory mode). 2. Demonstrate use of sign in language facilitation techniques. 3. Collect and analyze data. Strengths 1. 2. 3. Areas for Improvement 1. Suggestions for next session 1. 2. 2. 3. 3. Supervisor Signature Student Clinician Signature SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: COLLECTING AND ANALYZING DATA Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Collecting and analyzing data. PREPARATION 1. Read Miller Ch. 1, 2, and PLS-3 supplemental measure; language sample checklist. 2. Student will analyze their data collection system used in Tx and develop ideas for revision. 3. Review info on SOAPS. Response rate. Clinician client talk time-calculate on KISS (the supervisory process p. 377-378) as assigned. Ch. 5 Goldberg (silver book). 4. Continue to revise systems needed and increase client response rate. DISCUSSION 1. First Meeting: a. Any questions from readings. b. Determining method of data collection, e.g. on-line vs. taping. c. Discuss system of data collection to be used in the next session, e.g. chart with targets listed. 2. Second Meeting: Discuss specific requirements with supervisor. 3. Meeting to discuss results and develop strategies for increasing client response rate. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: FORMULATING TX GOALS Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Formulating Tx goals PREPARATION Research Review info of client- specific dev. milestones (normative data) DISCUSSION Meeting: bring and summarize material found on normative development. Review chart/eval/SOAP notes Complete case management sheet. Meeting: present on highlights of case management sheet—current levels, strengths/weaknesses Refer to and review info on Tx hierarchy (Planning Curriculum Goals) (PA) Goldberg Ch. 6 p. 199 (Silver book) Choose a goal and develop Tx hierarchy. Review info on goal writing and planning—Hedge Ch. 7 p. 167 Curriculum goals (P.A.) Fey ch.5 Student writes Tx plan (because goals are measurable) Explain rationale for steps of hierarchy for part. goal. Revise as needed following discussion with supervisor. Student will discuss with supervisor, target areas to develop goals for. Review with supervisor and revise. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: IMPLEMENT LANGUAGE FACILITATION TECHNIQUES Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Implement language facilitation techniques. PREPARATION Birth-3 packet HC/ES. Hedge Ch. 8 COSI 352 methods material. Pick 1-2 specific tech. to focus on in Tx sessions. DISCUSSION Role play with peer or supervisor various techniques. Repeat as needed for subsequent techniques. Repeat as needed for subsequent techniques. Develop carryover activity, e.g. handout to be used with parents/caregivers of self or commercial. Review with supervisor. Get parent/caregiver feedback. With supervisor or prior to meeting as needed. Watch videotape or ongoing Tx and identify specific techniques used by SLP or student clinician or alternative strategies not implemented. Report in self-evaluation on 1-2 specific techniques used in Tx session. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: DELIVER CORRECTIVE/REINFORCING FEEDBACK Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Deliver corrective/reinforcing feedback. • • • • • PREPARATION Review literature pertinent to disorder/client (corrective/positive feedback). Review info on reinforcing feedback. Goldberg p. 123-132, p. 298-301. Observe Tx/watch video and ID techniques used. Tape self and complete KISS corrective feedback, p. 325. Tape self and complete KISS on positive reinforcement. DISCUSSION Discussion to review comments/questions Present findings and suggestions Present findings. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: MANAGE CHALLENGING BEHAVIOR Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Manage challenging behavior PREPARATION Review Gianni: Classroom management guidelines H.O. ES/HC DISCUSSION Discussion of reasons for negative/off task behavior and strategies to improve/manage. Generate list of client problem behaviors specific with strategies to implement in Tx. Present on rationale of strategies listed. Self-evaluation of session. Implement plan. Revise strategies as needed. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: COMPLETE A REVIEW OF PERTINENT LLD LITERATURE Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Complete a review of pertinent LLD literature PREPARATION Read: Wallach & Butler, Chs. 1,9,10 Merritt & Culatta, Ch. 7 DISCUSSION Discuss: Any questions concerning reading material. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: DISCUSS LLD ISSUES WITH PARENTS Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Discuss LLD issues with parents. PREPARATION 1. Locate resources for parent education (internet, LDA CCSERC, IDA) 2. Read material. 3. Choose material to share with parents 4. Highlight pertinent information. DISCUSSION Review #3 & 4 from preparation; role play information dissemination. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: USE COMMERCIALLY AVAILABLE THERAPY/TREATMENT PROGRAM Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Use commercially available therapy/treatment program. Applications: • written language • fluency • phonology PREPARATION Read: Manuals specified by your supervisor. DISCUSSION Discuss: Any questions. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: LEAD GROUP THERAPY (LLD GROUP) Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Lead group therapy. Applications: LLD group PREPARATION Read: Wiig & Semel, Ch. 2 DISCUSSION Discuss: Discuss with supervisor differences in learning styles and implications for leading a group. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: ADMINISTERING AND SCORING SCREENING AND EVALUATION INSTRUMENTS Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Administering and scoring screening and evaluation instruments. PREPARATION Familiarize self with test protocols appropriate for client. DISCUSSION Rec evaluation tools to be used and discuss with supervisors. Observe SLP or video tapes conducting evaluation. Comments/ Questions following evaluation with supervisor. Administer Dx tool as determined by SLP. Supervisor will provide feedback on adm. skills (test specific strategies) Implement strategies discussed on next administration of test. Become familiar with scoring procedures. Identify strengths/weaknesses. Determine severity level (formal with informal info) SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: INTERPRETING TEST RESULTS Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Interpreting test results. • • • • PREPARATION Read Test manuals to be familiar with scoring and test interpretation Review GFTA scoring sheet re: dialectal differences Review sample reports and scored tests Complete first draft of report to be turned into supervisor. • • DISCUSSION Meet with supervisor to discuss test interpretation. Review comments/changes to first draft and revise. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: COLLABORATING WITH TEACHERS AND ADMINISTRATORS Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Collaborating with teachers & administrators. • • Overall Reading Assignment: p. 249-252 LOWE • • PREPARATION Elicit information relative to child’s disorder from teacher Formulate questions and hypothetical situations to be asked of teacher. Revise Teacher questionnaire p. 129 Naidecker/Blosser • Schedule meeting time with teacher -during teacher meeting, gather and document information relative to child. -interpret information gathered and compile additional information to be shared with teacher. • Schedule follow up meeting with teacher and disseminate info. • • DISCUSSION Share with supervisor. Interpret information gathered and compile additional information to be shared with teacher. Role play teacher/clinician information sharing re: child’s performance in assessment/therapy. Repeat as necessary and update goals/objective if necessary. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: EXPLAIN GOALS AND PROGRESS TO PARENTS AND SCHOOL PERSONNEL Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Explain goals and progress to parents and school personnel. PREPARATION Prepare script. DISCUSSION Role play script with supervisor/peer. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: STRUCTURING THE ENVIRONMENT TOWARD EFFECTIVE SERVICE DELIVERY Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Structuring the environment toward effective service delivery. • • • • • PREPARATION Visit room and document physical structure of room as well as auditory and visual distractions. Separate into positive and negative aspects of environment. Develop strategies to further enhance/modify environment to best meet student needs. Request changes to environment on-site and give to appropriate personnel. Modify as necessary • DISCUSSION Share with supervisor. • Share with supervisor • See Preparation • See Preparation. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: COLLECT AND ANALYZE SPEECH SAMPLES Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Collect and analyze speech samples. Applications: • School aged fluency group • Adolescent fluency group PREPARATION Prepare stimulus materials for at least 2 audio/videotaped spontaneous speech samples and 2 reading samples (if appropriate). (samples should be at least 200 syllables each) • • Review frameworks for speech sample analysis (rate and type) e.g.: 1) Shipley & McAfee pp. 227-232 2) Gregory & Hill • • DISCUSSION Play samples of tape to verify accuracy of analysis with supervisor. Utilize results to prepare baseline data collection plans. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: MODELING A VARIETY OF FLUENCY SHAPING TECHNIQUES Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Modeling a variety of fluency shaping techniques. • • • • PREPARATION Review fluency training packet material on fluency shaping (e.g. continuous phonation, easy onset, etc.) Choose most appropriate techniques for client (based on speech sample analysis, past therapy outcomes, results of baseline data) Practice techniques (with supervisor approval) in front of mirror and while taping yourself, review and check for accuracy. Write script to explain techniques to client. DISCUSSION Practice technique prior to therapy session with supervisor. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: LEADING RELAXATION EXERCISES Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Leading relaxation exercises. • • • • • PREPARATION Collect information on relaxation strategies (e.g. “Progressive Relaxation” in Daly & Burnett, relaxation response, etc.). Practice relaxation technique at home (including visual imagery) Prepare therapy room. Implement strategies with client. Solicit client’s feedback (subjective) about benefit of relaxation. • • DISCUSSION Analyze time spent on relaxation and benefit for client. Adjust as necessary to maximize benefit for client. SUPERVISORY CONFERENCE OUTLINE: LEADING GROUP THERAPY (ADOLESCENT FLUENCY GROUP) Practicum Placement _______________________________ DATE LEARNING OUTCOME Leading group therapy. Applications: • Adolescent fluency group. • • • • • PREPARATION Read Ramig et al. article in fluency training packet. Establish purpose/goals of group therapy. Incorporate individual fluency goal(s) into group setting as appropriate. Formulate group therapy hierarchy. Establish schedule of clinicians to lead activities/group. DISCUSSION Discuss each preparation step with clinician group prior to meeting with supervision. APPENDIX E: CHSC CLINIC FORMS • • • • • CHSC Treatment Plan/Progress/Discharge Form Lesson Plan CHSC Progress Notes Speech Language Pathology Sample Lesson Plans Head Start Forms You will find the treatment plan/progress report in each client’s working file. The clinician lists goals for the given semester on this form and records attained progress on these goals. CHSC TREATMENT PLAN/PROGRESS/DISCHARGE FORM LESSON PLANS Lesson plans must be completed and turned into your supervisor prior to your clients’ sessions according to the schedule outlined in your clinical contract. Failure to turn in lesson plans for any session will result in loss of clinical hours for that session. You are to complete your analysis of the session including session strengths, areas to improve and suggestions, and turn it into your supervisor following the session. Progress notes are to be completed after each session following the SOAP format and should be attached to the client’s working file. DETAILED LESSON PLAN FORM SAMPLE DETAILED LESSON PLAN #1 SAMPLE DETAILED LESSON PLAN #2 Client Jeremy Clinician Graduate Student Date 3/31/98 Time 5:00 p.m. Supervisor Kay McNeal, CCC-SLP Short Term Objectives: 1. Diaphragmatic breathing: Jeremy will learn/use diaphragmatic breathing at the short phrase level (2-3 words) with 80% accuracy. 2. Jeremy will identify when he is releasing air rapidly prior to speaking and talking on low air volume in a 3 minute monologue with 80% consistency. 3. Slow, smooth speech: Jeremy will learn/use slow, smooth speech with 80% consistency at the short phrase level (2-4 words or up to 8 syllables) 4. Jeremy will incorporate his use of diaphragmatic breathing and slow, smooth speech at the short phrase level with 80% consistency. ANTECEDENT EVENTS Treatment Procedures/Materials Cues Cafet for Kids: Jeremy will do 4 syllable phrase stretches using a stimulus list and consecutive vocalizations. Visual (Stimulus List) 2. Cafet for Kids: 5 syllable phrase stretches using a stimulus list and consecutive vocalizations. CALMER sign as reminder to use conversational tone 3. Cafet for Kids: (if time allows) move to 6 syllable phrases using a stimulus list and consecutive vocalizations. 1. TRANSFER Activity: Since Jeremy liked it so much last session and worked well: Outburst Junior for Kids ages 7-14. Clinician will have Jeremy answer stimulus questions. Ruler—as reminder to stretch out Verbal RESPONSE DEFINITION Session Behavioral Feedback and Objective Response Reinforcement Level and Conditions Jeremy will produce 4 syllable phrase stretches using slow, smooth speech with 80% accuracy. Jeremy will produce 5 syllable phrase stretches using slow, smooth speech with 60% accuracy. Jeremy will produce 6 syllable phrase stretches using slow, smooth speech with 80% accuracy Jeremy will produce 4-5 syllable phrase answers using slow, smooth speech with 80% accuracy. Verbal praise and connective feedback (esp. regarding instances of fast air and/or insufficient length of syllable) Reinforce ment Schedule Continuous SUBSEQUENT EVENTS Clinician Response if Target Behavior is Not Produced Clinician will model appropriate syllable stretch and provide explanation of when fast air is noted—clinician will practice with Jeremy releasing air slowly as he begins to vocalize. STRENGTHS: AREAS TO IMPROVE: SUGGESTIONS TO IMPROVE THOSE AREAS: CHSC PROGRESS NOTES PROBLEM ORIENTED PROGRESS NOTES FOR SOAPS Problem oriented progress notes include four components: S = subjective information O = objective information A = assessment of the objective information P = a plan The initial goal is to identify a problem list which provides for initial format for long range planning. This list will define every problem the child has which may potentially interfere with or relate to the communication process. Thus, although you may not treat all of the problems, you will list all of them. A sample problem list appears elsewhere in this handout. Once you have devised the problem list, you then write a SOAP for each problem. Even though you may not immediately or ever treat each problem, you should write a SOAP on it. For example, one problem may be "Velopharyngeal incompetency due to an unrepaired cleft," where the child is also under the care of a physician who will soon be performing the necessary surgical repair work. You would write an initial SOAP describing this problem. Since you are not directly treating the problem, follow-up SOAP would not be required. For problems/objectives that you are treating, a SOAP will take the place of daily logs. SOAPs are written and provide subjective, objective, assessment, and planning information for each objective targeted in a session. Subjective (S) data: List subjective impressions of the particular objective. This may include your feelings and impressions (or mother, father, or child's feelings) with respect to the problem. Generally, this will consist of information which may account for unexpected changes, either negative or positive, in your O data. Examples can be found on in following pages. Objective (O) data: The information is to be written in operational, objective terms. This means that anyone could examine the measures and come up with the same information. This may include percentages, numbers, amount of time engaged in particular behavior, etc. Complete sentences are not necessary. No interpretation of the data is necessary - rather, just report the results. Assessment (A): This is where you interpret your O as well as your S data. You make judgments as to whether the child is regressing, improving or maintaining. This is also the place where you will indicate changes in treatment goals. For example, if you had been working on establishing an SVO syntactic structure on which the child had achieved productivity as indicated in the O data, you might have the following statement: As productivity has been achieved on SVO, this structure will no longer be the main focus of treatment." Note that you will not specify what the new treatment goal will be; that information belongs in the plan. Plan (P): A concise, complete statement of a) the behavior to be established, and b) the means to be used to establish the behavior. SOAPs will be short if they are stated concisely. Remember not to be redundant. You will probably not have totally new S, O, A and P information each week. In fact, your plan will probably frequently stay the same. In this case, all you need is, "same as SOAP dated...." Since you will be obtaining weekly language samples, your O and A data will probably always change. Remember, every time you have O data you will need to have A data. Your subjective information will probably not change significantly unless you have weeks where your child does not seem to feel well and you think it is important to mention this. Your plan will only change as criteria for targets is reached and you need to establish new targets or if there is no change in behavior and you need to modify your means for establishing a behavior. S and P may or may not change. O and A usually change. SAMPLE PROBLEM LIST P1 Semantic/ syntactic abilities not ageappropriate P2 Inappropriate social-interactive skills with peers EXAMPLES OF SOAPS P1 S -O -- A -P -- P2 P3 P3 Disruptive crying behavior P4 Fluctuating conductive hearing loss P5 Vocabulary size not age-appropriate Child seemed very shy and rarely talked directly to clinician. Generally talked to a doll. MLU = 1.43. One-word declarative statements comprised 75% of the 100 utterance sample. In the remaining 25 utterances, the following semantic relations were present. Nomination 15%; Recurrence - 50%; Notice - 10%; Action & Object - 15%; Agent & Action - 10%. Of the relations expressed, only nomination was productive. There was no evidence of the heuristic or informative social language functions. No grammatical morphemes or transformations evidenced in sample. Child exhibits severe delay in semantic/syntactic skills. MLU should be 3.5 for age level. Further, all grammatical morphemes as well as the question, negative, and imperative transformations should be present. Target: Establish productive use of the following two-term semantic relations: recurrence, action, object, and agent. Procedure: Following child's lead in imitative play and modeling appropriate target structures. Treatment on grammatical morphemes and more complex structures will be delayed until prerequisite syntactic (i.e., two-term relations) have been established. Target behaviors to be established by (date). S -- Mother very defensive about child's social behavior: claims "she's shy and will outgrow it." O -- 30 minutes of 30-minute group session spent alone in corner. Trantrumed every time effort (6 times) was made to require group participation. A -- Child attended to activity while in the corner. However, a child of this age should be actively participating with peers. P -Target: Establish 10 minutes of group participation by (date). Procedure: Engage in imitative play with child and model introduction of other children into activity. If child resists, physical manipulation will be used to keep her in proximity to other children. S -- Child did not seem scared, rather was angry, at having to stay in individual treatment instead of going to large play room. O -- Cried 20 of 30 minute individual session. A -Child does not cry in group treatment. Seems to use crying as a manipulation behavior to obtain own way. P -- Target: Eliminate crying by (date). Procedure: Clinician will ignore child when crying and immediately attend when crying ceases. P4 S -- Mother reports "frequent" ear infections O -Audiometric evaluation reported a mild (30 db) bilateral conductive hearing loss due to fluid in ears. A -None P -Child currently under care of physician. No direct treatment in this clinic. P5 S -- None O -- TTR of .10 A -- This is a low ratio of new words to total number of utterances. P -- Target: To increase number of lexical terms. Procedure: While engaging in imitative play and modeling, two-term semantic relations, clinician will also model a variety of lexical terms. HEAD START SAFETY REMINDER LIST HEAD START LOCATIONS HEAD START PROCEDURES CHSC SPEECH-LANGUAGE SCREENING FORM CHSC SCREENING REPORT LANGUAGE CLASSROOM TARGET AREAS CHSC HEAD START TREATMENT PLAN/PROGRESS PEPORT/DISCHARGE SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY CONTRACT SERVICES DAILY PROGRESS NOTES CHSC LANGUAGE CLASSROOM MONTHLY PROGRESS REPORT CHSC CLIENT TRACKING SHEET HEAD START SERVICES BILLING FORM CHSC AUDITORY COMPREHENSION AND VERBAL ABILITY SCREENING COLLECTING AND RECORDING SPEECH SAMPLES HOW TO CONDUCT AN OTOSCOPIC EXAMINATION CHSC SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY SCREENING FORM APPENDIX F: CHSC INFORMATION FOR STUDENTS IN AUDIOLOGY PRACTICUM AUDIOLOGY PRACTICUM GRADING for SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY STUDENTS LEVEL 1: Audiology practicum with an SLP graduate intern who is a beginner -- first 10 hours. This level will also be used for the student who is only assigned to an audiology slot for a short or sporadic time period. 5: Very good. Displays technical problems which do not hinder the evaluation/treatment process. Demonstrates appropriate clinical behaviors consistently. 4: Good. Frequently demonstrates the clinical behavior. Exhibits awareness of the need to modify behaviors. Modifications are generally effective. 3: Adequate. The clinical skill is emerging. Efforts to modify may result in varying degrees of success. 2: Needs Improvement. With supervisor input, implements the behavior/skill with difficulty. Efforts to modify are generally unsuccessful. 1: Poor. The clinical behavior is not evident. Unable to modify behavior when directed by supervisor repeatedly. Little awareness of need to change behavior. LEVEL 2: Audiology practicum with an SLP graduate student who is completing their audiology hours. 5: Clinical Competence. Independent work accomplished with accuracy and superior skill level. 4: Good. Demonstrates independence but may need specific or general directions. 3: Adequate. Generally needs direction from supervisor. 2: Needs Improvement. Needs repeated and specific direction to perform clinical tasks accurately. Incomplete understanding of clinical problems, the needs of the patients or procedures. 1: Poor. Specific direction from supervisor does not alter unsatisfactory skills. Unable to relate effectively with patients and is inadequately prepared. Does not seek guidance or implement suggestions appropriately. AUDIOLOGY PRACTICUM GRADING for SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY STUDENTS Supervisor: Student Clinician: Site: Level*: 1 / 2 Semester: Year: Number of Hours Evaluation Based on: Midterm / Final *Please see attached grading guide for description of numerical values for student level 1 or 2. PROFESSIONAL RESPONSIBILITY Punctuality and Attendance Professional Presentation Demonstrates Initiative Interest in Improving Performance Comments: PROFESSIONAL INTERACTION Effectiveness and poise in dealing with patients and families Understands and utilizes effective communication with people with hearing impairments Has knowledge of and ability to obtain case history from patient and/or family Comments: CONVENTIONAL AUDIOMETRY Gives instructions Pure tone air and bone conduction Speech audiometry Immittance Interpretation and recommendations are verbalized to supervisor and/or patient/family Documentation including history, impressions and recommendations on audiogram and HAP chart notes Comments: AURAL REHABILITATION Troubleshoots hearing aid malfunctions Instructs patient/family on use of hearing aid Performs repairs as able Is able to subjectively/objectively quantify benefit Participates in Dispensing Visit including: Battery Insertion and removal Handling of controls Counseling re: realistic expectations Care and maintenance Comments: SCORE: Total points / # items scored / = CHSC AUDIOLOGY CASE HISTORY CHSC HEARING TEST FORM CHSC HEARING TEST RESULTS FORM CHSC AUDIOLOGY PROGRESS NOTES CHSC HEARING AID BENEFIT SURVEY HEARING AID DISPENSING/ORIENTATION/SATISFACTION SHEET APPENDIX G: AVAILABLE CLINICAL MATERIALS DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATION SCIENCES • • ASHA FACS- Functional Assessment of Communication Skills for Adults ASSET- Assessing Semantic Skills Through Everyday Themes • • Bankson-Berenthal Test of Phonology Boston Naming Test • CDI- MacArthur Communicative Development Inventories CSBS- Communication and Symbolic Behavior Scales • • • • DIAL-3 Developmental Indicators for the Assessment of Learning EOWPVT-R Expressive One Word Picture Vocabulary Test-Revised EVT- Expressive Vocabulary Test • FLCI- Functional Linguistic Communication Inventory • GFTA- Goldman Fristoe Test of Articulation (version 1) • IDA- Infant-Toddler Developmental Assessment • K-ABC Kaufman Assessment Battery for Children • • Mullen Scales of Early Language MVPT- Motor-free Visual Perception Test OWLS- Oral and Written Language Scales • • • • • • • PPVT-III Peabody Picture Vocabulary Test III SEEC- Vineland Social-Emotional Early Childhood Scales SPELT-II Structured Photgraphic Expressive Language Test II SPELT-P Structured Photographic Expressive Language Test-Preschool TLC- Test of Language Competence TOPA- Test of Phonological Awareness CHSC ADULT DIAGNOSTIC TESTS • • • • • • • • Aphasia Dx Profiles Aphasia Screening Test Apraxia Battery for Adults Appraisal of Language Disturbance Arizona Battery for Communication Disorders of Dementia Assessment of Fluency Auditory Comprehension Test Probes AACT • • • Boston Assessment of Severe Aphasia BDAE/Pictures/Forms Boston Naming Test • Communicative Abilities in Daily Living (Revised edition is not available) CHI-behavioral checklist Cognitive-Language Assessment CASL (7-21) • • • • • • • • Dementia Evaluation Dworkin Oro-Facial Evaluation Dysarthria Profile Dysphagia Bedside Evaluation Assessment of Intelligibility of Dysarthric Speech • Fluency in Aphasia • Halstead-Wepman Aphasia Screening • • Mini Inventories of Right Brain Injury Minnesota Test of Differential Diagnosis of Aphasia • Orofacial Exam • Peabody Picture Vocabulary TestRevised (3) Pre Language Checklist Prosody-Voice Screening Profile • • • • • • • • • Rainbow Passage Reading Passage Reading Comprehension Battery for Adults Reading Test Probes Right CVA Battery Receptive/Expressive Checklist Rice • • • • Scholastic Abilities Test for Adults (SATA) S/P Stuttering: Parent Dx Questionnaire Stuttering: Behavior Profile Sheet Stuttering Severity Instrument for Children and Adults (3) • Birth to Three Screening Test of Learning & Language Development • • • • • CASL (3-6) Carrow Elicited Language Inventory CELF-3 CELF-R Screening Checklist of Communicative Functions & Means Clinical Language Intervention Program CADET-Communication Ability Dx Test Comprehensive Test of Adaptive Behavior (CTAB) Communication & Symbolic Behavior Scales Criterion Referenced Inventory of Language • • • • TLC-E Technical Manual TOWL TLC Profile-Token • • Voice Protocol Voice Evaluation • • Written Expression Test Probe • SOFTWARE • • • • • • • • Kid’s World- The Great Reading Adventure (CD Rom) Edmark Millie and Bailey; Start School with Skills and Confidence-3 kits Discovery Toys Plastic Bags (3) Reading Mansion-Great Wave Software Busy Town-Richard Scarry’s Best Ever 1st Grade Starter Pack; 3 kits On Track Software; Same or Different CD Rom; 3 kits On Track Software; Beginning Sounds CD Rom; 3 kits On Track Software-Beginning Reading CD Rom • • • • • • • • • • • • • • ELM-2 ECO Scales ELI-Environmental Language Inventory Environmental Prelanguage Battery Expressive One Word Picture Vocabulary Test - Revised (EOWPVT-R) • • Goldman-Fristoe Test of Articulation (GFTA) Gray Oral Reading Test • The Help Test • Infant Scale of Communicative Intent • Kaufman Scale of Education Achievement • • Language Processing Test Let’s Talk Inventory for Adolescents • MacArthur Communicative Development Inventories CHSC PEDIATRIC DIAGNOSTIC TESTS • • • • • • • • • • • • Adolescent WORD Test Arizona Articulation Proficiency Test Revised Apraxia Exam ACLC ALPHA Assessment of Phonological Processes - Revised Assessing Semantic Skills through Everyday Themes (ASSET) Auditory Analysis Test Autistic Behavior Composite (Checklist & Profile) BBTOP Bankson-Bernthal Test of Phonology Bayley Scales of Infant Development Decoding Skills Test Denver Developmental Screening Test Detroit Tests of Learning Aptitude - 2nd edition Detroit Tests of Learning Aptitude- 3rd Edition Diagnostic Achievement Battery - 2nd edition Diagnostic Achievement Test for Adolescents • • • Miller-Yoder Language Comprehension Test Mother/Infant Communication Screening Multilevel Informal Language Inventory • Normative Adaptive Behavior Checklist • • • Observation of Communication Interaction Oral-Motor Feeding Rating Scale OWLS: Oral Written Language Scales • Peabody Individual Achievement Tests (Vol I & II) Peabody Picture Vocabulary Test - Forms III A&B Phonological Awareness Profile Photo Articulation Test PAT: Phonological Awareness Test Preverbal Assessment - Intervention Profile • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Receptive One Word Picture Vocabulary Test (ROWPVT) REEL-R (2) Record Form for Semantics and Morph. Rescorla: Language Development Survey Rosetti Infant/Toddler Language Scale Sawyer’s Test of Awareness of Language Segments SALT-P Screening Test for Developmental Apraxia of Speech Sequenced Inventory of Communication Development - Revised edition (SICD-R) SICD Instruction Manual Social Skills (Questioinnaires/Assessments) Spell Master Speech and Hearing Checklist SSI-3 Stuttering Severity Instrument-3 Stuttering Prevention Instrument (SPI) Test for Examining Expressive Morphology (TEEM) Templin-Darley Screening and Dx Test of Articulation Test of Adolescent/Adult Word Finding Test of Early Reading Ability (1 & 2) Test of Early Written Language TEWL-2 Manual/Test Forms Test of Language Competence-Expanded Edition (1 &2) Test of Language Development - 3 Primary (TOLD-3 Primary) Test of Legible Handwriting (TOLH) Test of Minimal Articulation Competence Test of pragmatic Language • • • • • • • • • • • Test of Pragmatic Skills Test of Problem Solving-Revised (TOPS-R) Test of Problem Solving-Adolescents (TOPS) Test of Word Finding Test of Written Language Test of Reading Comprehension Test of Written Spelling-2 Token Test for Children Westby Pay Assessment Woodcock Reading Master Test-R Word Test-R (elementary) APPENDIX H: ASHA MEMBERSHIP & CERTIFICATION/OHIO BOARD OF SPEECH LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY AND AUDIOLOGY LICENSING The following section provides information on the academic and clinical requirements in order to become eligible for applying for the ASHA Certificate of Clinical Competence and licensure by the Ohio Board of Speech Language Pathology. Information on how to apply for certification and licensure at the end of your master’s program will be included in Appendix J: Guidelines for Graduate Students. AMERICAN SPEECH LANGUAGE HEARING ASSOCIATION (ASHA) CERTIFICATION IN SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY The following sections are excerpted from the 2004 Membership and Certification Handbook of the American-Speech-Language-Hearing Association: Speech-Language Pathology. These sections address the following questions: • What is ASHA? • What is the Certificate of Clinical Competence (CCC)? • What is membership in ASHA? • What must I do to obtain membership and certification? • What is a clinical fellow? • What is the National Examination in Speech-Language Pathology and how do I take it? As a student, you will be most concerned with section III. Standards and Implementation Procedures for the Certificate of Clinical Competence which outlines all academic and clinical requirements to become certified in Speech-Language Pathology. READ THIS INFORMATION CAREFULLY. At the end of your program, you will need to complete the “Application for Membership/Certification”. A curren copy of the Membership and Certification Handbook and the “Application for Membership/Certification” can be found on ASHA’s website www.ASHA.org. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WHAT IS ASHA? AMERICAN SPEECH-LANGUAGE-HEARING ASSOCIATION The American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA) is the national scientific and professional association for speech-language pathologists; audiologists; and speech, language, and hearing scientists concerned with communication behavior and disorders. The Association, a nonprofit organization, was founded in 1925. It now has over 114,000 members, certificate holders, and affiliates, and recognizes 52 state speech and hearing association affiliates, including the District of Columbia and the Overseas Association of Communication Sciences. In addition, the Organización Puertorriqueña de Patologia del Habla Lenguaje y Audiologia, Inc. is also affiliated with ASHA. The purposes of ASHA are to: • encourage basic scientific study of the processes of individual human communication, with special reference to speech, language, and hearing; • promote appropriate academic and clinical preparation of individuals entering the discipline of human communication sciences and disorders and to promote the maintenance of current knowledge and skills of those within the discipline; • promote investigation and prevention of disorders of human communication; • foster improvement of clinical services and procedures addressing such disorders; • stimulate exchange of information among persons and organizations thus engaged and to disseminate such information; • advocate for the rights and interests of persons with communication disorders; and • promote the individual and collective professional interests of the members of the Association. ASHA ACTIVITIES ASHA maintains its permanent National Office in the Washington, DC, metropolitan area, where the executive, professional, and administrative staffs assist in coordinating the following Association activities: • sponsoring national conferences, institutes, and workshops each year as part of its continuing professional education program • maintaining programs related to research, education, and delivery of clinical services • conducting an Annual Convention at which scientific sessions, exhibits, short courses, and other educational and professional programs and a placement center are offered • maintaining a national career information program, a governmental affairs program, and a public information program • carrying out a continuing program of data collection related to professional training, human resource needs, and membership characteristics and activities • sponsoring a voluntary continuing education program that approves providers of continuing education activities and offers an Award for Continuing Education to certified individuals and members • publishing several professional journals and other professional materials • providing technical support to practitioner members on issues affecting the delivery of services • maintaining a computerized database that provides information about federal and private funding sources in the United States and Canada (includes abstract; amount; funding source; and contact person's address, telephone number, and email address) • protecting the public interest by maintaining high standards for members, certificate holders, accredited clinics, and accredited graduate educational programs. ASHA also recognizes the National Student Speech-Language-Hearing Association (NSSLHA), founded in 1972. NSSLHA is represented on certain key ASHA boards and committees. In addition, members of NSSLHA receive many benefits from ASHA at substantial savings. GOVERNANCE ASHA is governed by an Executive Board (EB) consisting of 11 elected officers and the executive director of the Association and a Legislative Council (LC) elected by members in each of the 50 states, the District of Columbia, members residing outside the United States, and other representatives as specified in the ASHA Bylaws. Two elected members of the National Student Speech-Language-Hearing Association (NSSLHA) also serve on the Legislative Council. The president of the Association serves as the chair of the Legislative Council, and the other members of the Executive Board serve as ex officio members. The Legislative Council and Executive Board establish the policies of the Association. The Executive Board supervises, controls, and directs the affairs of the Association, and in collaboration with the Legislative Council identifies priority issues and outcomes for the Association. The EB and the LC operate in accordance with the policies established by the Association's Bylaws. COUNCIL FOR CLINICAL CERTIFICATION The Council For Clinical Certification (CFCC) consists of speech-language pathologists and audiologists and a public member who are appointed by ASHA's Executive Board, and a student representative appointed by NSSLHA. The ASHA executive director's designee serves as an ex officio, nonvoting member of the CFCC. All professional members of the CFCC hold the Certificate of Clinical Competence in speech-language pathology (CCC-SLP) or audiology (CCCA) or both. This CFCC, a semi-autonomous body, is charged with developing, interpreting and applying the certification standards; formulating procedures for applications, examination, and review; awarding certification to qualified individuals; and, through appointment of a Special Appeals Panel, hearing and adjudicating appeals of certification decisions. COUNCIL ON ACADEMIC ACCREDITATION IN AUDIOLOGY AND SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY The Council on Academic Accreditation in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology (CAA), a semi-autonomous body, defines the standards for the accreditation of graduate educational programs and applies those standards in the accreditation of such programs. The CAA has final authority to establish the standards and processes for academic accreditation; and, subject to the application of established appeal procedures, the decisions of the CAA in awarding or denying academic accreditation are final. WHAT IS THE CERTIFICATE OF CLINICAL COMPETENCE? CERTIFICATES OF CLINICAL COMPETENCE ASHA's Certificates of Clinical Competence (CCC), which are granted in speech-language pathology and in audiology, allow the holder to provide independent clinical services and to supervise the clinical practice of student trainees, clinicians who do not hold certification, and support personnel. The certificate can be obtained by an individual who meets specific requirements in terms of degree, course work, practicum, and supervised professional experience, and who passes the national examination in speech-language pathology or audiology. The certificates are presently held by over 86,000 professionals, who provide services in schools, colleges, speech-language and hearing centers, clinics, hospitals, private practices, and other programs throughout the United States, Canada, and many other countries. To hold the CCC an individual must have a graduate degree, must have an active interest in the field of communication, must meet academic course work and clinical practicum requirements in the professional area, and must have completed a supervised Clinical Fellowship experience and achieved a passing score on the appropriate Praxis examination. Holders of the CCC must abide by ASHA's Code of Ethics, which incorporates the highest standards of integrity and ethical principles. An ASHA member who supervises the provision of clinical services must hold a current CCC in the appropriate area. An ASHA member may provide clinical services in speech-language pathology and audiology only when the individual holds the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence or is in the process of obtaining certification and is supervised by an individual who holds the appropriate CCC. Otherwise that individual is in violation of ASHA's "Code of Ethics." Maintaining the CCC is contingent upon the timely payment of annual dues and fees. ASHA resolution LC 5-81 states: "...individuals whose Annual Certification Fees are in arrears on April 1 will have allowed their certificates to expire on that date." Additionally, effective January 1, 2005, all certificate holders in speech-language pathology, regardless of their date of certification, will be required to participate in continuing professional development activities to maintain their certification. Specific information on this requirement is available on our Web site. BENEFITS OF CERTIFICATION Many associations use professional certification to recognize individuals for their dedication to their chosen career and their ability to perform to established standards. The certification process is one of the single most important steps you can make in career development. Here are several reasons you should consider ASHA certification. • Certification demonstrates your commitment to your profession. Certification shows your peers and supervisors and, in turn, the general public your commitment to your chosen career. • Certification enhances the profession's image. Association certification programs seek to enlist, develop, and promote certified professionals who can stand 'out in front' as examples of excellence in their field. • Certification establishes professional credentials that are national in scope. Certification lends weight to your résumé, in that it serves as an impartial, objective evaluation of your knowledge and experience. And when the public looks for individuals qualified to perform clinical services, they seek individuals 'like you' who have achieved certification. • Certification builds self-esteem. Certification programs create a standard for the profession. You'll begin to define yourself beyond a job description or academic degree. You'll see yourself as a certified professional who can control his or her own professional destiny and find a deep sense of personal satisfaction. • Certification prepares you for greater on-the-job responsibilities. Because certification is a voluntary professional commitment to a field of knowledge, it is a clear indicator of your willingness to invest in your own professional development. Certified professionals are aware of the constant change in their professional environment and possess the tools to anticipate and respond to change. ASHA certification has value beyond the ability to provide or supervise individuals in the provision of clinical services. ASHA certificate holders can: • receive reimbursement for services rendered from certain third-party payers, including private insurance agencies and some publicly funded programs; • be eligible for employment as speech-language pathologists in hospitals, health care settings, educational programs, and private practices; • be eligible for promotion in some employment settings, including the U.S. military; • be assured of an easier and more manageable state licensure process; • have maximum employment flexibility and portability between states; and • be recognized by state and federal policy makers as holding nationally validated professional credentials. Check into certification soon. It will give your career and professional life a real boost! WHAT IS MEMBERSHIP IN ASHA? The American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA) represents more than 114,000 members and affiliates who are speech-language pathologists; audiologists; and speech, language, and hearing scientists. ASHA is recognized nationally as an organization that maintains high standards of ethical conduct and professionalism, produces quality journals and continuing education programs, monitors and participates in the development and implementation of health care reform proposals and programs at the federal and state levels, and offers its members benefits and services that cannot be obtained elsewhere. Members of the Association must abide by ASHA's Code of Ethics. There are several categories of membership in ASHA. The applicant should review the description of membership categories given below before completing the membership application form and submitting the appropriate dues and fees (see Form A and Form B in this Handbook). MEMBERSHIP AND CERTIFICATION CATEGORIES Membership with certification. An individual who wishes to provide or supervise clinical services and resides in the United States or its territories must apply for this category of membership. To be eligible for this membership category the individual must have successfully completed all requirements for the Certificates of Clinical Competence in speech-language pathology (CCCSLP). The requirements include holding a graduate degree. Applicants for this category of membership typically are granted membership in ASHA while they are in the certification process. Until the CCC-SLP is awarded, the applicant may not provide clinical services except under the supervision of an individual who holds the CCC-SLP. While in the certification process a candidate for certification must pay the annual dues and the annual certification-in-process fee. As a member who has been awarded the CCC-SLP, an individual may provide independent clinical services and supervise students involved in clinical practicum, clinical fellows, and support personnel. Maintaining certification status and enjoying the benefits of membership are contingent upon the timely payment of annual dues and fees and, beginning January 1, 2005, mandatory participation in continuing professional development activities. Membership without certification. This category of membership is open to an individual who (a) holds a graduate degree with major emphasis in speech-language pathology; audiology; or speech, language, or hearing science, (b) is not involved in providing clinical services or in supervising students and/or clinical fellows, and resides in the United States. Complete application materials for Membership without certification (PDF Format) to become a member. Membership without certification (Research or allied professional). An individual who holds a graduate degree and presents evidence of active research, interest, and performance in the field of human communication is eligible for membership without certification as a research or allied professional (PDF Format). Only individuals who do not provide or supervise clinical services may apply for this category of membership. (Note: Clinical services are defined as evaluation and treatment of persons with speech-language and/or hearing impairments, whether such services are provided in elemenatary or secondary schools, in private practice, or in free-standing community clinics, rehabiliation centers, hospitals, nursing homes, or other facilities.) International Affiliate. An individual who holds a graduate degree and who resides abroad may apply for international affiliate status. An individual with foreign or dual U.S. and foreign citizenship who meets these criteria may apply for International Affiliation (PDF Format). Please review the dues schedule and submit the completed charge payment form with your application. International Affiliates are entitled to all the privileges of Association membership except for voting and holding office. International Affiliates are not eligible for certification and must abide by an ethical code of professional practice statement that prohibits use of affiliation with ASHA in the promotion of commercial products. Certificate Holder. An individual may also choose to maintain certificate-holder status--that is, hold the Certificate of Clinical Competence--but not become a member of the Association. Nonmember certificate holders are not eligible for member benefits. Life Member. Individuals who are 65 years old and have been an ASHA member for 25 consecutive years are eligible to apply for life membership. Please contact the Action Center at the ASHA National Office for details. WHAT MUST I DO TO OBTAIN MEMBERSHIP AND CERTIFICATION? STANDARDS AND IMPLEMENTATION PROCEDURES FOR THE CERTIFICATE OF CLINICAL COMPETENCE OVERVIEW OF STANDARDS Although previous certification standards emphasized process measures of academic and clinical knowledge, the 2005 standards combine process and outcome measures of academic and clinical knowledge and skills. Process standards specify the experiences, such as course work or practicum hours; outcome standards require demonstration of specific knowledge and skills. The 2005 standards utilize a combination of formative and summative assessments for the purpose of improving and measuring student learning. Salient features of the standards for entry- level practice include the following requirements: A. A minimum of 75 semester credit hours culminating in a master’s, doctoral, or other recognized post-baccalaureate degree. The graduate education in speech-language pathology must be initiated and completed in a program accredited by the Council on Academic Accreditation in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology (CAA) of the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. B. Skills in oral and written communication and demonstrated knowledge of ethical standards, research principles, and current professional and regulatory issues. C. Practicum experiences that encompass the breadth of the current scope of practice with both adults and children (with no specific clock-hour requirements for given disorders or settings) resulting in a minimum of 400 clock hours of supervised practicum, of which at least 375 hours must be in direct client/patient contact and 25 in clinical observation. D. A 36-week speech- language pathology clinical fellowship that establishes a collaboration between the clinical fellow and a mentor. E. A maintenance of certification requirement (Standard VII) that goes into effect on January 1, 2005. Standards and Implementation for the Certificate of Clinical Competence in SpeechLanguage Pathology. Effective January 1, 2005 Applicants for Initial Certification Individuals applying for initial certification before January 1, 2005, may be able to apply under either the 1993 or the 2005 Standards, depending on when they began their graduate program of study. Please refer to the chart below that describes the scenarios under which individuals may apply for certification. Applicant Began Graduate Program Under Which Standards (1993 or 2005)? And Completed And Applies for Program Under Which Certification Standards (1993 or When? 2005)? Applicant Applies for Certification Under Which Standards (1993 or 2005)? 1. 1993 1993 Before 1/1/05 1993 Standards 2. 1993 1993 After 1/1/05 1993 Standards (through 12/31/05); then 2005 Standards beginning 1/1/06 3. 1993 After program evaluated by CAA under 2005 Standards Before 1/1/05 Either 1993 or 2005 Standards (through 12/31/05) 4. 1993 After program evaluated by CAA under 2005 Standards a. But completed before 1/1/05 b. But completed after 1/1/05 After 1/1/05 Either 1993 or 2005 Standards (through 12/31/05) 5. 2005 Before 1/1/05 Before 1/1/05 2005 Standards 6. 2005 Before 1/1/05 After 1/1/05 2005 Standards Applicants for Reinstatement Individuals who were previously certified and who let their certification lapse must meet the 2005 standards if they wish to reinstate certification on or after January 1, 2005. The Standards for the Certificate of Clinical Competence in Speech-Language Pathology are shown in bold. The related implementation procedures are shown in normal text following each standard. STANDARD I: DEGREE Effective January 1, 2005, the applicant for certification must have a master’s or doctoral or other recognized post-baccalaureate degree. A minimum of 75 semester credit hours must be completed in a course of study addressing the knowledge and skills pertinent to the field of speech-language pathology. Implementation: Verification of the graduate degree is required of the applicant before the certificate is awarded. Degree verification is accomplished by submitting (a) an application signed by the director of the graduate program indicating the degree date, and (b) an official transcript showing that the degree has been awarded. Individuals educated in foreign countries must submit official transcripts and evaluations of their degrees and courses to verify equivalency. All graduate course work and graduate clinical practicum required in the professional area for which the Certificate is sought must have been initiated and completed at an institution whose program was accredited by the Council on Academic Accreditation in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology (CAA) of the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association in the area for which the Certificate is sought. Automatic Approval. If the graduate program of study is completed in a CAA-accredited program and if the program director verifies that all knowledge and skills requirements have been met, approval of the application is automatic, provided that the application for the Certificate of Clinical Competence is received by the National Office in accordance with the time lines stipulated in the chart above. Evaluation Required. The following categories of applicants must submit a completed application for certification, which includes the Knowledge and Skills Acquisition (KASA) summary form for evaluation by the Council For Clinical Certification (CFCC): (a) those who apply after the dates stipulated in the chart above (b) those who were graduate students and were continuously enrolled in a CAA-program that had its accreditation withdrawn during the applicant’s enrollment (c) those who satisfactorily completed graduate course work, clinical practicum, and knowledge and skills requirements in the area for which certification is sought in a program that held candidacy status for accreditation (d) those who satisfactorily completed graduate course work, clinical practicum, and knowledge and skills requirements in the area for which certification is sought at a CAA-accredited program but (1) received a graduate degree from a program not accredited by CAA; (2) received a graduate degree in a related area; or (3) received a graduate degree from a non-U.S. institution of higher education The graduate program director must verify satisfactory completion of both undergraduate and graduate academic course work, clinical practicum, and knowledge and skills requirements. STANDARD II: INSTITUTION OF HIGHER EDUCATION The graduate degree must be granted by a regionally accredited institution of higher education. Implementation: The institution of higher education must be accredited by one of the following: Commission on Higher Education, Middle States Association of Colleges and Schools; Commission on Institutions of Higher Education, New England Association of Schools and Colleges; Commission on Institutions of Higher Education, North Central Association of Colleges and Schools; Commission on Colleges, Northwest Association Schools and Colleges; Commission on Colleges, Southern Association of Colleges and Schools; and Accrediting Commission for Senior Colleges and Universities, Western Association of Schools and Colleges. Individuals educated in foreign countries must submit documentation that course work was completed in an institution of higher education that is regionally accredited or recognized by the appropriate regulatory authority for that country. In addition, applicants educated in foreign countries must meet each of the Standards that follow. STANDARD III: PROGRAM OF STUDY—KNOWLEDGE OUTCOMES The applicant for certification must complete a program of study (a minimum of 75 semester credit hours overall, including at least 36 at the graduate level) that includes academic course work sufficient in depth and breadth to achieve the specified knowledge outcomes. Implementation: The program of study must address the knowledge and skills pertinent to the field of speechlanguage pathology. The applicant must maintain documentation of course work at both undergraduate and graduate levels demonstrating that the requirements in this standard have been met. The minimum 75 semester credit hours may include credit earned for course work, clinical practicum, research, and/or thesis/dissertation. Verification is accomplished by submitting an official transcript showing that the minimum credit hours have been competed. Standard III-A: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of the principles of biological sciences, physical sciences, mathematics, and the social/behavioral sciences. Implementation: The applicant must have transcript credit (which could include course work, advanced placement, CLEP, or examination of equivalency) for each of the following areas: biological sciences, physical sciences, social/behavioral sciences, and mathematics. Appropriate course work may include human anatomy and physiology, neuroanatomy and neurophysiology, genetics, physics, inorganic and organic chemistry, psychology, sociology, anthropology, and non-remedial mathematics. The intent of this standard is to require students to have a broad liberal arts and science background. Courses in biological and physical sciences specifically related to communication sciences and disorders (CSD) may not be applied for certification purposes in this category. In addition to transcript credit, applicants may be required by their graduate program to provide further evidence of meeting this requirement. Standard III-B: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of basic human communication and swallowing processes, including their biological, neurological, acoustic, psychological, developmental, and linguistic and cultural bases. Implementation: This standard emphasizes the basic human communication processes. The applicant must demonstrate the ability to integrate information pertaining to normal and abnormal human development across the life span, including basic communication processes and the impact of cultural and linguistic diversity on communication. Similar knowledge must also be obtained in swallowing processes and new emerging areas of practice. Program documentation may include transcript credit and information obtained by the applicant through clinical experiences, independent studies, and research projects. Standard III-C: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of the nature of speech, language, hearing, and communication disorders and differences and swallowing disorders, including the etiologies, characteristics, anatomical/ physiological, acoustic, psychological, developmental, and linguistic and cultural correlates. Specific knowledge must be demonstrated in the following areas: · articulation · fluency · voice and resonance, including respiration and phonation · receptive and expressive language (phonology, morphology, syntax, semantics, and pragmatics) in speaking, listening, reading, writing, and manual modalities · hearing, including the impact on speech and language · swallowing (oral, pharyngeal, esophageal, and related functions, including oral function for feeding; orofacial myofunction) · cognitive aspects of communication (attention, memory, sequencing, problem-solving, executive functioning) · social aspects of communication (including challenging behavior, ineffective social skills, lack of communication opportunities) · communication modalities (including oral, manual, augmentative, and alternative communication techniques and assistive technologies) Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate the ability to integrate information delineated in this standard. Program documentation may include transcript credit and information obtained by the applicant through clinical experiences, independent studies, and research projects. It is expected that course work addressing the professional knowledge specified in Standard III-C will occur primarily at the graduate level. The knowledge gained from the graduate program should include an effective balance between traditional parameters of communication (articulation/phonology, voice, fluency, language, and hearing) and additional recognized and emerging areas of practice (e.g., swallowing, upper aerodigestive functions). Standard III-D: The applicant must possess knowledge of the principles and methods of prevention, assessment, and intervention for people with communication and swallowing disorders, including consideration of anatomical/physiological, psychological, developmental, and linguistic and cultural correlates of the disorders. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate the ability to integrate information about prevention, assessment, and intervention over the range of differences and disorders specified in Standard III C above. Program documentation may include transcript credit and information obtained by the applicant through clinical experiences, independent studies, and research projects. Standard III-E: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of standards of ethical conduct. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of, appreciation for, and ability to interpret the ASHA Code of Ethics. Program documentation may reflect coursework, workshop participation, instructional module, clinical experiences, and independent projects. Standard III-F: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of processes used in research and the integration of research principles into evidence-based clinical practice. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate comprehension of the principles of basic and applied research and research design. In addition the applicant should know how to access sources of research information and have experience relating research to clinical practice. Program documentation could include information obtained through class projects, clinical experiences, independent studies, and research projects. Standard III-G: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of contemporary professional issues. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of professional issues that affect speech-language pathology as a profession. Issues typically include professional practice, academic program accreditation standards, ASHA practice policies and guidelines, and reimbursement procedures. Documentation could include information obtained through clinical experiences, workshops, and independent studies. Standard III-H: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge about certification, specialty recognition, licensure, and other relevant professional credentials. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of state and federal regulations and policies related to the practice of speech-language pathology and credentials for professional practice. Documentation could include course modules and instructional workshops. STANDARD IV: PROGRAM OF STUDY—SKILLS OUTCOMES Standard IV-A: The applicant must complete a curriculum of academic and clinical education that follows an appropriate sequence of learning sufficient to achieve the skills outcomes in Standard IV-G. Implementation: The applicant’s program of study should follow a systematic knowledge- and skill-building sequence in which basic course work and practicum precede, insofar as possible, more advanced course work and practicum. Standard IV-B: The applicant must possess skill in oral and written or other forms of communication sufficient for entry into professional practice. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate communication skills sufficient to achieve effective clinical and professional interaction with clients/patients and relevant others. For oral communication, the applicant must demonstrate speech and language skills in English, which, at a minimum, are consistent with ASHA’s most current position statement on students and professionals who speak English with accents and nonstandard dialects. For written communication, the applicant must be able to write and comprehend technical reports, diagnostic and treatment reports, treatment plans, and professional correspondence. Individuals educated in foreign countries must meet the criteria required by the International Commission of Healthcare Professions (ICHP) in order to meet this standard. Standard IV-C: The applicant for certification in speech-language pathology must complete a minimum of 400 clock hours of supervised clinical experience in the practice of speechlanguage pathology. Twenty-five hours must be spent in clinical observation, and 375 hours must be spent in direct client/patient contact. Implementation: Observation hours generally precede direct contact with clients/patients. However, completion of all 25 observation hours is not a prerequisite to begin direct client/patient contact. The observation and direct client/patient contact hours must be within the scope of practice of speech-language pathology. For certification purposes, observation experiences must be under the direction of a qualified clinical supervisor who holds current ASHA certification in the appropriate practice area. Such direction may occur simultaneously with the student’s observation or may be through review and approval of written reports or summaries submitted by the student. Students may use videotapes of the provision of client services for observation purposes. The applicant must maintain documentation of time spent in supervised observation, verified by the program in accordance with Standards III and IV. Applicants should be assigned practicum only after they have acquired a sufficient knowledge base to qualify for such experience. Only direct contact with the client or the client’s family in assessment, management, and/or counseling can be counted toward practicum. Although several students may observe a clinical session at one time, clinical practicum hours should be assigned only to the student who provides direct services to the client or client’s family. Typically, only one student should be working with a given client. In rare circumstances, it is possible for several students working as a team to receive credit for the same session depending on the specific responsibilities each student is assigned. For example, in a diagnostic session, if one student evaluates the client and another interviews the parents, both students may receive credit for the time each spent in providing the service. However, if one student works with the client for 30 minutes and another student works with the client for the next 45 minutes, each student receives credit for the time he/she actually provided services— that is, 30 and 45 minutes, not 75 minutes. The applicant must maintain documentation of time spent in supervised practicum, verified by the program in accordance with Standards III and IV. Standard IV-D: At least 325 of the 400 clock hours must be completed while the applicant is engaged in graduate study in a program accredited in speech-language pathology by the Council on Academic Accreditation in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology. Implementation: A minimum of 325 hours of clinical practicum must be completed at the graduate level. The remaining required hours may have been completed at the undergraduate level, at the discretion of the graduate program. Standard IV-E: Supervision must be provided by individuals who hold the Certificate of Clinical Competence in the appropriate area of practice. The amount of supervision must be appropriate to the student’s level of knowledge, experience, and competence. Supervision must be sufficient to ensure the welfare of the client/patient. Implementation: Direct supervision must be in real time and must never be less than 25% of the student’s total contact with each client/patient and must take place periodically throughout the practicum. These are minimum requirements that should be adjusted upward if the student’s level of knowledge, experience, and competence warrants. A supervisor must be available to consult as appropriate for the client’s/patient’s disorder with a student providing clinical services as part of the student’s clinical education. Supervision of clinical practicum must include direct observation, guidance, and feedback to permit the student to monitor, evaluate, and improve performance and to develop clinical competence. All observation and clinical practicum hours used to meet Standard IV-C must be supervised by individuals who hold a current CCC in the professional area in which the observation and practicum hours are being obtained Only the supervisor who actually observes the student in a clinical session is permitted to verify the credit given to the student for the clinical practicum hours. Standard IV-F: Supervised practicum must include experience with client/patient populations across the life span and from culturally/linguistically diverse backgrounds. Practicum must include experience with client/patient populations with various types and severities of communication and/or related disorders, differences, and disabilities. Implementation: The applicant must demonstrate direct client/patient clinical experiences in both diagnosis and treatment with both children and adults from the range of disorders and differences named in Standard III-C. Standard IV-G: The applicant for certification must complete a program of study that includes supervised clinical experiences sufficient in breadth and depth to achieve the following skills outcomes: 1. Evaluation: a. conduct screening and prevention procedures (including prevention activities) b. collect case history information and integrate information from clients/patients, family, caregivers, teachers, relevant others, and other professionals c. select and administer appropriate evaluation procedures, such as behavioral observations, nonstandardized and standardized tests, and instrumental procedures d. adapt evaluation procedures to meet client/patient needs e. interpret, integrate, and synthesize all information to develop diagnoses and make appropriate recommendations for intervention f. complete administrative and reporting functions necessary to support evaluation g. refer clients/patients for appropriate services 2. Intervention: a. develop setting -appropriate intervention plans with measurable and achie vable goals that meet clients’/patients’ needs. Collaborate with clients/patients and relevant others in the planning process b. implement intervention plans (Involve clients/patients and relevant others in the intervention process c. select or develop and use appropriate materials and instrumentation for prevention and intervention d. measure and evaluate clients’/patients’ performance and progress e. modify intervention plans, strategies, materials, or instrumentation as appropriate to meet the needs of clients/patients f. complete administrative and reporting functions necessary to support intervention g. identify and refer clients/patients for services as appropriate 3. Interaction and Personal Qualities: a. communicate effectively, recognizing the needs, values, preferred mode of communication, and cultural/linguistic background of the client/patient, family, caregivers, and relevant others b. collaborate with other professionals in case management c. provide counseling regarding communication and swallowing disorders to clients /patients, family, caregivers, and relevant others d. adhere to the ASHA Code of Ethics and behave professionally Implementation: The applicant must document the acquisition of the skills referred to in this Standard applicable across the nine major areas listed in Standard III-C. Clinical skills may be developed and demonstrated by means other than direct client/patient contact in clinical practicum experiences, such as academic course work, labs, simulations, examinations, and completion of independent projects. This documentation must be maintained and verified by the program director or official designee. For certification purposes, only direct client/patient contact may be applied toward the required minimum of 375 clock hours of supervised clinical experience. STANDARD V: ASSESSMENT The applicant for certification must demonstrate successful achievement of the knowledge and skills delineated in Standard III and Standard IV by means of both formative and summative assessment. Standard V-A: Formative Assessment The applicant must meet the education program’s requirements for demonstrating satisfactory performance through ongoing formative assessment of knowledge and skills. Implementation: Formative assessment yields critical information for monitoring an individual’s acquisition of knowledge and skills. Therefore, to ensure that the applicant pursues the outcomes stipulated in Standard III and Standard IV in a systematic manner, academic and clinical educators must have assessed developing knowledge and skills throughout the applicant’s program of graduate study. Applicants may also be part of the process through self-assessment. Applicants and program faculties should use the ongoing assessment to help the applicant achieve requisite knowledge and skills. Thus, assessments should be followed by implementation of strategies for acquisition of knowledge and skills. The applicant must adhere to the academic program’s formative assessment process and must maintain records verifying ongoing formative assessment. The applicant shall make these records available to the Council For Clinical Certification upon its request. Documentation of formative assessment may take a variety of forms, such as checklists of skills, records of progress in clinical skill development, portfolios, and statements of achievement of academic and practicum course objectives, among others. Standard V-B: Summative Assessment The applicant must pass the national examination adopted by ASHA for purposes of certification in speech-language pathology. Implementation: Summative assessment is a comprehensive examination of learning outcomes at the culmination of professional preparation. Evidence of a passing score on the ASHA-approved national examination in speech-language pathology must be submitted to the National Office by the testing agency administering the examination. STANDARD VI: SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP After completion of academic course work and practicum (Standard VI), the applicant then must successfully complete a Speech-Language Pathology Clinical Fellowship (SLPCF). Implementation: The Clinical Fellow may be engaged in clinical service delivery or clinical research that fosters the continued growth and integration of the knowledge, skills, and tasks of clinical practice in speechlanguage pathology consistent with ASHA’s current Scope of Practice. The Clinical Fellow’s major responsibilities must be in direct client/patient contact, consultations, record keeping, and administrative duties. The SLPCF may not be initiated until completion of the graduate course work and graduate clinical practicum required for ASHA certification. It is the Clinical Fellow’s responsibility to identify a mentoring speech-language pathologist (SLP) who holds a current Certificate of Clinical Competence in Speech-Language Pathology. Before beginning the SLPCF and periodically throughout the SLPCF experience, the Clinical Fellow must contact the ASHA National Office to verify the mentoring SLP’s current certification status. Standard VI-A: The mentoring speech-language pathologist and Speech-Language Pathology Clinical Fellow will establish outcomes and performance levels to be achieved during the Speech-Language Pathology Fellowship (SLPCF), based on the Clinical Fellow’s academic experiences, setting -specific requirements, and professional interests/goals. Implementation: The Clinical Fellow and mentoring SLP will determine outcomes and performance levels in a goalsetting conference within 4 weeks of initiating the SLPCF. It is the Clinical Fellow’s responsibility to retain documentation of the agreed-upon outcomes and performance levels. The mentoring SLP’s guidance should be adequate throughout the SLPCF to achieve the stated outcomes, such that the Clinical Fellow can function independently by the completion of the SLPCF. The Clinical Fellow will submit the SLPCF Report and Rating Form to the Council For Clinical Certification at the conclusion of the SLPCF. Standard VI-B: The Clinical Fellow and mentoring SLP must engage in periodic assessment of the Clinical Fellow’s performance, evaluating the Clinical Fellow’s progress toward meeting the established goals and achievement of the clinical skills necessary for independent practice. Implementation: Assessment of performance may be by both formal and informal means. The Clinical Fellow and mentoring SLP should keep a written record of assessment processes and recommendations. One means of assessment must be the SLPCF Report and Rating Form. Standard VI-C: The Speech-Language Pathology Clinical Fellowship (SLPCF) will consist of the equivalent of 36 weeks of full-time clinical practice. Implementation: Full-time clinical practice is defined as a minimum of 35 hours per week in direct patient/client contact, consultations, record keeping, and administrative duties relevant to a bona fide program of clinical work. The length of the SLPCF may be modified for less than full-time employment (FTE) as follows: 15-20 hours/week over 72 weeks 21-26 hours/week over 60 weeks 27-34 hours/week over 48 weeks Professional experience of less than 15 hours per week does not meet the requirement and may not be counted toward the SLPCF. Similarly, experience of more than 35 hours per week cannot be used to shorten the SLPCF to less than 36 weeks. Standard VI-D: The Clinical Fellow must submit evidence of successful completion of the Speech-Language Pathology Clinical Fellowship (SLPCF) to the Council For Clinical Certification. Implementation: The Clinical Fellow must submit the SLPCF Report and Rating Form, which includes the CFSI and documentation of successful achievement of the goals established at the beginning of the SLPCF. This report must be completed by both the Clinical Fellow and the mentoring SLP. The Clinical Fellow must also submit the Employer(s) Verification Form, signed by the employer, which attests to the completion of the 36-week full-time SLPCF or its part-time equivalent. STANDARD VII: MAINTENANCE OF CERTIFICATION Demonstration of continued professional development is mandated for maintenance of the Certificate of Clinical Competence in Speech-Language Pathology. This standard will take effect on January 1, 2005. The renewal period will be 3 years. This standard will apply to all certificate holders, regardless of the date of initial certification. Implementation: Individuals who hold the Certificate of Clinical Competence (CCC) in Speech-Language Pathology must accumulate 30 contact hours of professional development over the 3-year period in order to meet this standard. At the time of payment of the annual certification fee, individuals holding the CCC in Speech-Language Pathology must acknowledge that they agree to meet this standard. At the conclusion of the renewal period, certified individuals will verify that they have met the requirements of the standard. Individuals will be subject to random review of their professional development activities. If renewal of certification is not accomplished by the end of the 3-year period, certification will lapse. Re-application for certification will be required, and certification standards in effect at the time of re-application must be met. Continued professional development may be demonstrated through one or more of the following options: • Accumulation of 3 continuing education units (CEUs) (30 contact hours) from continuing education providers approved by the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA). ASHA CEUs may be earned through group activities (e.g., workshops, conferences), independent study (e.g., course development, research projects, internships, attendance at educational programs offered by non-ASHA CE providers), and self-study (e.g., videotapes, audiotapes, journals). • Accumulation of 3 CEUs (30 contact hours) from a provider authorized by the International Association for Continuing Education and Training (IACET). • Accumulation of 2 semester hours (3 quarter hours) from a college or university that holds regional accreditation or accreditation from an equivalent nationally recognized or governmental accreditation authority. • Accumulation of 30 contact hours from employer-sponsored in-service or other continuing education activities that contribute to professional development. Professional development is defined as any activity that relates to the science and contemporary practice of audiology, speech-language pathology, and speech/language/hearing sciences, and results in the acquisition of new knowledge and skills or the enhancement of current knowledge and skills. Professional development activities should be planned in advance and be based on an assessment of knowledge, skills and competencies of the individual and/or an assessment of knowledge, skills, and competencies required for the independent practice of any area of the professions. For the first renewal cycle, beginning January 1, 2005, applications for renewal will be processed on a staggered basis, determined by their initial certification dates. For individuals initially certified before January 1, 1980, professional development activities must be completed between January 1, 2005, and December 31, 2007; for individuals initially certified between January 1, 1980, and December 31, 1989, professional development activities must be completed between January 1, 2006, and December 31, 2008; and for individuals initially certified after January 1, 1990, professional development activities must be completed between January 1, 2007, and December 31, 2009. All individuals will have a 3-year period to complete the process for renewal of certification. WHAT IS A CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP? CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP: REQUIREMENTS AND PROCEDURES The American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA) maintains that academic and practicum experiences alone are not sufficient preparation for an individual to function as an independent, competent professional providing high quality care in speech-language pathology. Therefore, all applicants for the Certificates of Clinical Competence (CCC) are required to successfully complete a clinical fellowship (CF) in addition to the required academic and practicum experiences and the national examination in speech-language pathology. The clinical fellowship is an important transitional phase between supervised graduate-level practicum and the independent delivery of services. Inherent in this transition are: • development of a total commitment to quality speech, language, and hearing services; • integration and application of theoretical knowledge gained in academic training; • evaluation of individual strengths and limitations; • refinement of clinical skills; • and development of clinical skills consistent with the current scope of practice in the profession. CLINICAL FELLOWS The clinical fellow is an individual who is obtaining the supervised professional clinical experience required to obtain the CCC. Professional experience includes direct patient contact, consultations, record keeping, or any other duties relevant to a bona fide program of clinical work. Time spent in supervision of students, academic teaching, and research, as well as administrative activity that does not deal directly with patient management, may not be counted as professional experience in this context. The clinical fellow may not supervise students in clinical practicum. Academic and clinical practicum requirements must be completed before the clinical fellowship is initiated. The clinical fellow must request supervision from a person holding a current CCC-SLP. It is the responsibility of the clinical fellow to verify the certification status of the clinical fellowship supervisor before initiating the experience and to verify the supervisor's continuing certification throughout the duration of the clinical fellowship experience. Individuals may verify the certification status of their supervisor in the following ways: (a) call ASHA's Action Center at its toll-free number (1-800-498-2071); (b) call the Certification office at the National Office (301-897-5700); or (c) ask to see your supervisor's ASHA membership card with the expiration date. Information to note: • A family member or individual related in any way to the clinical fellow may not serve as a clinical fellowship supervisor. • If dual certification is sought, full clinical fellowship requirements must be met in each area. • ASHA's Board of Ethics has determined that clinical fellows may specify "CF/SLP" after their names. However, if you wish to provide clinical services in the United States, you must first contact the appropriate state regulatory agency for specific regulations regarding use of the designation of audiologist (A) or speech-language pathologist (SLP). STATE LICENSURE/REGULATORY REQUIREMENTS Before beginning a clinical fellowship, the clinical fellow should determine what the state licensing agency requires of persons fulfilling a clinical fellowship. Some states use a different designation for the fellowship (e.g., Required Professional Employment). Many states require clinical fellows to register with the licensing agency, obtain a provisional or temporary license, and/or file a clinical fellowship plan. The addresses and phone numbers of the state regulatory agencies are on ASHA's Web site. Completing the clinical fellowship without also meeting the state requirements may jeopardize one's ability to practice. CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP SETTING It is recognized that services for persons with speech, language, and hearing disabilities can be provided in any one of a number of diverse employment settings. The determination of whether a given setting is appropriate for the clinical fellowship is made by first applying the criterion of whether the particular program or program component is designed to evaluate, habilitate, or rehabilitate individuals with speech, language, and hearing disabilities. Second, the program must afford the possibility that clinical fellowship supervisory requirements can be met. It is the clinical fellow's responsibility to obtain employment in a setting that meets these criteria. It is also the clinical fellow's responsibility to abide by ASHA's "Code of Ethics" during the clinical fellowship. It is further recognized that many highly specialized programs are appropriate for the clinical fellowship, even though they deal intensively with only a small number of individuals. Evaluation and treatment programs in schools, clinics, hospitals, community agencies, nursing homes, and home health agencies are appropriate clinical fellowship settings. However, programs that primarily provide screening services are not suitable for the clinical fellowship experience. Because the clinical fellowship is not intended to be an extension of the clinical practicum experience undertaken as part of academic study, the clinical service program of an educational program may not be an appropriate work setting for the clinical fellowship. If such a site is selected for the clinical fellowship, it is important that the clinical fellow perform clinical services as a bona fide staff member and that all of the requirements for the clinical fellowship are met. If the clinical fellow changes the clinical fellowship site, the clinical fellowship supervisor, or the category of number of hours worked per week, the clinical fellow must document any changes in the final Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (see Form D) as noted below. For example, if a clinical fellow began the clinical fellowship indicating the intent to work 18 hours/week and after 2 months of work he/she changes to 26 hours/week or after 3 months of work selects another supervisor and moves to another facility, then those changes must be documented in the final report, with a separate report submitted for each component of the experience. Professional Services Accreditation. ASHA administers a voluntary accreditation program for speech-language pathology and audiology programs in a variety of clinical facilities in which the clinical fellowship experience may occur. The program documents and verifies use of standards established by the Council on Professional Standards. The ASHA "Guidelines for Professional Service Programs in Audiology and Speech-Language Pathology" address the following areas: program mission, goals, and objectives; nature and quality of services; quality improvement and program evaluation; administration; financial resources and management; human resources; physical facilities and program environment; and equipment and materials. Professional services accreditation demonstrates to regulatory agencies, insurance carriers, HMOs, and other funding agencies that a clinical program meets ASHA's nationally recognized standards of quality service delivery. This accreditation is currently used by many state funding agencies as the criterion for selection of speech-language pathology and audiology service providers. Although it is not required that the facility in which an individual completes the clinical fellowship be accredited by ASHA's Professional Services Accreditation (PSA) program, it is recognized that the current PSA guidelines do ensure the provision of both high quality services to the public and a commitment to adequate supervision of non-certified staff members. Individuals completing their clinical fellowship in an accredited facility will not be required to complete the entire Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D), as described later. For a complete list of accredited clinical service delivery programs, you can consult ASHA's Web site. LENGTH OF CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP The clinical fellowship is defined as no less than 36 weeks of full-time professional employment. A minimum of 30 hours of work per week constitutes full-time employment. At least 80% of the clinical fellowship work week must be in direct client contact (assessment, diagnosis, evaluation, screening, habilitation, or rehabilitation) related to the management process. Thus, in a 30-hour work week, at least 24 hours must be devoted to direct clinical activities. The clinical fellowship requirement can also be met by less than full-time employment. For example, if the clinical fellow works: • 25-29 hours per week, the length of the clinical fellowship must be at least 48 weeks. • 20-24 hours per week, the length of the clinical fellowship must be at least 60 weeks. • 15-19 hours per week, the length of the clinical fellowship must be at least 72 weeks. Professional employment of less than 15 hours per week may not be used to fulfill any part of the clinical fellowship requirement . If the clinical fellowship is not completed within 4 years of the date the academic and practicum education is completed, the clinical fellow must reapply and meet the academic and practicum requirements in effect at the time of reapplication. ALTERNATE MECHANISM FOR SUPERVISION The CFCC recognizes that under certain circumstances alternative mechanisms may be necessary to meet the clinical fellowship supervision requirements. A request to use an alternative method to meet clinical fellowship supervision requirements must be submitted in writing to the CFCC. The request must include a detailed outline explaining the type, length, and frequency of each alternative supervisory activity and the reason for the alternative. For example, if the request is for the use of videotapes instead of direct observations, the fellow must specify the length of each videotaped session, how often the videotapes will be made, and the total number of such videotapes. The request and the detailed outline of the proposed alternate supervisory program must be approved by the CFCC before initiation of the clinical fellowship . CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP SUPERVISOR A clinical fellow can be supervised only by an individual holding a valid CCC in the professional area in which the clinical fellow is seeking certification. A family member or individual related in any way to the clinical fellow may not serve as the clinical fellowship supervisor. It is the responsibility of the clinical fellowship supervisor to maintain his/her certification during the entire clinical fellowship period through timely payment of annual dues and fees. If the clinical fellowship supervisor's certification lapses, the clinical fellow may be required to extend his/her clinical fellowship. Currently, individuals are not required to work a minimum amount of time after becoming certified before supervising other individuals. However, clinical fellows are encouraged to seek supervisors with some prior supervisory experience. If a clinical fellow is supervised by multiple individuals, it is the responsibility of one clinical fellowship supervisor to collate the evaluations of all supervisors and to verify that the policies governing supervision and evaluation have been met. All clinical fellowship supervisors must hold a current CCC in the area in which certification is sought and must maintain this certification throughout the period of supervision. Learn and Earn for Supervisors. Did you know that CF supervisors may earn ASHA CEUs for the new supervisory knowledge and skills acquired as a result of their supervisory experience? For more information, see Learning Related to Clinical Fellow Supervision. Mandatory Supervision Requirements. Clinical fellowship supervision must include the personal and direct involvement of the supervisor. The clinical fellowship supervisor must directly observe diagnostic and therapeutic procedures in order to monitor and evaluate the clinical fellow's performance in professional employment. The clinical fellowship is divided into three equal segments, each segment representing one third of the total experience. For example, a 36-week clinical fellowship is divided into three 12-week segments; a 72-week clinical fellowship is divided into three 24-week segments. The clinical fellowship supervisor must complete no less than 36 supervisory activities spaced uniformly throughout the clinical fellowship. The supervisor must complete at least 18 on-site observations (one hour = 1 on-site observation). At least 6 on-site observations must be accrued during each third of the experience (up to 6 hours may be accrued in one day). In addition to direct observation, the clinical fellowship supervisor must complete 18 other monitoring activities, at least 6 per segment . Such activities may include: • conferring with the clinical fellow concerning clinical treatment strategies • monitoring changes in clients' communication behaviors ' evaluating the clinical fellow's clinical records, including (a) diagnostic records, (b) treatment records, (c) correspondence, (d) plans of treatment, and (e) summaries of clinical conferences (These activities may be conducted in correspondence.) • monitoring the clinical fellow's participation in case conferences • evaluating the clinical fellow on the basis of consultation with professional colleagues and employers • evaluating the clinical fellow's work on the basis of consultation with clients and their families • monitoring the clinical fellow's contributions to professional meetings and publications, as well as participation in other professional growth opportunities. Clinical Fellowship Supervisor's Responsibilities. From time to time, the Board of Ethics determines that members and certificate holders can benefit from additional analysis and instruction concerning a specific issue of ethical conduct. Issues in Ethics statements are intended to heighten sensitivity and increase awareness. They are illustrative of the "Code of Ethics" and intended to promote thoughtful consideration of ethical issues. They may assist members and certificate holders in engaging in self-guided ethical decision-making. These statements do not absolutely prohibit or require specified activity. The facts and circumstances surrounding a matter of concern will determine whether the activity is ethical. The current Issues in Ethics statement, "Clinical Fellowship Supervisor's Responsibilities," is available on ASHA's Web site. Guidelines for Direct Expense Reimbursement for Clinical Fellowship Supervisors. It is the interpretation of the CFCC that clinical fellowship supervisors should not accept compensation for supervision or sponsorship from the clinical fellow being supervised or sponsored, beyond reasonable reimbursement for direct expenses. The guidelines below apply specifically to those instances in which direct expenses are personally assumed by the clinical fellow. 1. The clinical fellow and the clinical fellowship supervisor should execute a written agreement, and each should retain a signed copy. The agreement should include: • the duration of the supervision • the number of on-site supervisory activities and the duration of each on-site supervisory activity • the occasion, nature, and number of other monitoring activities • the mechanism whereby the clinical fellow receives feedback • the clinical fellowship supervisor's commitment to complete and sign the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D) within 30 days of completion of the CF experience • a mechanism for terminating the clinical fellowship if it becomes necessary before the expected completion date • an account of the direct expenses for which the clinical fellowship supervisor will be reimbursed (e.g., transportation, meals, lodging, telephone, etc.) • the payment schedule for reimbursement of direct expenses incurred by the clinical fellowship supervisor (Payment must not be conditional upon the clinical fellowship supervisor's recommendation for approval of the clinical fellowship.) • a statement that both the supervisor and the clinical fellow have verified that the clinical fellowship supervisor's certification is current throughout the clinical fellowship. 2. Expenses should be reimbursed at a reasonable level. Reasonable refers to the exact expenses incurred for transportation, meals, lodging, telephone, and postage. 3. If the clinical fellow and the clinical fellowship supervisor work for the same employer or institution, there shall be no remuneration. EVALUATION OF CLINICAL FELLOWS The Standards for the Certificates of Clinical Competence require the clinical fellowship supervisor to conduct periodic formal evaluations of the clinical fellow. The section on " Clinical Fellowship Skills Inventory (CFSI-SLP) " contains instructions for use during the formal evaluations. It is the responsibility of the clinical fellow and the clinical fellowship supervisor to make certain that they follow the instructions in these sections and that the clinical fellowship supervisor uses the CFSISLP (see Form E) to complete the mandatory evaluations and that these ratings are entered on the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D). As stated in the CFCC Implementation Procedures, the clinical fellowship supervisor must use the current evaluation instrument at least once during each of the three segments of the clinical fellowship. That is, the supervisor must conduct at least three formal evaluations using the Clinical Fellowship Skills Inventory, spaced uniformly throughout the clinical fellowship. No later than 4 weeks after the clinical fellowship is completed, the clinical fellow and the clinical fellowship supervisor must sign, date, and submit to the National Office for review by the CFCC a Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D) reflecting the three formal evaluations . If a clinical fellow is supervised by multiple individuals, it is the responsibility of one clinical fellowship supervisor to collate the evaluations of all supervisors and to verify that the policies governing supervision and evaluation have been met. All clinical fellowship supervisors must hold a current CCC in the area in which certification is sought, and they must maintain this certification throughout the period of supervision. Ongoing Feedback. Because one purpose of the clinical fellowship is to improve the clinical effectiveness of the clinical fellow, supervisors must provide performance feedback to the clinical fellow throughout the clinical fellowship . Feedback and goal-setting require two-way communication whereby both the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow share important information about the clinical fellow's performance of clinical activities. A specific time should be set aside for each performance feedback session at the end of each of the three segments of the clinical fellowship. This session should be used to identify performance strengths and weaknesses and, through discussion and goal-setting, to assist the clinical fellow in developing the required skills. If the clinical fellowship supervisor anticipates at any time during the clinical fellowship that the clinical fellow under supervision will fail to meet requirements, the clinical fellowship supervisor must counsel the clinical fellow both orally and in writing and maintain written records of all contacts and conferences over the ensuing months. If the clinical fellowship experience is terminated at any time before completion of the clinical fellowship, or if the clinical fellowship supervisor does not recommend approval of the clinical fellowship experience at the end of the clinical fellowship, he/she must so indicate in Section 8 of the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form. Within 30 days of making the negative recommendation, the clinical fellowship supervisor must submit to the CFCC (a) a letter of explanation and supporting documentation, and (b) a signed Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form completed for the portion of the clinical fellowship he/she supervised. This information must be shared with the clinical fellow. Following a negative recommendation, the clinical fellow may complete an entirely new clinical fellowship, a portion of the clinical fellowship, and/or request an Initial Determination Review by the CFCC. Initial Determination. To request an Initial Determination Review, the clinical fellow must submit to the CFCC within 30 days of the negative recommendation (a) the completed and signed Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D and (b) a letter of explanation and supporting documentation to indicate why the clinical fellowship should be accepted. The CFCC may share this information with the clinical fellowship supervisor and may solicit any additional information the supervisor wishes to provide. The decision to approve the clinical fellowship rests solely with the CFCC. The CFCC will review all information submitted to determine if the clinical fellowship experience will be approved, in part or in full. (For more information see Section VII. Procedures for Appeal). Clinical Fellowship Skills Inventory (CFSI-SLP). The CFSI-SLP provides the means for determining whether the clinical fellow can satisfactorily perform the skills necessary for independent practice and addresses the need to assess the clinical fellow in developing these skills. The CFSI-SLP stresses the need for both the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow to identify performance areas in which improvement is needed and then to develop and implement performance improvement plans. This approach to the performance appraisal process includes the following features: (a) a standardized system for reviewing the clinical work of all clinical fellows at regularly scheduled intervals, (b) a procedure to ensure that the clinical fellow has the skills for independent practice, (c) a means by which the clinical fellowship supervisor can meaningfully supervise the clinical fellow's progress in attaining and improving skills, (d) a process by which the clinical fellow gains experience in the self-evaluation of his or her skills, and (e) a collaborative effort in which the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow are encouraged to work together to make the clinical fellowship a valuable learning experience. Performance appraisal protects the public interest and serves as a clinical teaching and learning tool. The CFSI-SLP consists of 18 skill segments covering four areas. The skills selected for inclusion in the CFSI-SLP are derived from a role delineation and validation study conducted for ASHA by the Professional Examination Service. Following is a general description of each of the four performance areas: • Evaluation (5 skills): selection, adaptation, administration of an assessment battery and interpretation of results • Treatment (5 skills): selection, development, adaptation, and implementation of treatment plans and intervention strategies • Management (3 skills): service activities and compliance with administrative and policy requirements • Interaction (5 skills): communication skills and collaboration with other professionals The rating scale for each skill has been designed along a 5-point continuum, ranging from '5' (representing the most effective performance) to '1' (representing the least effective performance). The clinical fellowship supervisor will match the clinical fellow's performance to the descriptors for each skill. The ratings for one skill may not be the same as the ratings for other skills. For each skill included on the CFSI-SLP the clinical fellowship supervisor will have to decide which point on the scale best reflects the performance of the clinical fellow during the segment being rated. The category "Not Applicable (NA)" appears on two items of the rating scale and may be used only for these items. NA should be used only if the facility does not provide an opportunity for the clinical fellow to perform the skill during the segment. However, the clinical fellowship supervisor is encouraged to coordinate the observation schedule to ensure that all applicable skills are observed and evaluated. The clinical fellowship supervisor must use the rating scale at least once during each of the three segments of the clinical fellowship. This evaluation must be shared and discussed with the clinical fellow. Supervisors must follow the instructions below to complete the rating process at the end of each segment. Instructions for the Rating Process The clinical fellowship supervisor completes the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D) to rate the performance of the clinical fellow on each of 18 skills. Both the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow must sign the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form and note the dates when the performance feedback sessions were held. At the end of the clinical fellowship, the clinical fellowship supervisor mails the completed Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form to the Certification office at ASHA. The clinical fellowship supervisor retains a photocopy of the completed Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form. At the beginning of the first segment of the clinical fellowship, the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow should meet to discuss assigned work responsibilities, performance expectations, and the requirement that regularly scheduled performance appraisals be conducted during the clinical fellowship. They should review the CFSI-SLP to ensure that both the skills to be evaluated and the rating scale are understood and to determine if there is a particular skill or skill area requiring a special focus. Setting goals at this time to prepare for the second and third segments will give the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow an opportunity to discuss concerns that have arisen and to plan new performance goals before the beginning of another segment. Goal setting also encourages the supervisor and fellow to consider realistically how much improvement can be achieved from one performance assessment to another. It is an important component in the performance appraisal process--one that requires collaboration between the clinical fellowship supervisor and the clinical fellow. The clinical fellow should prepare for each performance feedback session by reviewing the CFSISLP (i.e., the performance skills and rating scale). It is also recommended that the clinical fellow conduct a self-evaluation using the CFSI-SLP. Self-evaluation can provide the clinical fellow with important insights to use in improving performance. The clinical fellow can then compare his or her own ratings with those given by the clinical fellowship supervisor. Minimum Rating for Core Skills. Core skills must be assessed during at least one segment of the clinical fellowship, and each skill must receive a rating of at least a "3" on a 5-point scale during the last segment in which the core skill is rated. The core skills are 2-5, 8-11, and 14-17 and are so noted on the list of skills found in Appendix 5. For clinical fellowships initiated as of September 1, 1997, a minimum rating of "3" on core skills during the last segment in which the core skill was rated will be required for approval of the fellowship. Supervisors may rate the clinical fellow only on the clinical skills identified in the CFSI. If a rating of "3" is achieved for each of the core skills during the last segment in which the core skill was rated, the supervisor must include in the final Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form a positive recommendation for certification or provide a specific rationale and documentation for why the fellow is not being recommended for certification. CLINICAL FELLOWSHIP REPORT AND RATING FORM Upon completion of the clinical fellowship, a conference must be held to provide the clinical fellow the opportunity to discuss the evaluation with the supervisor. The supervisor and the clinical fellow must complete, sign, and submit the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D) to the CFCC as soon as possible after completion of the clinical fellowship. If the application for certification has not been submitted to the National Office, it must be filed at this time. If a change is made in the clinical fellowship site, clinical fellowship supervisor, or category of hours worked per week, the clinical fellowship supervisor must submit to the CFCC, within 4 weeks of the change, the completed and signed Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form for the portion of the clinical fellowship that was completed. Remember --a separate Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form must be submitted for each component of the clinical fellowship that involved a change of site, supervisor, or work schedule. WHAT IS THE NATIONAL EXAMINATION IN SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY? GENERAL INFORMATION The national examination in speech-language pathology is administered at least five times a year as the Specialty Area Test of the Praxis Series by the Educational Testing Service (ETS). The examination is administered at over 400 test centers throughout the nation. All sites administer exams that follow the same content outline. The exam "Registration Bulletin" and "Tests At A Glance" (TAAG), which contains the content outline and sample questions for the examination, may be obtained directly from ETS. The Praxis Series Educational Testing Service P.O. Box 6051 Princeton, NJ 08541-6051 800-772-9476 (TTY: 800-272-1391) The examination is designed to measure the examinees' academic preparation in and knowledge of the profession. The examination focuses on three major areas: (a) evaluation, (b) management, and (c) administration. The examination has approximately 150 objective multiple-choice questions that must be answered in approximately 2 hours. To answer the test questions, applicants must recall basic knowledge, interpret data, and use data to solve problems. Some questions may require the examinee to interpret and analyze data similar to that seen in a clinical setting. Applicants for the Certificates of Clinical Competence (CCC) must pass the examination in speech-language pathology within 2 years from the date the course work and practicum submitted by the applicant are approved by the Council For Clinical Certification (CFCC). Within this 2-year period, the applicant may retake the examination as often as it is administered until a passing score is achieved. If the applicant does not pass the examination during this period, the certification file will be closed, and the applicant will be required to reapply for certification, after passing the exam, and meet the standards in effect at the time of reapplication. PASSING SCORE Applicants for certification must pass the national examination in the area for which certification is desired. The current passing score is 600. REPORTING SCORES Exam results must be sent directly from the Educational Testing Service (ETS) in order to be applicable toward certification. When you register to take the exam, request that your score be reported directly to ASHA. ETS charges an additional fee to report scores after the examination has been taken. To have ETS report your score to ASHA use the code R-5031 for Certification on the exam Registration Form as indicated in the ETS "Registration Bulletin." Your score will be sent to the ASHA National Office within 8 weeks of the examination date. The National Office is able to automatically match scores with individuals only if your application for certification is on file with the Certification office at the time the score is received and if a computer record has been established for you. To assist the National Office in processing your examination information, it will be helpful if you submit a copy of the report sent to you by the testing service when you submit your application for certification. However, please note that this copy will not be used as official verification of completion of the examination requirement. PREPARATION FOR THE NATIONAL EXAMINATION The CFCC encourages you to register and take the examination no earlier than the completion of your graduate education. To help you prepare for the test, the ETS has made available study guides for the examination, which can be ordered directly from ETS. The study guide contains the content outline for the examination, sample questions, helpful suggestions for test-taking, and a practice test. For information on ordering the study guide, refer to the Test Code 0330 and order online at http://www.ets.org or mail the order to: The Praxis Series Educational Testing Service N00 P.O. Box 6058 Princeton, NJ 08541-6058 ASHA does not currently offer review courses or sell study guides. However, some review courses are offered by certain universities, state speech-language-hearing associations, or continuing education sponsors. To obtain information regarding these courses, please call the agencies directly or call ASHA's Continuing Education unit at 301-897-5700 for any offerings in your area. Additionally, consult ASHA's Web site for information on the examination. Individuals With Disabilities If the applicant for ASHA certification has a disability that impairs his or her ability to take the examination under standard conditions, the individual should contact ETS directly to arrange for appropriate accommodations. The examinee should write to The Praxis Series, Nonstandard Testing Accommodations, Educational Testing Service, P.O. Box 6054, Princeton, NJ 085416054. Applicants requesting nonstandard testing arrangements must complete and submit to ETS the following items: Exam Registration Form Eligibility Questionnaire Certification of Documentation Form Appropriate forms and additional information regarding the requirements for nonstandard testing accommodations can be found in the examination "Registration Bulletin." SAVE YOUR EXAM SCORE. The ETS retains an examination score for 5 years only. Therefore, you must keep your exam score in a secure place with other important documents. If in the future you apply for certification or state licensure and are unable to provide a copy of your examination score, you may be required to take the exam again and obtain a passing score in effect at that time. The ASHA National Office is not responsible for maintaining examination scores after certification is awarded. Technical Report 2001 / I - 25 25 Scope of Practice Practice • Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology Ad Hoc Committee on Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology This document was approved by the ASHA Legislative Council in April 2001 (LC 7-01). Members of the 000 Ad Hoc Committee on Scope of Practice in SpeechLanguage Pathology who developed this document are Nicholas Bankson (chair), Allan Diefendorf, Roberta Elman, Susan Forsythe, Elizabeth Gavett, Alex Johnson (vice president for professional practices in speech-language pathology who serves as Executive Board liaison), Lori Lombard, Ninevah Murray, Arlene Pietranton (ex officio), and Carmen Vega-Barachowitz. Statement of Purpose The purpose of this document is to define the scope of practice in speech-language pathology in order to: l. Delineate areas of speech-language pathology professional practice provided by members of the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association (ASHA) and clinical certification holders in accordance with the ASHA Code of Ethics; 2. Educate health care, education, and other professionals, consumers, payers, regulators, and members of the general public about professional services offered by speech-language pathologists as qualified providers; 3. Assist ASHA members and certificate holders in the provision of high quality and evidencebased services to individuals across the life Reference this material as: American Speech-LanguageHearing Association. (2001). Scope of practice in speechlanguage pathology. Rockville, MD: Author. Index terms: ASHA reference products, practice scope and patterns, SLP education and qualifications, SLP practice settings, SLP roles and activities, speech-language pathology, World Health Organization (WHO) framework Document type: Practice guidelines and policies 4. span who present with communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive concerns1; Provide guidance for education programs in speech-language pathology curriculum. The scope of practice defined here and the areas specifically set forth describe the breadth of professional practice offered within the profession. Levels of education, experience, skill, and proficiency with respect to the activities identified within this scope of practice vary among individual providers; a speechlanguage pathologist does not typically practice in all areas of the field. As the ASHA Code of Ethics specifies, individuals may only practice in areas in which they are competent based on their education, training, and experience. However, speech-language pathologists may expand their current level of expertise. Certain situations may necessitate that speech-language pathologists pursue additional education or training to expand their personal scope of practice. This scope of practice statement does not supersede existing state licensure laws or affect the interpretation or implementation of such laws. It may serve, however, as a model for the development or modification of licensure laws. The schema in Figure 1 (see next page) depicts the relationship of the scope of practice to practice policy documents, certification standards, and the ASHA Code of Ethics. As indicated, individuals must fulfill the speech-language pathology certification standards in order to enter the practice of the profession. Practice policy documents (i.e., preferred practice patterns, position statements, guidelines, and knowledge and skills statements), address current and emerging speech-language pathology practice areas. These docu1 aeromechanical events related to communication, respiration, and swallowing (e.g., speaking valve selection, respiratory retraining for paradoxical vocal fold motion, stomal stenosis management and insufflation testing after total laryngectomy). I - 26 / 2001 ASHA Desk Reference 2002 • Cardinal Documents of the Association ments build on the knowledge, skills, and experiences required by the certification standards. The ASHA Code of Ethics sets forth the fundamental principles and rules considered essential to the preservation of the highest standards of integrity and ethical conduct to which members of the profession of speech-language pathology are bound. Speech-language pathology is a dynamic and continuously developing profession; listing specific areas within this scope of practice does not exclude emerging areas of practice. Although not specifically identified in this document, in certain instances speech-language pathologists may be called on to perform services (e.g., “multiskilling” in a health care setting, collaborative service delivery in schools) for the well-being of the individual(s) they are serving. In such instances it is both ethically and legally incumbent upon professionals to determine that they have the knowledge and skills necessary to conduct such tasks. Finally, it should be indicated that factors such as changes in service delivery systems, increasing numbers of people needing services, projected United States population growth of cultural and linguistic minority groups, and technological and scientific advances mandate that a scope of practice statement for the profession of speech-language pathology be dynamic in nature. For these reasons this document will undergo periodic review and possible revision. Framework for Practice The domain of speech-language pathology includes human communication behaviors and disorders as well as swallowing or other upper aerodigestive functions and disorders. The overall objective of speech-language pathology services is to optimize individuals’ ability to communicate and/or swallow in natural environments, and thus improve their quality of life. This objective is best achieved through the provision of integrated services in meaningful life contexts. The World Health Organization Practice • Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology (WHO) is in the process of finalizing a multipurpose health classification system identified as the International Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health (ICIDH-2)* that offers clinical service providers an internationally recognized conceptual framework and common language for discussing and describing human functioning and disability (WHO, 2000). This framework can be used to describe the role of speech-language pathologists in enhancing quality of life by optimizing human communication behavior, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive functions regardless of setting. The ICIDH-2 [ICF] framework has two parts. The first is termed Functioning and Disability; the second refers to Contextual Factors. Functioning and Disability includes the following two components: • Body Functions and Structures: Body Functions refers to the physiological or psychological functions of body systems; Body Structures *Editor’s note: In 2001 the original acronym, ICIDH-2, was changed to ICF. • 2001 / I - 27 refers to the anatomic parts of the body and their components. Activity and Participation: Activity refers to the performance of a task or action of a given individual; Participation refers to an individual’s involvement in a life situation. Both Activity and Participation components are modified with Capacity and Performance qualifiers. The Capacity qualifier describes an individual’s ability to execute a task or an action in a standardized or uniform environment. The Performance qualifier describes what an individual does in the current environment or actual context in which s/he lives. Figure 2 illustrates the components of the framework as applied to the practice of speech-language pathology. Each component can be expressed as a continuum of function. One end of the continuum indicates intact or neutral functioning; the other I - 28 / 2001 ASHA Desk Reference 2002 • Cardinal Documents of the Association indicates completely compromised function or disability (e.g., impairment, activity limitation [formerly referred to as disability (WHO, 1980)], or participation restriction [formerly referred to as handicap (WHO, 1980)]). For example, the component of Body Functions and Structures has a continuum that ranges from normal variation to complete impairment; Activity ranges from no activity limitation to complete activity limitation; and Participation ranges from no participation restriction to complete participation restriction. The second part of the ICIDH-2 [ICF] framework refers to Contextual Factors. Contextual Factors may interact with Body Functions and Structures, Activity, or Participation as facilitators or barriers to functioning. Contextual Factors include the following two components: • Environmental Factors: defined as the physical, social, and attitudinal environment in which people live. • Personal Factors: include such features of an individual as age, race, gender, educational background, and lifestyle. Although not formally classified in the ICIDH-2 [ICF], Personal Factors are acknowledged to be contributors to intervention outcomes. The scope of practice in speech-language pathology encompasses all components and factors identified in the WHO framework. That is, speech-language pathologists work to improve quality of life by reducing impairments of body functions and structures, activity limitations, participation restrictions, and environmental barriers of the individuals they serve. They serve individuals with known disease processes (e.g., aphasia, cleft palate) as well as those with activity limitations or participation restrictions (e.g., individuals needing classroom support services or special educational placement), including when such limitations or restrictions occur in the absence of known disease processes or impairments (e.g., individuals with differences in dialect). The role of speech-language pathologists includes prevention of communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive disorders as well as diagnosis, habilitation, rehabilitation, and enhancement of these functions. Education and Qualifications Speech-language pathologists must hold a graduate degree, the Certificate of Clinical Competence (CCC-SLP) of the American Speech-LanguageHearing Association (ASHA), and where applicable, other required credentials (e.g., state licensure, teaching certification). As primary care providers for communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive disorders, speech-language pathologists are autonomous professionals; that is, their services need not be prescribed or supervised by individuals in other professions. However, in many cases individuals are best served when speech-language pathologists work collaboratively with other professionals. Scope of Practice The practice of speech-language pathology includes prevention, diagnosis, habilitation, and rehabilitation of communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive disorders; elective modification of communication behaviors; and enhancement of communication. This includes services that address the dimensions of body structure and function, activity, and/or participation as proposed by the World Health Organization model (WHO, 2000). The practice of speech-language pathology involves: 1. Providing prevention, screening, consultation, assessment and diagnosis, treatment, intervention, management, counseling, and follow-up services for disorders of: • speech (i.e., articulation, fluency, resonance, and voice including aeromechanical components of respiration); • language (i.e., phonology, morphology, syntax, semantics, and pragmatic/social aspects of communication) including comprehension and expression in oral, written, graphic, and manual modalities; language processing; preliteracy and language-based literacy skills, including phonological awareness; • swallowing or other upper aerodigestive functions such as infant feeding and aeromechanical events (evaluation of esophageal function is for the purpose of referral to medical professionals); • cognitive aspects of communication (e.g., attention, memory, problem solving, executive functions). • sensory awareness related to communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive functions. 2. Establishing augmentative and alternative communication techniques and strategies including developing, selecting, and prescribing of such systems and devices (e.g., speech generating devices). 3. Providing services to individuals with hearing loss and their families/caregivers (e.g., Practice • Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology auditory training; speechreading; speech and language intervention secondary to hearing loss; visual inspection and listening checks of amplification devices for the purpose of troubleshooting, including verification of appropriate battery voltage). 4. Screening hearing of individuals who can participate in conventional pure-tone air conduction methods, as well as screening for middle ear pathology through screening tympanometry for the purpose of referral of individuals for further evaluation and management. 5. Using instrumentation (e.g., videofluoroscopy, EMG, nasendoscopy, stroboscopy, computer technology) to observe, collect data, and measure parameters of communication and swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive functions in accordance with the principles of evidence-based practice. 6. Selecting, fitting, and establishing effective use of prosthetic/adaptive devices for communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive functions (e.g., tracheoesophageal prostheses, speaking valves, electrolarynges). This does not include sensory devices used by individuals with hearing loss or other auditory perceptual deficits. 7. Collaborating in the assessment of central auditory processing disorders and providing intervention where there is evidence of speech, language, and/or other cognitivecommunication disorders. 8. Educating and counseling individuals, families, co-workers, educators, and other persons in the community regarding acceptance, adaptation, and decision making about communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive concerns. 9. Advocating for individuals through community awareness, education, and training programs to promote and facilitate access to full participation in communication, including the elimination of societal barriers. 10. Collaborating with and providing referrals and information to audiologists, educators, and health professionals as individual needs dictate. 11. Addressing behaviors (e.g., perseverative or disruptive actions) and environments (e.g., seating, positioning for swallowing safety or 2001 / I - 29 attention, communication opportunities) that affect communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive functions. 12. Providing services to modify or enhance communication performance (e.g., accent modification, transgendered voice, care and improvement of the professional voice, personal/professional communication effectiveness). 13. Recognizing the need to provide and appropriately accommodate diagnostic and treatment services to individuals from diverse cultural backgrounds and adjust treatment and assessment services accordingly. Professional Roles and Activities Speech-language pathologists serve individuals, families, groups, and the general public through a broad range of professional activities. They: • Identify, define, and diagnose disorders of human communication and swallowing and assist in localization and diagnosis of diseases and conditions. • Provide direct services using a variety of service delivery models to treat and/or address communication, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive concerns. • Conduct research related to communication sciences and disorders, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive functions. • Educate, supervise, and mentor future speech-language pathologists. • Serve as case managers and service delivery coordinators. • Administer and manage clinical and academic programs. • Educate and provide in-service training to families, caregivers, and other professionals. • Participate in outcomes measurement activities and use data to guide clinical decision making and determine the effectiveness of services provided in accordance with the principles of evidence-based practice. • Train, supervise, and manage speechlanguage pathology assistants and other support personnel. • Promote healthy lifestyle practices for the prevention of communication, hearing, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive disorders. I - 30 / 2001 • • • • • • ASHA Desk Reference 2002 • Cardinal Documents of the Association Foster public awareness of speech, language, hearing, and swallowing, and other upper aerodigestive disorders and their treatment. Advocate at the local, state, and national levels for access to and funding for services to address communication, hearing, swallowing, or other upper aerodigestive disorders. Serve as expert witnesses. Collaborate with audiologists in identifying neonates and infants at risk for hearing loss. Recognize the special needs of culturally diverse populations by providing services that are free of potential biases, including selection and/or adaptation of materials to ensure ethnic and linguistic sensitivity. Provide services using tele-electronic diagnostic measures and treatment methodologies (including remote applications). Practice Settings Speech-language pathologists provide services in a wide variety of settings, which may include but are not exclusive to: • Public and private schools • Health care settings (e.g., hospitals, medical rehabilitation facilities, long-term care facilities, home health agencies, community clinics, behavioral/mental health facilities) • Private practice settings • Universities and university clinics • Individuals’ homes • Group homes and sheltered workshops • Neonatal intensive care units, early intervention settings, preschools, and day care centers • Community and state agencies and institutions • Correctional institutions • Research facilities • Corporate and industrial settings Reference and Resource List General American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1986, May). The autonomy of speech-language pathology and audiology. Asha, 28, 53–57. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Sedation and topical anesthetics in audiology and speech-language pathology. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 7), 41–42. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1993). Definition of communication disorders and variations. Asha, 35 (Suppl. 10), 40–41. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1993). Guidelines for caseload size and speech-language pathology service delivery in the school. Asha, 35 (Suppl. 10), 33–39. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1994). Admission/discharge criteria in speech-language pathology. Unpublished report. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1994). Code of ethics. Asha, 36 (Suppl. 13), 1–2. under revision American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1996). Inclusive practices for children and youths with communication disorders. Asha, 38 (Suppl. 16), 35–44. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1996). Scope of practice in audiology. Asha, 38 (Suppl. 16), 12–15. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997). Position statement and technical report: Multiskilled personnel. Asha, 39 (Suppl. 17), 13. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997). Preferred practice patterns for the profession of speechlanguage pathology. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1999). Guidelines for the roles and responsibilities of the school-based speech-language pathologist. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2000). IDEA and your caseload: A template for eligibility and dismissal criteria for students ages 3 to 21. Rockville, MD: Author. Council on Professional Standards in Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology. (2000). Speech-language pathology certification standards. Rockville, MD: Author. World Health Organization. (2000). International classification of functioning, disability and health: Prefinal draft. Geneva, Switzerland: Author. Augmentative and Alternative Communication American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1989). Competencies for speech-language pathologists providing services in augmentative communication. Asha, 31 (3), 107–110. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). Augmentative and alternative communication. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 5), 8. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). Report: Augmentative and alternative communication. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 5), 9–12. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1998). Maximizing the provision of appropriate technology services and devices for students in schools. Asha, 40 (Suppl. 18), 33–42. National Joint Committee for the Communicative Needs of Persons with Severe Disabilities. (1992). Guidelines for meeting the communication needs of persons with severe disabilities. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 7), 1–8. Practice • Scope of Practice in Speech-Language Pathology Cognitive Aspects of Communication American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1982). Serving the communicatively handicapped mentally retarded individual. Asha, 24 (8), 547–553. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1987). The role of speech-language pathologists in the habilitation and rehabilitation of cognitively impaired individuals. Asha, 29 (6), 53–55. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1988). Mental retardation and developmental disabilities curriculum guide for speech-language pathologists and audiologists. ASHA Desk Reference, vol. 4, 185–189. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1988). The role of speech-language pathologists in the identification, diagnosis, and treatment of individuals with cognitive-communicative impairments. Asha, 30 (3), 79. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1990). Interdisciplinary approaches to brain damage. Asha, 32 (Suppl. 2), 3. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1990). The role of speech-language pathologists and audiologists in service delivery for persons with mental retardation and developmental disabilities in community settings. Asha, 32 (Suppl. 2), 5–6. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). Guidelines for speech-language pathologists serving persons with language, socio-communicative and/or cognitive-communicative impairments. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 5), 21–28. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1995). Guidelines for the structure and function of an interdisciplinary team for persons with brain injury. Asha, 37 (Suppl. 14), 23. Deaf and Hard of Hearing American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1984). Competencies for aural rehabilitation. Asha, 26 (5), 37–41. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1990). Aural rehabilitation: an annotated bibliography. Asha, 32 (Suppl. 1), 1–12. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1994, August). Service provision under the Individuals with Disabilities Education Act–Part H, as Amended (IDEA– Part H) to children who are deaf and hard of hearing ages birth to 36 months. Asha, 36, 117–121. Hearing Screening American National Standards Institute. (1996). Specifications for audiometers (ANSI S3.6.-1996). New York: Acoustical Society of America. American National Standards Institute. (1991). Maximum permissible ambient noise levels for audiometric test rooms (ANSI S3.1-1991). New York: Acoustical Society of America. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1994). Clinical practice by certificate holders in the profession in which they are not certified. Asha, 36 (13), 11–12. 2001 / I - 31 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1997). Guidelines for audiologic screening. Rockville, MD: Author. Joint Committee on Infant Hearing. (2000). Year 2000 position statement: Principles and guidelines for early hearing detection and intervention programs. American Journal of Audiology, 9, 9–29. Language and Literacy American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1982). Definition of language. Asha, 24 (6), 44. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1982). Position statement on language learning disorders. Asha, 24 (11), 937–944. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1989). Issues in determining eligibility for language intervention. Asha, 31 (3), 113–118. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). A model for collaborative service delivery for students with language-learning disorders in the public schools. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 5), 44–50. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). Guidelines for speech-language pathologists serving persons with language, socio-communicative and/or cognitive-communicative impairments. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 5), 21–28. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association Task Force on Central Auditory Processing Consensus Development. (1995). Central auditory processing: Current status of research and implications for clinical practice. Rockville, MD: ASHA. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2000). Guidelines on the roles and responsibilities of speechlanguage pathologists with respect to reading and writing in children and adolescents. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2000). Position statement on the roles and responsibilities of speechlanguage pathologists with respect to reading and writing in children and adolescents. Rockville, MD: Author. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2000). Technical report on the roles and responsibilities of speechlanguage pathologists with respect to reading and writing in children and adolescents. Rockville, MD: Author. National Joint Committee on Learning Disabilities. (1989). Communication-based services for infants, toddlers, and their families. ASHA Desk Reference, vol. 3, 159–163. Multicultural Issues American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1983). Social dialects (and implications). Asha, 25 (9), 23–27. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1985). Clinical management of communicatively handicapped minority language populations. Asha, 27 (6), 29–32. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1989). Bilingual speech-language pathologists and audiologists. Asha, 31, 93. I - 32 / 2001 ASHA Desk Reference 2002 • Cardinal Documents of the Association American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1998). Provision of English-as-a-second-language instruction by speech-language pathologists in school settings: Position statement and technical report. Asha, 40 (Suppl. 18), 24–27. Prevention American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1982). Prevention of speech, language, hearing problems. Asha, 24, 425, 431. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1988, March). Prevention of communication disorders. Asha, 30, 90. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). The prevention of communication disorders tutorial. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 6), 15–41. Research American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Ethics in research and professional practice. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 9), 11–12. Speech: Articulation, Fluency, Voice, Resonance American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Position statement and guidelines for evaluation and treatment for tracheoesophageal fistulization/puncture. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 7), 17–21. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Position statement and guidelines for vocal tract visualization and imaging. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 7), 31–40. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1993). Position statement and guidelines for oral and oropharyngeal prostheses. Asha, 35 (Suppl. 10), 14–16. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1993). Position statement and guidelines on the use of voice prostheses in tracheotomized persons with or without ventilatory dependence. Asha, 35 (Suppl. 10), 17–20. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1993). The role of the speech-language pathologist and teacher of voice in the remediation of singers with voice disorders. Asha, 35 (1), 63. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1995, March). Guidelines for practice in stuttering treatment. Asha, 37 (Suppl. 14), 26–35. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1998). Roles of otolaryngologists and speech-language pathologists in the performance and interpretation of strobovideolaryngoscopy. Asha, 40 (Suppl. 18), 32. ASHA Special Interest Division 3: Voice and Voice Disorders. (1997). Training guidelines for laryngeal videoendoscopy/stroboscopy. Unpublished report. Rockville: MD. Author. Supervision American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1985). Clinical supervision in speech-language pathology and audiology. Asha, 28 (6), 57–60. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1989). Preparation models for the supervisory process in speech-language pathology and audiology. Asha, 32 (3), 97–106. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Supervision of student clinicians. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 9), 8. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Clinical fellowship supervisor’s responsibilities. Asha, 34 (Suppl. 9), 16–17. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1996, Spring). Guidelines for the training, credentialing, use, and supervision of speech-language pathology assistants. Asha, 38 (Suppl. 16), 21–34. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (in preparation). Knowledge and skills for supervision of speech-language pathology assistants. Swallowing/Upper Aerodigestive Function American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1987). Ad hoc committee on dysphagia report. Asha, 29 (4), 57–58. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1989). Report: Ad hoc committee on labial-lingual posturing function. Asha, 31 (11), 92–94. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1990). Knowledge and skills needed by speech-language pathologists providing services to dysphagic patients/ clients. Asha, 32 (Suppl. 2), 7–12. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1991). The role of the speech-language pathologist in assessment and management of oral myofunctional disorders. Asha, 33 (Suppl. 5), 7. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1992). Position statement and guidelines for instrumental diagnostic procedures for swallowing, Asha, 34 (Suppl. 7), 25–33. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (1993). Orofacial myofunctional disorders: knowledge and skills. Asha, 35 (Suppl. 10), 21–23. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2000). Clinical indicators for instrumental assessment of dysphagia (guidelines): Executive summary. ASHA Suppl. 20, 18–9. American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. (2000). Roles of the speech-language pathologist and otolaryngologist in the performance and interpretation of endoscopic examination of swallowing (position statement). ASHA Suppl. 20, 17. ASHA Special Interest Division 13: Swallowing and Swallowing Disorders (Dysphagia). (1997). Graduate curriculum on swallowing and swallowing disorders (adult and pediatric dysphagia). ASHA Desk Reference, vol. 3, 248a–248n. Ethics • Code of Ethics Ethics 2001 / I - 185 Code of Ethics Last Revised January 1, 2003 Preamble The preservation of the highest standards of integrity and ethical principles is vital to the responsible discharge of obligations by speech-language pathologists, audiologists, and speech, language, and hearing scientists. This Code of Ethics sets forth the fundamental principles and rules considered essential to this purpose. Every individual who is (a) a member of the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association, whether certified or not, (b) a nonmember holding the Certificate of Clinical Competence from the Association, (c) an applicant for membership or certification, or (d) a Clinical Fellow seeking to fulfill standards for certification shall abide by this Code of Ethics. Any violation of the spirit and purpose of this Code shall be considered unethical. Failure to specify any particular responsibility or practice in this Code of Ethics shall not be construed as denial of the existence of such responsibilities or practices. The fundamentals of ethical conduct are described by Principles of Ethics and by Rules of Ethics as they relate to the conduct of research and scholarly activities and responsibility to persons served, the public, and speech-language pathologists, audiologists, and speech, language, and hearing scientists. Principles of Ethics, aspirational and inspirational in nature, form the underlying moral basis for the Code of Ethics. Individuals shall observe these principles as affirmative obligations under all conditions of professional activity. Reference this material as: American Speech-LanguageHearing Association. Code of ethics (revised). ASHA Supplement, 23, pp. 13–15. Index terms: ASHA reference products, ethics (professional practice issues), ethics and related papers Document type: Ethics and related documents Rules of Ethics are specific statements of minimally acceptable professional conduct or of prohibitions and are applicable to all individuals. Principle of Ethics I Individuals shall honor their responsibility to hold paramount the welfare of persons they serve professionally or participants in research and scholarly activities and shall treat animals involved in research in a humane manner. Rules of Ethics A. Individuals shall provide all services competently. B. Individuals shall use every resource, including referral when appropriate, to ensure that highquality service is provided. C. Individuals shall not discriminate in the delivery of professional services or the conduct of research and scholarly activities on the basis of race or ethnicity, gender, age, religion, national origin, sexual orientation, or disability. D. Individuals shall not misrepresent the credentials of assistants, technicians, or support personnel and shall inform those they serve professionally of the name and professional credentials of persons providing services. E. Individuals who hold the Certificates of Clinical Competence shall not delegate tasks that require the unique skills, knowledge, and judgment that are within the scope of their profession to assistants, technicians, support personnel, students, or any nonprofessionals over whom they have supervisory responsibility. An individual may delegate support services to assistants, technicians, support personnel, students, or any other persons only if those services are adequately supervised by an individual who holds the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence. I -186 / 2001 F. G. H. I. J. K. L. M. N. O. ASHA Desk Reference 2002 Volume 1 • Cardinal Documents of the Association Individuals shall fully inform the persons they serve of the nature and possible effects of services rendered and products dispensed, and they shall inform participants in research about the possible effects of their participation in research conducted. Individuals shall evaluate the effectiveness of services rendered and of products dispensed and shall provide services or dispense products only when benefit can reasonably be expected. Individuals shall not guarantee the results of any treatment or procedure, directly or by implication; however, they may make a reasonable statement of prognosis. Individuals shall not provide clinical services solely by correspondence. Individuals may practice by telecommunication (for example, telehealth/e-health), where not prohibited by law. Individuals shall adequately maintain and appropriately secure records of professional services rendered, research and scholarly activities conducted, and products dispensed and shall allow access to these records only when authorized or when required by law. Individuals shall not reveal, without authorization, any professional or personal information about identified persons served professionally or identified participants involved in research and scholarly activities unless required by law to do so, or unless doing so is necessary to protect the welfare of the person or of the community or otherwise required by law. Individuals shall not charge for services not rendered, nor shall they misrepresent services rendered, products dispensed, or research and scholarly activities conducted. Individuals shall use persons in research or as subjects of teaching demonstrations only with their informed consent. Individuals whose professional services are adversely affected by substance abuse or other health-related conditions shall seek professional assistance and, where appropriate, withdraw from the affected areas of practice. Principle of Ethics II Individuals shall honor their responsibility to achieve and maintain the highest level of professional competence. Rules of Ethics A. Individuals shall engage in the provision of clinical services only when they hold the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence or when they are in the certification process and are supervised by an individual who holds the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence. B. Individuals shall engage in only those aspects of the professions that are within the scope of their competence, considering their level of education, training, and experience. C. Individuals shall continue their professional development throughout their careers. D. Individuals shall delegate the provision of clinical services only to: (1) persons who hold the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence; (2) persons in the education or certification process who are appropriately supervised by an individual who holds the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence; or (3) assistants, technicians, or support personnel who are adequately supervised by an individual who holds the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence. E. Individuals shall not require or permit their professional staff to provide services or conduct research activities that exceed the staff member’s competence, level of education, training, and experience. F. Individuals shall ensure that all equipment used in the provision of services or to conduct research and scholarly activities is in proper working order and is properly calibrated. Principle of Ethics III Individuals shall honor their responsibility to the public by promoting public understanding of the professions, by supporting the development of services designed to fulfill the unmet needs of the public, and by providing accurate information in all communications involving any aspect of the professions, including dissemination of research findings and scholarly activities. Rules of Ethics A. Individuals shall not misrepresent their credentials, competence, education, training, experience, or scholarly or research contributions. B. Individuals shall not participate in professional activities that constitute a conflict of interest. C. Individuals shall refer those served professionally solely on the basis of the interest of those Ethics • Code of Ethics being referred and not on any personal financial interest. D. Individuals shall not misrepresent diagnostic information, research, services rendered, or products dispensed; neither shall they engage in any scheme to defraud in connection with obtaining payment or reimbursement for such services or products. E. Individuals’ statements to the public shall provide accurate information about the nature and management of communication disorders, about the professions, about professional services, and about research and scholarly activities. F. Individuals’ statements to the public—advertising, announcing, and marketing their professional services, reporting research results, and promoting products—shall adhere to prevailing professional standards and shall not contain misrepresentations. Principle of Ethics IV Individuals shall honor their responsibilities to the professions and their relationships with colleagues, students, and members of allied professions. Individuals shall uphold the dignity and autonomy of the professions, maintain harmonious interprofessional and intraprofessional relationships, and accept the professions’ self-imposed standards. Rules of Ethics A. Individuals shall prohibit anyone under their supervision from engaging in any practice that violates the Code of Ethics. B. Individuals shall not engage in dishonesty, fraud, deceit, misrepresentation, sexual harrassment, or any other form of conduct that adversely reflects on the professions or on the individual’s fitness to serve persons professionally. 2001 / I - 187 C. Individuals shall not engage in sexual activities with clients or students over whom they exercise professional authority. D. Individuals shall assign credit only to those who have contributed to a publication, presentation, or product. Credit shall be assigned in proportion to the contribution and only with the contributor’s consent. E. Individuals shall reference the source when using other persons’ ideas, research, presentations, or products in written, oral, or any other media presentation or summary. F. Individuals’ statements to colleagues about professional services, research results, and products shall adhere to prevailing professional standards and shall contain no misrepresentations. G. Individuals shall not provide professional services without exercising independent professional judgment, regardless of referral source or prescription. H. Individuals shall not discriminate in their relationships with colleagues, students, and members of allied professions on the basis of race or ethnicity, gender, age, religion, national origin, sexual orientation, or disability. I. Individuals who have reason to believe that the Code of Ethics has been violated shall inform the Board of Ethics. J. Individuals shall comply fully with the policies of the Board of Ethics in its consideration and adjudication of complaints of violations of the Code of Ethics. Issues in Ethics • Confidentiality Issues in Ethics 2004/ 43 Confidentiality Board of Ethics Issues in Ethics Statements: Definition From time to time, the Board of Ethics determines that members and certificate holders can benefit from additional analysis and instruction concerning a specific issue of ethical conduct. Issues in Ethics statements are intended to heighten sensitivity and increase awareness. They are illustrative of the Code of Ethics and intended to promote thoughtful consideration of ethical issues. They may assist members and certificate holders in engaging in self-guided ethical decision-making. These statements do not absolutely prohibit or require specified activity. The facts and circumstances surrounding a matter of concern will determine whether the activity is ethical. This Issues in Ethics statement was revised to update references to the Code of Ethics as revised in 2003. Introduction This Issues in Ethics statement is presented for the guidance of ASHA members and certificate holders in matters relating to confidentiality. ASHA members and certificate holders are employed in a variety of work settings and are faced daily with issues of confidentiality of client/student/ patient information. Some examples include records management, information exchanged in the course of the client-clinician relationship, disclosure, release of information, access to records, exchange of records between professionals. The following information is provided in an attempt to heighten sensitivity, increase awareness, and enhance judg- Reference this material as: American Speech-LanguageHearing Association. (2004). Confidentiality. ASHA Supplement 24, 43–45. Index terms: Ethics (professional practice issues), practice scope and patterns, professional practice activities and issues Document type: Ethics and related documents ments in situations dealing with confidentiality of information. ASHA members and certificate holders are also faced with issues of confidentiality in their relationships with colleagues and information they obtain as they serve in roles such as site visitors, consultants, supervisors, or reviewers. Background Confidentiality of client/student/patient information is specifically addressed by the ASHA Code of Ethics through Principle of Ethics I, Rules K and L. K. Individuals shall adequately maintain and appropriately secure records of professional services rendered, research and scholarly activities conducted, and products dispensed and shall allow access to these records only when authorized or when required by law. L. Individuals shall not reveal, without authorization, any professional or personal information about identified persons served professionally or identified participants involved in research and scholarly activities unless required by law to do so, or unless doing so is necessary to protect the welfare of the person or of the community or otherwise required by law. The ASHA Code of Ethics, through Principle of Ethics IV, Rules B, F, I, and J, addresses confidentiality in relationships with colleagues. B. Individuals shall not engage in dishonesty, fraud, deceit, misrepresentation, sexual harassment, or any other form of conduct that adversely reflects on the professions or on the individual’s fitness to serve persons professionally. F. Individuals’ statements to colleagues about professional services, research results, and products shall adhere to prevailing professional standards and shall contain no misrepresentations. 44 / 2004 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association I. Individuals who have reason to believe that the Code of Ethics has been violated shall inform the Board of Ethics. the course of employment in a particular setting is not “owned” by the speech-language pathologist or audiologist. J. Individuals shall comply fully with policies of the Board of Ethics in its consideration and adjudication of complaints of violation of the Code of Ethics. 2. Persons other than the client/student may request information about the client’s communication problem. Requests might come from an off-site clinic supervisor, Clinical Fellowship supervisor, a professional who supervises student teachers, reporters, insurance companies, and government agencies. Again, information cannot be disclosed without signed releases. Confidentiality of Client/Student/Patient Information Discussion Confidentiality of privileged information stems from codes of ethics, federal law, and state law. If one works in an educational setting (such as a college or school) there are relevant laws that specify the management of school records including access to information and release of information. If one works in a health care setting (such as a hospital, nursing facility, or rehabilitation setting) there are relevant laws for the management of medical records. If one works in a private practice setting confidentiality of client/student/patient information must be protected. Speech-language pathologists and audiologists, regardless of setting, are responsible for obtaining and adhering to laws and guidance policies for records management in that setting. Records management guidance will typically cover • record storage; • ownership of records; • access of clients and their legal guardians to records; • record retention and statutes of limitation; • transfer of information; • requests for information by someone other than the client/student or the client’s/ student’s legal guardian; and • use of client/student records for research. Guidance 1. Speech-language pathologists and audiologists must be aware of who owns the records. In a medical setting, the hospital owns the record. In a private practice the individual who is legally responsible for the practice owns the records. In a school setting, the school district owns the record. For example, a school district maintains one “official” record on each student. Speech-language pathology or audiology reports are the property of the school district and may not be released to anyone without appropriate, signed releases of information. A report prepared by a speech-language pathologist or audiologist in 3. It is important to be aware of what information is required and what information is appropriate to be included in the client’s legal record and to exercise professional judgment in making notations in the client’s/student’s record. 4. Data and the personal identities of individual participants in clinical activities and research must be kept confidential. Some reasonable precautions to protect and respect the confidentiality of participants include • dissemination of clinical service and research findings without disclosure of personal identifying information, if possible; • secure storage and limited access to clinical and research records by authorized personnel only; • removal, disguise, or coding of personal identifying information; and • written, informed consent from participants, parent, or guardian to disseminate findings observable from photographic/video images or audio voice recordings in which personal identifying information may be disclosed to others. Summary It is incumbent on the speech-language pathologist or audiologist to be knowledgeable about federal and state laws, professional codes of ethics to which they must adhere (in addition to the ASHA Code of Ethics), and work-site specific procedures regarding the handling of patient information. Confidentiality in Relationships With Colleagues Discussion Speech-language pathologists and audiologists function in a variety of roles and activities that allow access to information of a personal and confidential Issues in Ethics • Confidentiality 2004/ 45 nature. For example, speech-language pathologists may be reviewers of manuscripts/publications authored by others or of grant, fellowship, or scholarship applications; site visitors; consultants; supervisors; administrators; or participants in groups dealing with confidential and personal information. 2. With regard to reporting/responding to alleged violations of codes of conduct, respect for the confidentiality of the matter is the responsibility of all individuals involved. It would be prudent to consider all aspects of a matter confidential until a final decision is rendered. Individuals reporting or responding to alleged violations of codes of ethics or professional codes of conduct are also dealing with a confidential matter and acting in a confidential relationship with the adjudicating body. 3. With respect to disclosure of decisions by adjudicating bodies, individuals need to inform themselves of pertinent laws and organizational policies regarding disclosure of information. Adjudicating bodies typically follow rules of confidentiality (some dictated by law and regulation, some dictated by the organization’s internal governance policies and procedures) regarding disclosure of decisions. Summary It is incumbent on speech-language pathologists or audiologists to honor their responsibilities to the profession and their relationships with colleagues in matters of confidentiality of proprietary and personal information. Guidance 1. In the multiple roles and activities in which speech-language pathologists and audiologists are engaged, confidentiality of proprietary and personal information obtained in conjunction with the activity/ role is paramount. 2001; revised 2003 Ethics Ethics: Fees for Clinical Service Provided by Students and Clinical Fellows 2004 / 1 Fees for Clinical Service Provided by Students and Clinical Fellows Board of Ethics Issues in Ethics Statements: Definition From time to time, the Board of Ethics determines that members and certificate holders can benefit from additional analysis and instruction concerning a specific issue of ethical conduct. Issues in Ethics statements are intended to heighten sensitivity and increase awareness. They are illustrative of the Code of Ethics and intended to promote thoughtful consideration of ethical issues. They may assist members and certificate holders in engaging in self-guided ethical decision-making. These statements do not absolutely prohibit or require specified activity. The facts and circumstances surrounding a matter of concern will determine whether the activity is ethical. This statement replaces an earlier version (1978) titled, “Fees for Clinical Service Provided by Students.” Introduction The Board of Ethics has been asked to address ethical questions that may arise when fees are charged for clinical services provided by students and clinical fellows. These ethical issues involve the following: (1) the legitimacy of charging for work done by individuals who are not yet fully trained or certified; (2) the nature of supervision provided these individuals; and (3) the public’s right to be informed regarding the qualifications of those providing the services. The Board of Ethics refers readers to Principles of Ethics II and III and Principle of Ethics II, Rule A, and Principle of Ethics III, Rule A, for discussion of these issues: Reference this material as: American Speech-LanguageHearing Association. (2004). Fees for clinical service provided by students. ASHA Supplement 24, in press. Index terms: Clinical service providers, students, supervision Document type: Ethics and related documents Principle of Ethics II: Individuals shall honor their responsibility to achieve and maintain the highest level of professional competence. Principle of Ethics II, Rule A: Individuals shall engage in the provision of clinical services only when they hold the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence or when they are in the certification process and are supervised by an individual who holds the appropriate Certificate of Clinical Competence. Principle fo Ethics III: Individuals shall honor their responsibility to the public by promoting public understanding of the professions, by supporting the development of services designed to fulfill the unmet needs of the public, and by providing accurate information in all communications involving any aspect of the professions, including dissemination of research findings and scholarly activities. Principle of Ethics III, Rule A: Individuals shall not misrepresent their credentials, competence, education, training, experience, or scholarly or research contributions. Discussion and Guidance Principle of Ethics II, Rule A of the Code of Ethics recognizes the professional acceptability of appropriately supervised clinical practice by students and clinical fellows in training. Hence, the Board of Ethics has concluded that it has no basis for suggesting or requiring that such fees be fixed at any specific level or differ in any manner or proportion from the fees normally charged for services provided by certified audiologists or speech-language pathologists. Although students and clinical fellows may be involved in the provision of clinical services, client welfare is the responsibility of the certified supervisor. Clinical fellows are covered under the Code of Ethics and must adhere to its principles and rules. Of importance here is the nature, type, and quality of the supervision, rather than the fee schedule. The services provided must meet or exceed professional 2004 / 2 American Speech-Language-Hearing Association standards of supervision, as well as any legal and regulatory standards that may apply. The nature and intensity of supervision should be based on the stage of clinical development of each student or clinical fellow. If appropriate supervision is provided, the fees charged are justified; if not, there is something fundamentally wrong with the service offered, and the fee level is immaterial in view of Principle of Ethics I of the Code, which obligates members and/or certificate holders to “honor their responsibility to hold paramount the welfare of persons they serve professionally.” Third-party payors may be very specific as regards payment for services provided by students and clinical fellows. Therefore, it is imperative that supervisors be knowledgeable regarding these specific requirements. A final issue concerns the client’s right to be fully informed of the professional qualifications of the service provider. Principle of Ethics III, Rule A of the Code instructs that members and/or certificate holders “shall not misrepresent their credentials, competence, education, training, or experience.” Students, clinical fellows, and supervisors must identify themselves as such to those they service, for example, by use of an appropriate name tag. 1978; revised 2003 OHIO BOARD OF SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY AND AUDIOLOGY LICENSURE In addition to ASHA certification, most states require a license to practice speech-language pathology. Ohio is one of these states. At the end of your master’s program, you will apply for a conditional license in Ohio or the state in which you will practice. Below are the requirements you will meet throughout your master’s program that will allow you to apply for licensure in Ohio. If you intend on practicing in another state, you must check with their governing board for the appropriate requirements. EDUCATIONAL REQUIREMENTS FOR LICENSURE (A) To be eligible for licensure, an applicant must demonstrate that the following course work requirements are met: (1) He/she obtained a broad general education, which may include study from among the areas of human psychology, sociology, psychological and physical development, the physical sciences, especially those that pertain to acoustic and biological phenomena, and human anatomy and physiology, including neuroanatomy and neurophysiology. (2) He/she obtained at least a master's degree in the area in which licensure is sought or the equivalent as determined by the board from a college or university accredited by one of the following regional or national accrediting organizations or their successor organizations: (a) "Middle States Association of Colleges and Schools- Commission on Higher Education" (b) "New England Association of Schools and Colleges" (c) "North Central Association of Colleges and Schools" (d) "Northwest Association of Schools and Colleges" (e) "Southern Association of Colleges and Schools" (f) "Western Association of Schools and Colleges - Accrediting Commission for Senior Colleges" The best source for determining whether the college or university is accredited by one of the above organizations or successors is the college or university itself. (3) The academic credit upon which the master's degree or higher was awarded must include course work accumulated in the completion of a well-integrated course of study, as follows: (a) A total of seventy-five semester hours or one hundred twelve and one-half quarter hours were accumulated. (b) The course work consisted of at least the minimum number of hours in all areas listed below: (i) Twenty-seven semester hours in basic science course work. Of the twenty-seven semester hours, six semester hours must be in biological/physical sciences and mathematics and six semester hours must be in behavioral or social sciences; (ii) Fifteen semester hours in basic human communication processes, including all of the following: the anatomic and physiologic bases, the physical and psychophysical bases, and the linguistic and psycholinguistic aspects; (iii) Thirty-six semester hours in professional course work. Of the thirty-six semester hours, thirty of the semester hours must be in courses for which graduate credit was received and comply with the requirements below that are applicable to the area in which licensure is sought: (a) For speech-language pathology: thirty semester hours shall be in speech-language pathology, with at least six semester hours in language disorders; six semester hours shall be in audiology, with three semester hours in hearing disorders and hearing evaluation and three semester hours in habilitative/rehabilitative procedures. (b) For audiology: thirty semester hours shall be in audiology, with at least six semester hours in hearing disorders and hearing evaluation and at least six semester hours in habilitative/rehabilitative procedures; six semester hours shall be in speech-language pathology, not associated with hearing impairment, with three semester hours in speech disorders and three semester hours in language disorders. (c) For both speech-language pathology and audiology, course of study shall include content on ethical practice standards. (B) Verification of education shall be the official transcript submitted to the board by the university or college. (1) No credit may be allowed for courses listed on the application unless satisfactory completion of the course is verified by an official transcript. (2) Satisfactory completion is defined as the applicant's having received academic credit in semester hours, quarter hours, or other unit or credit with a passing grade as defined by the college or university. (3) Where the course work is reported in quarter hours, the following formula will be used: one semester hour equals one and one half quarter hours. (4) The applicant is solely responsible for authorizing the college or university to send an official transcript to the board. (5) The board may require additional verification of course work content. (C) Course work listed on a college or university transcript shall be evaluated under the following standards: (1) A specific course may be split and credited to no more than two categories. If a course is split, a description of the course taken from the university catalog must be submitted. At least one semester hour of the course must address the area in which partial credit is requested. (2) Up to six semester hours for a thesis or dissertation may be accepted in the basic human communications processes or the professional course work categories. (a) An abstract of the thesis/dissertation content must be submitted with the application. (b) Academic credit that is associated with thesis or dissertation and for which graduate credit was received may apply in the professional area, but may not be counted as meeting any of the minimum requirements. (c) "Minimum requirements" means six semester credit hours in speech disorders, six semester credit hours in language disorders, three semester credit hours in hearing disorders and hearing evaluations, three semester credit hours in habilitative/rehabilitative procedures, and twenty-one graduate semester credit hours in the area of licensure. (d) Credit earned for research methodology courses, such as research methods, introduction to graduate study, etc., may be counted toward the thirty semester credit hours of course work at the graduate level but may not be used toward any of the minimum requirements. (D) Course work requirements for licensure shall be deemed to be met when the applicant was awarded a master's degree or higher in the area in which licensure is sought from a college or university program accredited by a regional or national specialized accrediting organization in speech-language pathology and/or audiology recognized by the "United States Department of Education" and the "Council for Higher Education Accreditation," One Dupont Circle Northwest, Suite 50, Washington, D.C. 20036-1135, or its predecessors or successors, at the time the master's degree was awarded. (E) Course work requirements for licensure shall be deemed to be met when the applicant holds a current certificate in audiology in good standing received from the "American Board of Audiology" when both of the following criteria are met: (1) Verification of certification is received from the "American Board of Audiology." (2) The student clinical and professional experience completed for certification, if performed in Ohio, were done in conformance with Ohio law and rules. (F) Pursuant to section 4753.08(C) of the Revised Code, educational requirements for licensure shall be waived for an applicant who presents proof of a current certificate of clinical competence in the area in which licensure is sought that is in good standing and received from the "American Speech-Language-Hearing Association" when both of the following criteria are met: (1) Verification of certification is received from the "American Speech-Language-Hearing Association." (2) The student clinical and professional experience completed for certification, if performed in Ohio, were done in conformance with Ohio law and rules. (G) In order to expedite the licensure of graduates prior to the preparation of final transcripts, the board shall consider on an individual basis any application for which the university provides a letter from the registrar, graduate officer or speech-language pathology and/or audiology department chairperson containing all of the following: (1) A statement that the final transcript is not available; (2) A statement that the applicant has met all requirements for a master's degree or higher; (3) A statement of the area in which the master's degree or higher was earned; (4) The university or college seal or notarized signature of the university or college official providing such letter. The applicant is solely responsible for authorizing the college or university to send an official transcript to the board within ninety days of licensure or when it is available. STUDENT CLINICAL EXPERIENCE REQUIREMENTS (A) Definitions (1) For purposes of division (C) of section 4753.06 of the Revised Code, supervised clinical experience of a student or intern means those clock hours of clinical experience obtained in direct contact with persons served through a college or university accredited by a regional or national accrediting organization recognized by the board, in a cooperating program of said college or university, or in anther program approved by the board. (2) "Clock hour" means a time increment of sixty minutes. (3) "Evaluation" means screening, assessment and diagnosis of hearing disorders and language and speech disorders (articulation, fluency, voice and dysphagia) occurring before initiation of a treatment program. (a) Clock hours devoted to counseling associated with the evaluation/diagnostic process may be counted. (b) Clock hours spent in formal reevaluation may be applied to this category. (c) Periodic assessments during treatment may not be considered as evaluation but may be applied to the treatment category. (d) The majority of the evaluation hours in each category must be in areas other than screening activities. (4) "Treatment for language and speech disorders" (articulation, fluency, voice, and dysphagia) means clinical management, including direct and indirect services, progress in monitoring activities, and counseling. Clock hours devoted to counseling associated with the treatment process may be counted in this category. (5) "Treatment for hearing disorders" means clinical management and counseling, including auditory training, speech-reading, and speech and language services for those with hearing impairment. (6) "Direct supervision" means that the supervisor provides guidance and direction to the student based upon on site observation of the student while in the same room or through an observation window or observation by video simulcast or closed-circuit television. (7) "Indirect supervision" means that the supervisor providing guidance and direction to the student is on site during the majority of the student clinical experience. (B) To meet requirements for licensure, the student clinical experience must meet all of the following criteria: (1) The documentation establishes that the applicant obtained three hundred seventy-five hours of supervised clinical practicum, of which twenty-five clock hours shall be clinical observation prior to beginning initial clinical practicum and three hundred fifty clock hours shall be clinical practicum. Two hundred fifty of the three hundred seventy-five clock hours shall be at the graduate level in the area in which licensure is sought. (2) The documentation establishes that the following minimum requirements are met in the applicable area: (a) In the area of speech-language pathology: (i) Twenty clock hours shall be in each of the following eight categories: evaluation of speech disorders in children; evaluation of speech disorders in adults; evaluation of language disorders in children; evaluation of language disorders in adults; treatment of speech disorders in children; treatment of speech disorders in adults; treatment of language disorders in children; and treatment of language disorders in adults; (ii) Twenty clock hours shall be in audiology and may include evaluation/screening and/or habilitation/rehabilitation; (iii) Fifty clock hours shall be in each of three types of clinical settings. (b) In the area of audiology: (i) At least fifty clock hours shall be in each of three types of clinical settings. The student must have experience in the evaluation and treatment of children and adults and with a variety of types and severity of disorders of hearing, speech, and language, and with the selection and use of amplification and assistive devices; (ii) At least eighty clock hours shall be in each of the following categories, with a minimum of ten hours in each category: selection and use of amplification and assistive devices for children, and selection and use of amplification and assistive devices for adults; (iii) At least twenty clock hours shall be in the treatment of hearing disorders in children and adults; (iv) Twenty clock hours shall be in speech-language pathology unrelated to hearing impairment and may include evaluation/screening and/or treatment. (3) The documentation establishes that the supervision of the experience was in compliance with all of the supervision criteria set forth in paragraph (C) of this rule. (C) Student clinical experience supervision (1) The documentation establishes that the student clinical experience supervision was a combination of direct and indirect supervision, as follows: (a) At least ninety-five clock hours shall be directly supervised. (b) Two hundred eighty clock hours shall be at least indirectly supervised. (2) Supervisor observation of student clinical experience clock hours took place on site or by closed-circuit television. It is recommended that evaluation of student performance include activities such as conferences, audio and video recordings, written evaluations, rating instruments, and inspection of lesson plans and written reports. (a) The supervisor must directly observe at least twenty-five percent of the student's contact time with each person served. (b) The supervisor must directly observe at least fifty percent of the student's time in each diagnostic evaluation, including screening and identification. (D) Verification of student clinical experience shall be submitted directly from the college or university on forms prescribed by the board. (1) The verification must bear the notarized signature of the department head or applicant's clinical supervisor. The board may at its discretion require additional verification of student clinical experience. (2) It is the applicant's responsibility to ensure that the college or university is authorized to send student clinical experience records. (E) The student clinical experience requirements set forth in paragraphs (B) and (C) of this rule shall be deemed to be met when the applicant presents proof that he/she was awarded a master's degree or higher in the area in which licensure is sought from a college or university program in speech-language pathology and/or audiology accredited by a regional or national specialized accrediting organization in speech-language pathology or audiology recognized by the "United States Department of Education" and "Council for Higher Education Accreditation," One Dupont Circle Northwest, Suite 50, Washington, D.C. 20036-1135, or its predecessors or successors, at the time the master's degree was awarded. (F) The student clinical experience requirements set forth in paragraphs (B) and (C) of this rule shall be deemed to be met when the applicant holds current certification in audiology that is in good standing and received from the "American Board of Audiology" and both of the following criteria are met: (1) Verification of certification is received from the "American Board of Audiology." (2) The student clinical experience and professional experience upon which certification was granted, if completed in Ohio, were done in conformance with Ohio law and rules. (G) The student clinical experience requirements sets forth in paragraphs (B) and (C) of this rule shall be deemed to be met when the applicant holds a current certificate of clinical competence in the area in which licensure is sought that is in good standing and received from the "American Speech-Language-Hearing Association" and both of the following criteria are met: (1) Verification of certification is received from the "American Speech-Language-Hearing Association." (2) The student clinical experience and professional experience upon which certification was granted, if completed in Ohio, were done in conformance with Ohio law and rules. (H) Academic credit for student clinical experience may not be used to satisfy specific course work minimum requirements. A maximum of six semester clock hours for student clinical experience may be applied to the thirty-six semester clock hours of professional course work. (I) Students shall not receive reimbursement or compensation for services provided during the student clinical experience, unless the board finds that extraordinary circumstances render reimbursement or compensation appropriate. (J) Student clinical experience must have been under the supervision of a person who meets one of the following criteria: (1) Student clinical experience obtained in the state of Ohio shall have been under the supervision of a person who during the entire student clinical experience was licensed under Chapter 4753. of the Revised Code in the area in which the applicant seeks licensure. (2) Student clinical experience obtained outside of Ohio shall have been under the supervision of a person who during the entire student clinical experience was licensed in the area in which the applicant seeks licensure in the state in which the student clinical experience was performed. (3) Student clinical experience obtained in a state that does not have licensure shall have been under the supervision of a person who during the entire student clinical experience was certified by the "American Speech-Language-Hearing Association" or the "American Board of Audiology," in the area in which the applicant seeks licensure. EXAMINATION REQUIREMENTS An applicant shall have satisfied the examination requirements of the board if he/she has achieved a score of six hundred or above on the "National Examination in Speech Pathology" or the "National Examination in Audiology" or “The Praxis Series II Test in Speech-Language Pathology” or “The Praxis Series II Test in Audiology” administered by the "educational testing service" of Princeton, New Jersey, in the area in which licensure is sought or any other such practical and oral or written examinations as the board shall determine as necessary. Verification of the test score shall be submitted to the board by the "Educational Testing Service." Scores which cannot be reported by the "Educational Testing Service" may be submitted by another source with the approval of the board. It is the applicant's responsibility to ensure that the “Educational Testing Service” is authorized to report the test score. APPENDIX I: WORLD HEALTH ORGANIZATION (WHO) ICF Introduction ICF Introduction 1 2 ICF Introduction 1. Background This volume contains the International Classification of Functioning, Disability 1 and Health, known as ICF. The overall aim of the ICF classification is to provide a unified and standard language and framework for the description of health and health-related states. It defines components of health and some health-related components of well-being (such as education and labour). The domains contained in ICF can, therefore, be seen as health domains and health-related domains. These domains are described from the perspective of the body, the individual and society in two basic lists: (1) Body Functions and Structures; and 2 (2) Activities and Participation. As a classification, ICF systematically groups 3 different domains for a person in a given health condition (e.g. what a person with a disease or disorder does do or can do). Functioning is an umbrella term encompassing all body functions, activities and participation; similarly, disability serves as an umbrella term for impairments, activity limitations or participation restrictions. ICF also lists environmental factors that interact with all these constructs. In this way, it enables the user to record useful profiles of individuals’ functioning, disability and health in various domains. ICF belongs to the “family” of international classifications developed by the World Health Organization (WHO) for application to various aspects of health. The WHO family of international classifications provides a framework to code a wide range of information about health (e.g. diagnosis, functioning and disability, reasons for contact with health services) and uses a standardized common language permitting communication about health and health care across the world in various disciplines and sciences. In WHO’s international classifications, health conditions (diseases, disorders, injuries, etc.) are classified primarily in ICD-10 (shorthand for the International 1 The text represents a revision of the International Classification of Impairments, Disabilities, and Handicaps (ICIDH), which was first published by the World Health Organization for trial purposes in 1980. Developed after systematic field trials and international consultation over the past five years, it was endorsed by the Fifty-fourth World Health Assembly for international use on 22 May 2001 (resolution WHA54.21). 2 These terms, which replace the formerly used terms “impairment”, “disability” and “handicap” , extend the scope of the classification to allow positive experiences to be described. The new terms are further defined in this Introduction and are detailed within the classification. It should be noted that these terms are used with specific meanings that may differ from their everyday usage. 3 A domain is a practical and meaningful set of related physiological functions, anatomical structures, actions, tasks, or areas of life. 3 Introduction ICF 4 Classification of Diseases, Tenth Revision), which provides an etiological framework. Functioning and disability associated with health conditions are 5 classified in ICF. ICD-10 and ICF are therefore complementary, and users are encouraged to utilize these two members of the WHO family of international classifications together. ICD-10 provides a “diagnosis” of diseases, disorders or other health conditions, and this information is enriched by the additional 6 information given by ICF on functioning. Together, information on diagnosis plus functioning provides a broader and more meaningful picture of the health of people or populations, which can then be used for decision-making purposes. The WHO family of international classifications provides a valuable tool to describe and compare the health of populations in an international context. The information on mortality (provided by ICD-10) and on health outcomes (provided by ICF) may be combined in summary measures of population health for monitoring the health of populations and its distribution, and also for assessing the contributions of different causes of mortality and morbidity. ICF has moved away from being a “consequences of disease” classification (1980 version) to become a “components of health” classification. “Components of health” identifies the constituents of health, whereas “consequences” focuses on the impacts of diseases or other health conditions that may follow as a result. Thus, ICF takes a neutral stand with regard to etiology so that researchers can draw causal inferences using appropriate scientific methods. Similarly, this approach is also different from a “determinants of health” or "risk factors" approach. To facilitate the study of determinants or risk factors, ICF includes a list of environmental factors that describe the context in which individuals live. 4 International Statistical Classification of Diseases and Related Health Problems, Tenth Revision, Vols. 1-3. Geneva, World Health Organization, 1992-1994. 5 It is also important to recognize the overlap between ICD-10 and ICF. Both classifications begin with the body systems. Impairments refer to body structures and functions, which are usually parts of the “disease process” and are therefore also used in the ICD-10. Nevertheless, ICD-10 uses impairments (as signs and symptoms) as parts of a constellation that forms a “disease”, or sometimes as reasons for contact with health services, whereas the ICF system uses impairments as problems of body functions and structures associated with health conditions. 6 Two persons with the same disease can have different levels of functioning, and two persons with the same level of functioning do not necessarily have the same health condition. Hence, joint use enhances data quality for medical purposes. Use of ICF should not bypass regular diagnostic procedures. In other uses, ICF may be used alone. 4 ICF Introduction 2. Aims of ICF ICF is a multipurpose classification designed to serve various disciplines and different sectors. Its specific aims can be summarized as follows: • to provide a scientific basis for understanding and studying health and health-related states, outcomes and determinants; • to establish a common language for describing health and health-related states in order to improve communication between different users, such as health care workers, researchers, policy-makers and the public, including people with disabilities; • to permit comparison of data across countries, health care disciplines, services and time; • to provide a systematic coding scheme for health information systems. These aims are interrelated, since the need for and uses of ICF require the construction of a meaningful and practical system that can be used by various consumers for health policy, quality assurance and outcome evaluation in different cultures. 2.1 Applications of ICF Since its publication as a trial version in 1980, ICIDH has been used for various purposes, for example: • as a statistical tool – in the collection and recording of data (e.g. in population studies and surveys or in management information systems); • as a research tool – to measure outcomes, quality of life or environmental factors; • as a clinical tool – in needs assessment, matching treatments with specific conditions, vocational assessment, rehabilitation and outcome evaluation; • as a social policy tool – in social security planning, compensation systems and policy design and implementation; • as an educational tool – in curriculum design and to raise awareness and undertake social action. Since ICF is inherently a health and health-related classification it is also used by sectors such as insurance, social security, labour, education, economics, social policy and general legislation development, and environmental modification. It has been accepted as one of the United Nations social classifications and is referred to in and incorporates The Standard Rules on the Equalization of 5 Introduction ICF Opportunities for Persons with Disabilities. Thus ICF provides an appropriate instrument for the implementation of stated international human rights mandates as well as national legislation. 7 ICF is useful for a broad spectrum of different applications, for example social security, evaluation in managed health care, and population surveys at local, national and international levels. It offers a conceptual framework for information that is applicable to personal health care, including prevention, health promotion, and the improvement of participation by removing or mitigating societal hindrances and encouraging the provision of social supports and facilitators. It is also useful for the study of health care systems, in terms of both evaluation and policy formulation. 7 The Standard Rules on the Equalization of Opportunities for Persons with Disabilities. Adopted by the United Nations General Assembly at its 48th session on 20 December 1993 (resolution 48/96). New York, NY, United Nations Department of Public Information, 1994. 6 ICF 3. Introduction Properties of ICF A classification should be clear about what it classifies: its universe, its scope, its units of classification, its organization, and how these elements are structured in terms of their relation to each other. The following sections explain these basic properties of ICF. 3.1 Universe of ICF ICF encompasses all aspects of human health and some health-relevant components of well-being and describes them in terms of health domains and health-related domains. The classification remains in the broad context of health and does not cover circumstances that are not health-related, such as those brought about by socioeconomic factors. For example, because of their race, gender, religion or other socioeconomic characteristics people may be restricted in their execution of a task in their current environment, but these are not healthrelated restrictions of participation as classified in ICF. 8 There is a widely held misunderstanding that ICF is only about people with disabilities; in fact, it is about all people. The health and health-related states associated with all health conditions can be described using ICF. In other words, ICF has universal application. 9 3.2 Scope of ICF ICF provides a description of situations with regard to human functioning and its restrictions and serves as a framework to organize this information. It structures the information in a meaningful, interrelated and easily accessible way. ICF organizes information in two parts. Part 1 deals with Functioning and Disability, while Part 2 covers Contextual Factors. Each part has two components: 1. Components of Functioning and Disability The Body component comprises two classifications, one for functions of body systems, and one for body structures. The chapters in both classifications are organized according to the body systems. 8 Examples of health domains include seeing, hearing, walking, learning and remembering, while examples of health-related domains include transportation, education and social interactions. 9 Bickenbach JE, Chatterji S, Badley EM, Üstün TB. Models of disablement, universalism and the ICIDH, Social Science and Medicine, 1999, 48:1173-1187. 7 Introduction ICF The Activities and Participation component covers the complete range of domains denoting aspects of functioning from both an individual and a societal perspective. 2. Components of Contextual Factors A list of Environmental Factors is the first component of Contextual Factors. Environmental factors have an impact on all components of functioning and disability and are organized in sequence from the individual’s most immediate environment to the general environment. Personal Factors is also a component of Contextual Factors but they are not classified in ICF because of the large social and cultural variance associated with them. The components of Functioning and Disability in Part 1 of ICF can be expressed in two ways. On the one hand, they can be used to indicate problems (e.g. impairment, activity limitation or participation restriction summarized under the umbrella term disability); on the other hand they can indicate nonproblematic (i.e. neutral) aspects of health and health-related states summarized under the umbrella term functioning). These components of functioning and disability are interpreted by means of four separate but related constructs. These constructs are operationalized by using qualifiers. Body functions and structures can be interpreted by means of changes in physiological systems or in anatomical structures. For the Activities and Participation component, two constructs are available: capacity and performance (see section 4.2). A person's functioning and disability is conceived as a dynamic interaction between health conditions (diseases, disorders, injuries, traumas, etc.) and contextual factors. As indicate above, Contextual Factors include both personal and environmental factors. ICF includes a comprehensive list of environmental factors as an essential component of the classification. Environmental factors interact with all the components of functioning and disability. The basic construct of the Environmental Factors component is the facilitating or hindering impact of features of the physical, social and attitudinal world. 10 3.3 Unit of classification ICF classifies health and health-related states. The unit of classification is, therefore, categories within health and health-related domains. It is important to note, therefore, that in ICF persons are not the units of classification; that is, ICF does not classify people, but describes the situation of each person within an array of health or health-related domains. Moreover, the description is always made within the context of environmental and personal factors. 10 This interaction can be viewed as a process or a result depending on the user. 8 ICF Introduction 3.4 Presentation of ICF ICF is presented in two versions in order to meet the needs of different users for varying levels of detail. The full version of ICF, as contained in this volume, provides classification at four levels of detail. These four levels can be aggregated into a higher-level classification system that includes all the domains at the second level. The twolevel system is also available as a short version of ICF. 9 Introduction ICF 4. Overview of ICF components DEFINITIONS 11 In the context of health: Body functions are the physiological functions of body systems (including psychological functions). Body structures are anatomical parts of the body such as organs, limbs and their components. Impairments are problems in body function or structure such as a significant deviation or loss. Activity is the execution of a task or action by an individual. Participation is involvement in a life situation. Activity limitations are difficulties an individual may have in executing activities. Participation restrictions are problems an individual may experience in involvement in life situations. Environmental factors make up the physical, social and attitudinal environment in which people live and conduct their lives. An overview of these concepts is given in Table 1; they are explained further in operational terms in section 5.1. As the table indicates: • ICF has two parts, each with two components: Part 1. Functioning and Disability (a) Body Functions and Structures (b) Activities and Participation Part 2. Contextual Factors (c) Environmental Factors (d) Personal Factors • Each component can be expressed in both positive and negative terms. • Each component consists of various domains and, within each domain, categories, which are the units of classification. Health and health-related states of an individual may be recorded by selecting the appropriate category 11 See also Annex 1, Taxonomic and Terminological Issues. 10 ICF Introduction code or codes and then adding qualifiers, which are numeric codes that specify the extent or the magnitude of the functioning or disability in that category, or the extent to which an environmental factor is a facilitator or barrier. Table 1. An overview of ICF Part 1: Functioning and Disability Components Domains Body Functions and Structures Body functions Body structures Change in body functions (physiological) Constructs Change in body structures (anatomical) Positive aspect Functional and structural integrity Part 2: Contextual Factors Activities and Participation Environmental Factors Personal Factors Life areas (tasks, actions) External influences on functioning and disability Internal influences on functioning and disability Facilitating or Capacity Executing tasks in a hindering impact of Impact of attributes of standard environment features of the physical, social, and the person Performance attitudinal world Executing tasks in the current environment Activities Participation Facilitators not applicable Barriers / hindrances not applicable Functioning Impairment Negative aspect Activity limitation Participation restriction Disability 11 Introduction ICF 4.1 Body Functions and Structures and impairments Definitions: Body functions are the physiological functions of body systems (including psychological functions). Body structures are anatomical parts of the body such as organs, limbs and their components. Impairments are problems in body function or structure as a significant deviation or loss. (1) Body functions and body structures are classified in two different sections. These two classifications are designed for use in parallel. For example, body functions include basic human senses such as “seeing functions” and their structural correlates exist in the form of “eye and related structures”. (2) “Body” refers to the human organism as a whole; hence it includes the brain and its functions, i.e. the mind. Mental (or psychological) functions are therefore subsumed under body functions. (3) Body functions and structures are classified according to body systems; consequently, body structures are not considered as organs. 12 (4) Impairments of structure can involve an anomaly, defect, loss or other significant deviation in body structures. Impairments have been conceptualized in congruence with biological knowledge at the level of tissues or cells and at the subcellular or molecular level. For practical reasons, however, these levels are not listed. The biological foundations of impairments have guided the classification and there may be room for expanding the classification at the cellular or molecular levels. For medical users, it should be noted that impairments are not the same as the underlying pathology, but are the manifestations of that pathology. 13 (5) Impairments represent a deviation from certain generally accepted population standards in the biomedical status of the body and its functions, and definition of their constituents is undertaken primarily by those qualified to judge physical and mental functioning according to these standards. (6) Impairments can be temporary or permanent; progressive, regressive or static; intermittent or continuous. The deviation from the population norm may be slight or severe and may fluctuate over time. These characteristics are captured in further descriptions, mainly in the codes, by means of qualifiers after the point. 12 Although organ level was mentioned in the 1980 version of ICIDH, the definition of an “organ” is not clear. The eye and ear are traditionally considered as organs; however, it is difficult to identify and define their boundaries, and the same is true of extremities and internal organs. Instead of an approach by “organ”, which implies the existence of an entity or unit within the body, ICF replaces this term with “body structure”. 13 Thus impairments coded using the full version of ICF should be detectable or noticeable by others or the person concerned by direct observation or by inference from observation. 12 ICF Introduction (7) Impairments are not contingent on etiology or how they are developed; for example, loss of vision or a limb may arise from a genetic abnormality or an injury. The presence of an impairment necessarily implies a cause; however, the cause may not be sufficient to explain the resulting impairment. Also, when there is an impairment, there is a dysfunction in body functions or structures, but this may be related to any of the various diseases, disorders or physiological states. (8) Impairments may be part or an expression of a health condition, but do not necessarily indicate that a disease is present or that the individual should be regarded as sick. (9) Impairments are broader and more inclusive in scope than disorders or diseases; for example, the loss of a leg is an impairment of body structure, but not a disorder or a disease. (10) Impairments may result in other impairments; for example, a lack of muscle power may impair movement functions, heart functions may relate to deficit in respiratory functions, and impaired perception may relate to thought functions. (11) Some categories of the Body Functions and Structures component and the ICD-10 categories seem to overlap, particularly with regard to symptoms and signs. However, the purposes of the two classifications are different. ICD-10 classifies symptoms in special chapters to document morbidity or service utilization, whereas ICF shows them as part of the body functions, which may be used for prevention or identifying patients’ needs. Most importantly, in ICF the Body Functions and Structures classification is intended to be used along with the Activities and Participation categories. (12) Impairments are classified in the appropriate categories using defined identification criteria (e.g. as present or absent according to a threshold level). These criteria are the same for body functions and structures. They are: (a) loss or lack; (b) reduction; (c) addition or excess; and (d) deviation. Once an impairment is present, it may be scaled in terms of its severity using the generic qualifier in the ICF. (13) Environmental factors interact with body functions, as in the interactions between air quality and breathing, light and seeing, sounds and hearing, distracting stimuli and attention, ground texture and balance, and ambient temperature and body temperature regulation. 13 Introduction ICF 4.2 Activities and Participation /activity limitations and participation restrictions Definitions: Activity is the execution of a task or action by an individual. Participation is involvement in a life situation. Activity limitations are difficulties an individual may have in executing activities. Participation restrictions are problems an individual may experience in involvement in life situations. (1) The domains for the Activities and Participation component are given in a single list that covers the full range of life areas (from basic learning or watching to composite areas such as interpersonal interactions or employment). The component can be used to denote activities (a) or participation (p) or both. The domains of this component are qualified by the two qualifiers of performance and capacity. Hence the information gathered from the list provides a data matrix that has no overlap or redundancy (see Table 2). Table 2. Activities and Participation: information matrix Qualifiers Domains d1 Learning and applying knowledge d2 General tasks and demands d3 Communication d4 Mobility d5 Self-care d6 Domestic life d7 d8 Interpersonal interactions and relationships Major life areas d9 Community, social and civic life Performance 14 Capacity ICF Introduction (2) The performance qualifier describes what an individual does in his or her current environment. Because the current environment includes a societal context, performance can also be understood as "involvement in a life situation" or "the lived experience" of people in the actual context in which 14 they live. This context includes the environmental factors – all aspects of the physical, social and attitudinal world which can be coded using the Environmental Factors component. (3) The capacity qualifier describes an individual’s ability to execute a task or an action. This construct aims to indicate the highest probable level of functioning that a person may reach in a given domain at a given moment. To assess the full ability of the individual, one would need to have a “standardized” environment to neutralize the varying impact of different environments on the ability of the individual. This standardized environment may be: (a) an actual environment commonly used for capacity assessment in test settings; or (b) in cases where this is not possible, an assumed environment which can be thought to have a uniform impact. This environment can be called a “uniform” or “standard” environment. Thus, capacity reflects the environmentally adjusted ability of the individual. This adjustment has to be the same for all persons in all countries to allow for international comparisons. The features of the uniform or standard environment can be coded using the Environmental Factors classification. The gap between capacity and performance reflects the difference between the impacts of current and uniform environments, and thus provides a useful guide as to what can be done to the environment of the individual to improve performance. (4) Both capacity and performance qualifiers can further be used with and without assistive devices or personal assistance. While neither devices nor personal assistance eliminate the impairments, they may remove limitations on functioning in specific domains. This type of coding is particularly useful to identify how much the functioning of the individual would be limited without the assistive devices (see coding guidelines in Annex 2) (5) Difficulties or problems in these domains can arise when there is a qualitative or quantitative alteration in the way in which an individual carries out these domain functions. Limitations or restrictions are assessed against a generally accepted population standard. The standard or norm against which an individual’s capacity and performance is compared is that of an individual without a similar health condition (disease, disorder or injury, etc.). The limitation or restriction records the discordance between the observed and the expected performance. The expected performance is the population norm, which represents the experience of people without the specific health 14 The definition of “participation” brings in the concept of involvement. Some proposed definitions of “involvement” incorporate taking part, being included or engaged in an area of life, being accepted, or having access to needed resources. Within the information matrix in Table 2 the only possible indicator of participation is coding through performance. This does not mean that participation is automatically equated with performance. The concept of involvement should also be distinguished from the subjective experience of involvement (the sense of “belonging”). Users who wish to code involvement separately should refer to the coding guidelines in Annex 2. 15 Introduction ICF condition. The same norm is used in the capacity qualifier so that one can infer what can be done to the environment of the individual to enhance performance. (6) A problem with performance can result directly from the social environment, even when the individual has no impairment. For example, an individual who is HIV-positive without any symptoms or disease, or someone with a genetic predisposition to a certain disease, may exhibit no impairments or may have sufficient capacity to work, yet may not do so because of the denial of access to services, discrimination or stigma. (7) It is difficult to distinguish between "Activities" and "Participation" on the basis of the domains in the Activities and Participation component. Similarly, differentiating between “individual” and “societal” perspectives on the basis of domains has not been possible given international variation and differences in the approaches of professionals and theoretical frameworks. Therefore, ICF provides a single list that can be used, if users so wish, to differentiate activities and participation in their own operational ways. This is further explained in Annex 3. There are four possible ways of doing so: (a) to designate some domains as activities and others as participation, not allowing any overlap; (b) same as (a) above, but allowing partial overlap; (c) to designate all detailed domains as activities and the broad category headings as participation; (d) to use all domains as both activities and participation. 4.3 Contextual Factors Contextual Factors represent the complete background of an individual’s life and living. They include two components: Environmental Factors and Personal Factors – which may have an impact on the individual with a health condition and that individual’s health and health-related states. Environmental factors make up the physical, social and attitudinal environment in which people live and conduct their lives. These factors are external to individuals and can have a positive or negative influence on the individual’s performance as a member of society, on the individual’s capacity to execute actions or tasks, or on the individual’s body function or structure. (1) Environmental factors are organized in the classification to focus on two different levels: (a) Individual – in the immediate environment of the individual, including settings such as home, workplace and school. Included at this level are the physical and material features of the environment that an individual comes face to face with, as well as direct contact with others such as family, acquaintances, peers and strangers. 16 ICF Introduction (b) Societal – formal and informal social structures, services and overarching approaches or systems in the community or society that have an impact on individuals. This level includes organizations and services related to the work environment, community activities, government agencies, communication and transportation services, and informal social networks as well as laws, regulations, formal and informal rules, attitudes and ideologies. (2) Environmental factors interact with the components of Body Functions and Structures and Activities and Participation. For each component, the nature and extent of that interaction may be elaborated by future scientific work. Disability is characterized as the outcome or result of a complex relationship between an individual’s health condition and personal factors, and of the external factors that represent the circumstances in which the individual lives. Because of this relationship, different environments may have a very different impact on the same individual with a given health condition. An environment with barriers, or without facilitators, will restrict the individual’s performance; other environments that are more facilitating may increase that performance. Society may hinder an individual's performance because either it creates barriers (e.g. inaccessible buildings) or it does not provide facilitators (e.g. unavailability of assistive devices). Personal factors are the particular background of an individual’s life and living, and comprise features of the individual that are not part of a health condition or health states. These factors may include gender, race, age, other health conditions, fitness, lifestyle, habits, upbringing, coping styles, social background, education, profession, past and current experience (past life events and concurrent events), overall behaviour pattern and character style, individual psychological assets and other characteristics, all or any of which may play a role in disability at any level. Personal factors are not classified in ICF. However, they are included in Fig. 1 to show their contribution, which may have an impact on the outcome of various interventions. 17 Introduction ICF 5. Model of Functioning and Disability 5.1 Process of functioning and disability As a classification, ICF does not model the “process” of functioning and disability. It can be used, however, to describe the process by providing the means to map the different constructs and domains. It provides a multiperspective approach to the classification of functioning and disability as an interactive and evolutionary process. It provides the building blocks for users who wish to create models and study different aspects of this process. In this sense, ICF can be seen as a language: the texts that can be created with it depend on the users, their creativity and their scientific orientation. In order to visualize the current understanding of interaction of various components, the diagram presented in Fig. 1 may be helpful. 15 Fig. 1. Interactions between the components of ICF Health condition (disorder or disease) Body Functions and Structures Activities Environmental Factors Participation Personal Factors 15 ICF differs substantially from the 1980 version of ICIDH in the depiction of the interrelations between functioning and disability. It should be noted that any diagram is likely to be incomplete and prone to misrepresentation because of the complexity of interactions in a multidimensional model. The model is drawn to illustrate multiple interactions. Other depictions indicating other important foci in the process are certainly possible. Interpretations of interactions between different components and constructs may also vary (for example, the impact of environmental factors on body functions certainly differs from their impact on participation). 18 ICF Introduction In this diagram, an individual's functioning in a specific domain is an interaction or complex relationship between the health condition and contextual factors (i.e. environmental and personal factors). There is a dynamic interaction among these entities: interventions in one entity have the potential to modify one or more of the other entities. These interactions are specific and not always in a predictable one-to-one relationship. The interaction works in two directions; the presence of disability may even modify the health condition itself. To infer a limitation in capacity from one or more impairments, or a restriction of performance from one or more limitations, may often seem reasonable. It is important, however, to collect data on these constructs independently and thereafter explore associations and causal links between them. If the full health experience is to be described, all components are useful. For example, one may: • have impairments without having capacity limitations (e.g. a disfigurement in leprosy may have no effect on a person's capacity); • have performance problems and capacity limitations without evident impairments (e.g. reduced performance in daily activities associated with many diseases); • have performance problems without impairments or capacity limitations (e.g. an HIV-positive individual, or an ex-patient recovered from mental illness, facing stigmatization or discrimination in interpersonal relations or work); • have capacity limitations without assistance, and no performance problems in the current environment (e.g. an individual with mobility limitations may be provided by society with assistive technology to move around); • experience a degree of influence in a reverse direction (e.g. lack of use of limbs can cause muscle atrophy; institutionalization may result in loss of social skills). Case examples in Annex 4 further illustrate possibilities of interactions between the constructs. The scheme shown in Fig. 1 demonstrates the role that contextual factors (i.e. environmental and personal factors) play in the process. These factors interact with the individual with a health condition and determine the level and extent of the individual’s functioning. Environmental factors are extrinsic to the individual (e.g. the attitudes of the society, architectural characteristics, the legal system) and are classified in the Environmental Factors classification. Personal Factors, on the other hand, are not classified in the current version of ICF. They include gender, race, age, fitness, lifestyle, habits, coping styles and other such factors. Their assessment is left to the user, if needed. 19 Introduction ICF 5.2 Medical and social models A variety of conceptual models has been proposed to understand and explain disability and functioning. These may be expressed in a dialectic of “medical model” versus “social model”. The medical model views disability as a problem of the person, directly caused by disease, trauma or other health condition, which requires medical care provided in the form of individual treatment by professionals. Management of the disability is aimed at cure or the individual’s adjustment and behaviour change. Medical care is viewed as the main issue, and at the political level the principal response is that of modifying or reforming health care policy. The social model of disability, on the other hand, sees the issue mainly as a socially created problem, and basically as a matter of the full integration of individuals into society. Disability is not an attribute of an individual, but rather a complex collection of conditions, many of which are created by the social environment. Hence the management of the problem requires social action, and it is the collective responsibility of society at large to make the environmental modifications necessary for the full participation of people with disabilities in all areas of social life. The issue is therefore an attitudinal or ideological one requiring social change, which at the political level becomes a question of human rights. For this model disability is a political issue. 16 ICF is based on an integration of these two opposing models. In order to capture the integration of the various perspectives of functioning, a “biopsychosocial” approach is used. Thus, ICF attempts to achieve a synthesis, in order to provide a coherent view of different perspectives of health from a biological, individual and social perspective. 17 16 The term "model" here means construct or paradigm, which differs from the use of the term in the previous section. 17 See also Annex 5 - “ICF and people with disabilities”. 20 ICF Introduction 6. Use of ICF ICF is a classification of human functioning and disability. It systematically groups health and health-related domains. Within each component, domains are further grouped according to their common characteristics (such as their origin, type, or similarity) and ordered in a meaningful way. The classification is organized according to a set of principles (see Annex 1). These principles refer to the interrelatedness of the levels and the hierarchy of the classification (sets of levels). However, some categories in ICF are arranged in a non-hierarchical manner, with no ordering but as equal members of a branch. The following are structural features of the classification that have a bearing on its use. (1) ICF gives standard operational definitions of the health and health-related domains as opposed to “vernacular” definitions of health. These definitions describe the essential attributes of each domain (e.g. qualities, properties, and relationships) and contain information as to what is included and excluded in each domain. The definitions contain commonly used anchor points for assessment so that they can be translated into questionnaires. Conversely, results from existing assessment instruments can be coded in ICF terms. For example, “seeing functions” are defined in terms of functions of sensing form and contour, from varying distances, using one or both eyes, so that the severity of difficulties of vision can be coded at mild, moderate, severe or total levels in relation to these parameters. (2) ICF uses an alphanumeric system in which the letters b, s, d and e are used to denote Body Functions, Body Structures, Activities and Participation, and Environmental Factors. These letters are followed by a numeric code that starts with the chapter number (one digit), followed by the second level (two digits), and the third and fourth levels (one digit each). (3) ICF categories are “nested” so that broader categories are defined to include more detailed subcategories of the parent category. (For example, Chapter 4 in the Activities and Participation component, on Mobility, includes separate categories on standing, sitting, walking, carrying items, and so on). The short (concise) version covers two levels, whereas the full (detailed) version extends to four levels. The short version and full version codes are in correspondence, and the short version can be aggregated from the full version. (4) Any individual may have a range of codes at each level. These may be independent or interrelated. (5) The ICF codes are only complete with the presence of a qualifier, which denotes a magnitude of the level of health (e.g. severity of the problem). Qualifiers are coded as one, two or more numbers after a point (or separator). Use of any code should be accompanied by at least one qualifier. Without qualifiers, codes have no inherent meaning. 21 Introduction ICF (6) The first qualifier for Body Functions and Structures, the performance and capacity qualifiers for Activities and Participation, and the first qualifier for Environmental Factors all describe the extent of problems in the respective component. (7) All three components classified in ICF (Body Functions and Structures, Activities and Participation, and Environmental Factors) are quantified using the same generic scale. Having a problem may mean an impairment, limitation, restriction or barrier depending on the construct. Appropriate qualifying words as shown in brackets below should be chosen according to the relevant classification domain (where xxx stands for the second-level domain number). For this quantification to be used in a universal manner, assessment procedures need to be developed through research. Broad ranges of percentages are provided for those cases in which calibrated assessment instruments or other standards are available to quantify the impairment, capacity limitation, performance problem or barrier. For example, when “no problem” or “complete problem” is specified the coding has a margin of error of up to 5%. “Moderate problem” is defined as up to half of the time or half the scale of total difficulty. The percentages are to be calibrated in different domains with reference to relevant population standards as percentiles. xxx.0 NO problem xxx.1 MILD problem xxx.2 MODERATE problem xxx.3 SEVERE problem xxx.4 COMPLETE problem xxx.8 not specified xxx.9 not applicable (none, absent, negligible,… ) (slight, low,…) (medium, fair,...) (high, extreme, …) (total,…) 0-4 % 5-24 % 25-49 % 50-95 % 96-100 % (8) In the case of environmental factors, this first qualifier can be used to denote either the extent of positive effects of the environment, i.e. facilitators, or the extent of negative effects, i.e. barriers. Both use the same 0-4 scale, but to denote facilitators the point is replaced by a plus sign: for example e110+2. Environmental Factors can be coded (a) in relation to each construct individually, or (b) overall, without reference to any individual construct. The first option is preferable, since it identifies the impact and attribution more clearly. (9) For different users, it might be appropriate and helpful to add other kinds of information to the coding of each item. There are a variety of additional qualifiers that could be useful. Table 3 sets out the details of the qualifiers for each component as well as suggested additional qualifiers to be developed. (10) The descriptions of health and health-related domains refer to their use at a given moment (i.e. as a snapshot). However, use at multiple time points is possible to describe a trajectory over time and process. (11) In ICF, a person's health and health-related states are given an array of codes that encompass the two parts of the classification. Thus the maximum 22 ICF Introduction number of codes per person can be 34 at the one-digit level (8 body functions, 8 body structures, 9 performance and 9 capacity codes). Similarly, for the two-level items the total number of codes is 362. At more detailed levels, these codes number up to 1424 items. In real-life applications of ICF, a set of 3 to 18 codes may be adequate to describe a case with two-level (three-digit) precision. Generally the more detailed four-level version is used for specialist services (e.g. rehabilitation outcomes, geriatrics), whereas the two-level classification can be used for surveys and clinical outcome evaluation. Further coding guidelines are presented in Annex 2. Users are strongly recommended to obtain training in the use of the classification through WHO and its network of collaborating centres. 23 Introduction ICF Table 3. Qualifiers Components Body Functions (b) First qualifier Second qualifier Generic qualifier with the negative scale used to indicate the extent or magnitude of an impairment None Example: b167.3 to indicate a severe impairment in specific mental functions of language Body Structures (s) Activities and Participation (d) Generic qualifier with the negative scale used to indicate the extent or magnitude of an impairment Example: s730.3 to indicate a severe impairment of the upper extremity Used to indicate the nature of the change in the respective body structure: 0 no change in structure 1 total absence 2 partial absence 3 additional part 4 aberrant dimensions 5 discontinuity 6 deviating position 7 qualitative changes in structure, including accumulation of fluid 8 not specified 9 not applicable Example: s730.32 to indicate the partial absence of the upper extremity Performance Capacity Generic qualifier Generic qualifier Problem in the person's current environment Limitation without assistance Example: d5101.1_ to indicate mild difficulty with bathing the whole body with the use of assistive devices that are available to the person in his or her current environment Environmental Factors (e) Generic qualifier, with negative and positive scale, to denote extent of barriers and facilitators respectively Example: e130.2 to indicate that products for education are a moderate barrier. Conversely, e130+2 would indicate that products for education are a moderate facilitator 24 Example: d5101._2 to indicate moderate difficulty with bathing the whole body; implies that there is moderate difficulty without the use of assistive devices or personal help None ICF Introduction 54th World Health Assembly endorsement of ICF for international use The resolution WHA54.21 reads as follows: The Fifty-fourth World Health Assembly, 1. ENDORSES the second edition of the International Classification of Impairments, Disabilities and Handicaps (ICIDH), with the title International Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health, henceforth referred to in short as ICF; 2. URGES Member States to use ICF in their research, surveillance and reporting as appropriate, taking into account specific situations in Member States and, in particular, in view of possible future revisions; 3. REQUESTS the Director-General to provide support to Member States, at their request, in making use of ICF. 25 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 1 Subcommittee on Populations National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics (NCVHS) CLASSIFYING AND REPORTING FUNCTIONAL STATUS Information on functional status is becoming increasingly essential for fostering healthy people and a healthy population. Achieving optimal health and well-being for Americans requires an understanding across the life span of the effects of people’s health conditions on their ability to do basic activities and participate in life situationsin other words, their functional status. Some clinical professionals routinely use functional status information to care for their patients, but the information is often missing from physicians’ notes for acute hospital care and routine outpatient medical visits. And even when the information is present in medical records, it only rarely becomes part of administrative records. This prevents a host of possible beneficial uses of the information for management, research, public health, and policy purposes. This report is the result of an 18-month-long review by the Subcommittee on Populations of the National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics (NCVHS), concerning the feasibility of including functional status data in administrative records. NCVHS advises the Department of Health and Human Services on national health information policy.1 The Populations Subcommittee consulted with 27 clinicians, researchers, and other data users from the U.S., Canada, and the World Health Organization at three NCVHS hearings in 2000. The presenters were unanimous in stressing that health care and health policy must go beyond a narrow disease-based focus to a broader approach that emphasizes people’s health and well-being, with a goal of minimizing future loss of function. This report has two major purposes: to put functional status solidly on the radar screens of those responsible for health information policy, and to begin laying the groundwork for greater use of functional status information in and beyond clinical care. It stems from the belief that while the International Classification of Diseases (ICD) has served us well for more than a century in characterizing diagnoses, it is now time to complement it with a parallel system for characterizing functional status. The report begins by surveying the current and potential uses of functional status information, and then discusses the importance of including this information in clinical and administrative records to support optimal decision-making for health. The World Health Organization’s newly-revised International Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health (ICF) is described as a promising approach to coding functional status information. The Committee believes that a coding system that specifies the Further information about NCVHS and its work in areas related to this report is contained in Appendix 5. 1 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 2 elements of functioning is an appropriate place to start dealing with the issues of measurement and interpretation of functional status. Further, the Committee believes that the ICF deserves careful study, under the direction of the Department of Health and Human Services, as a potential codeset for reporting this information. The report concludes with a series of recommendations on the ICF and related topics.2 FUNCTIONAL STATUS INFORMATION Definitions Functional status is variously defined in the health field, by clinicians with different emphases as well as in different policy contexts. This NCVHS project uses a broad view of functional status that covers both the individual carrying out activities of daily living and the individual participating in life situations and society. These two broad areas include 1) basic physical and cognitive activities such as walking or reaching, focusing attention, and communicating, as well as the routine activities of daily living, including eating, bathing, dressing, transferring, and toileting; and 2) life situations such as school or play for children and, for adults, work outside the home or maintaining a household. Functional limitations occur when a person’s capacity to carry out such activities or performance of such activities is compromised due to a health condition or injury and is not compensated by environmental factors (including physical, social, and attitudinal factors). Functional status is affected by physical, developmental, behavioral, emotional, social, and environmental conditions. This conception encompasses the whole person, as engaged in his or her physical and social environment. It applies across the lifespan, although interpretation of functional status differs for different age groups. Current and Potential Uses of Functional Status Measurement We must have a way to study our interventions in order to treat the right conditions at the right time and in the right manner.3 We waste a lot of time and an enormous amount of effort in the transition between services [for children] because we don’t have a common language.4 Functional status is among the most predictive elements in terms of utilization as well as outcomes.5 2Quotes used throughout this report were part of testimony given in the January, April, and July 2000 Subcommittee hearings. All presenters are listed in Appendix 2. 3 Judy Hawley, P.T. (July) 4 Rune Simeonsson, M.D. (April) 5 Robert Kane, M.D. (January) National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 3 Functional status assessment is carried out through professional observation, testing, and/or self-report by the patient or a proxy. Some functional status instruments are generic, such as the SF-36, while others are disease-specific, such as the Activities of Daily Vision Scale. Instruments addressing the activities of daily living (ADLs) include the Functional Independence Measure (FIM), the Minimum Data Set (MDS), the MDS for Post-Acute Care (MDS-PAC), and the Outcome and Assessment Information Set (OASIS). Hundreds of specialized instruments have been developed to assist practice in such areas as geriatrics, psychiatry, and nursing practice. The information generated by these assessments can be used not only in clinical care but also for health care management, quality assurance, public health planning and practice, policy development, and research. At present, the most developed uses of the information are in clinical care; the others remain largely potentialities, to be realized once a standardized way has been found to include the data in administrative records and related data sets. The concept of functional status is integral to all health care and applies to every person, regardless of age, physical or mental condition, or other characteristic. Two individuals with the same diagnosisfor example, cerebral palsy, bipolar disorder, or arthritiscan have very different levels of functioning, and their actual health status could be either better or worse than assumed. Even those who at certain times in their lives have no functional limitations should have this information included in their medical records at appropriate intervals along with other routinely-recorded clinical findings, to complement the information on diagnosis and health condition. Research is needed on such questions as frequency, coding, self-report and provider assessment. Functional status information is commonly used in rehabilitative medicine, physical and occupational therapy, and nursing home and home care. The information is used to guide therapy in areas such as hearing, speech, vision, cognition, and mobility. It also is used to design and coordinate services for children with special needs and to monitor the well-being of people with various chronic conditions. Depending on the person and condition, health care providers can use functional status information to determine people’s needs, develop interventions to restore or maintain function or prevent or minimize its decline, and prevent secondary disabilities. They also can track changes and follow people across settings and monitor quality and outcomes. Using functional status information, health care providers can help their patients maximize their abilitiesarguably the purpose of all health care. The Committee does not recommend imposing a single measurement instrument or methodology on clinical practice; rather, it recommends the use of a uniform code set so that health care providers can consistently report on their findings across the continuum of care, for clinical and administrative purposes. 6 A code set is any set of codes used for encoding data elements, such as tables of terms, medical concepts, medical diagnosis codes, or medical procedure codes. The International Classification of Diseases and the National Drug Codes are examples of code sets. 6 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 4 Functional status information could serve the management needs of health care providers and payers in such areas as financial management, utilization review and quality assurance. The information is used, or could be used, to evaluate outcomes, compare treatment modalities, and predict costs. Knowing and tracking people’s functional status could help health care organizations predict service utilization and resource use. The information is useful for risk adjustment and for documenting medical necessity, both of which are needed for payment and other purposes. Payers could use functional status information to adjust payment levels and capitation rates. Eligibility determination for some public programs requires information on function. Information in administrative records on people’s functional status and changes in it over time could strengthen efforts to evaluate health care performance, compare treatment modalities, and tie inputs to outcomes for quality assurance purposes. Quality assurance activities often start with administrative data, which are more readily available than clinical data. Such assessments are of interest not only to public and private payers, but also to policy makers, bodies such as the National Committee on Quality Assurance, and health care providers themselves. The President’s Advisory Commission on Consumer Protection and Quality explicitly discussed the importance of functional status information in its 1998 report. HCFA, the largest public-sector payer, is supporting several quality improvement initiatives in managed care and feefor-service environments. A major thrust is the development of standardized data collection and reporting tools to enhance the utility of regularly collected information, potentially including functional status information. Of course, functional status information could be used not only to assess quality of care but also to improve it, for the reasons noted in the preceding section. Functional status information could help public health practitioners monitor and evaluate the health of the entire population and its component groups. Some of the most compelling needs for the information relate to Healthy People 2010. The two overarching goals for Healthy People 2010increasing quality and years of healthy life and eliminating population health disparitiesdepend on functional status assessment. Also, the specific 2010 objectives for disabilities and secondary conditions (section 6) cannot be measured, much less met, without functional status information. Many other objectives also require it. Currently, some state and federal surveys collect this information on samples of the population, which can complement missing administrative data. The samples used in surveys do not have broad enough coverage, however, to give confidence that functional status within the population is accurately represented. A major contribution of surveys is to provide valid and reliable depth about specific areas of functional status; administrative data are needed for breadth. Several potential policy applications of functional status information have already been mentioned. These include helping decision-makers set research and policy priorities, predict costs, prioritize federal, state and local health care and public health initiatives, and develop programs for priority populations. Ongoing surveillance data may be used to monitor changes and evaluate the effect of interventions. Finally, researchers need functional status information not only to investigate clinical subjects but also for research in the areas of health care management, public health practice, and policy. National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 5 If we are going to assess characteristics of people, we want to know something more about what is going to contribute to their health and well being. Knowledge of limitations and personal activities will provide the most useful additional information for understanding the individual, as well as aggregated information describing health needs and possible resources required.7 We have to have a way to reduce the potential for future loss of function, particularly in the 10 or 15 percent of the population that use most of our health care dollars and are most vulnerable to loss of function.8 The Challenges of Measuring and Reporting Functional Status Little attention is being paid to the cumulative impact of childhood impairment over the lifetime…. So although it seems like these are very complicated issues, it is very important that we deal with them, and that we include functioning.9 Although there is growing recognition of the importance of functional status information, assessment, measurement and interpretation still involve many challenges. These include the existence of different conceptual bases as well as technical and methodological problems with the tools themselves, lack of proper validation studies in some cases, issues with how they are administered, complications stemming from the multiplicity of tools, and a host of external issues related to institutional barriers, cost, time constraints, training needs, and conceptual barriers. Measuring functional status is particularly difficult with persons with cognitive limitations, either because cognitive capacity has not yet developed (as in very young children) or because it is impaired. The need to use proxies in these cases raises questions about the validity of the findings. In addition, it often is not possible to assess children’s inherent capacity to do something because their physical and cognitive skills are undeveloped. Children must be assessed in terms of both their current and potential functioning in order to develop appropriate interventions. Pediatrician Ruth Stein noted “four Ds of childhood” that distinguish children from adults and pose challenges for interpreting functional differences: “developmental change, dependency on parents and other adults, differential epidemiology, and difference in demographic patterns.”10 As with all health information, privacy issues must be taken into consideration in the disclosure and use of functional status information for people of all ages (although some experts view the privacy concerns in this area as no more serious than in others). Another issue is that because functional status affects such things as disabilDonald Lollar, Ed.D. (January) Gretchen Swanson, Ph.D. (January) 9 Ruth Stein, M.D. (January) 10 (January) 7 8 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 6 ity benefits and payment based on medical necessity, patients or proxies and providers have a perverse incentive to modulate reporting, making measurement subject to conscious as well as unconscious bias. In all, discussions during the NCVHS hearings made it abundantly clear that the science of functional status measurement is still under development and that no consensus yet exists on how to define and measure this complex phenomenon. At the same time, it was also clear that dozens of workable generic and disease-specific instruments are available and in use, with many still undergoing further testing and yet others being newly developed. The Subcommittee concluded that reviewing functional status measurement was beyond its scope and purview, except to note that much more work is needed in developing suitable instruments for infants and children. The decision to focus on the feasibility of incorporating functional status information into standardized clinical and administrative records stemmed in part from the expectation that a uniform coding instrument could mitigate some of the challenges related to functional status measurement, especially those related to the multiplicity of tools and definitions. Furthermore, by essentially defining concepts in operational terms, a code set makes it possible to deal with both measurement and interpretation issues more intelligently and efficiently. FUNCTIONAL STATUS IN ADMINISTRATIVE RECORDS If the purpose of the health care claim is to submit information in order to be paid appropriately for service rendered, [then] the more accurate the information, the more appropriately the claim is paid. . . . If a physical therapist could code what they are treatingfor instance, gait dysfunctionthe picture created for the insurance company would be more accurate and complete.11 The point has already been made that administrative data generally do not include information on functional status.12 The significance of this fact is that information on this dimension of healthincreasingly the sine qua non for understanding healthis not available to the health care system (e.g., insurers and health plans), nor to the researchers, public health workers, and policy makers who depend on administrative data. What is needed, therefore, is a standardized code set that will enable providers, with minimal burden, to include functional status information in administrative data. For this reason, the NCVHS Subcommittee on Populations focused its study on the feasibility of including functional status information in administrative data, including a beginning look at how the information could be coded and transmitted. 11Judy Hawley, P.T. (July) The best-known exceptions to this rule are the Minimum Data Set (MDS), collected quarterly in nursing homes; the Outcome and Assessment Information Set (OASIS), collected during home health visits; and collection by rehabilitation hospitals using various approaches. Medicare requires the use of MDS and OASIS with Medicare beneficiaries, and includes this information in its administrative data. However, these “enriched” administrative data represent only small, non-random populations, mostly seniors. 12 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 7 Administrative data are compiled from the enrollment process and health care encounters. Resulting claims or encounter records are submitted by providers to payers and health plans so they can be reimbursed for their services (in non-capitated programs) and service utilization and aspects of quality can be monitored. Thus, payment and financial management are the first order of business for administrative data. They serve other equally important purposes, however. Administrative data complement surveys as an essential source of health statistics used to identify people with potentially disabling conditions, monitor the population’s health, target interventions, evaluate health care quality, predict costs, design and track the results of health policy, and conduct health services research. Although they have many limitations, administrative data offer a number of important advantages. First, they already exist, are relatively inexpensive to acquire, and are computer-readable. Second, they can include large groups of people, thus enhancing the utility of information for management purposes. Third, for some population subgroups (primarily Medicare beneficiaries at present), longitudinal, person-level administrative databases can track study subjects over time and across settings of care. And finally, the large number of cases in aggregated data bases helps hide individual identities. It must be acknowledged that a major problem with administrative data is that with some exceptions, they exclude the uninsured. For those with administrative records, however, the chief limitations of current data stem from their reliance on diagnostic codes, which are regarded as having questionable accuracy, completeness, clinical scope, and meaningfulness. Most diagnoses alone convey little about their effects on people’s daily activities or the impact of people’s social or physical environments. Diagnosis does not reveal or predict functionand function has an enormous effect on utilization rates and is a good indicator of quality of care, among other things. Without functional status information, the researchers, policy makers, and others who are already using administrative data have at best a rough idea of how people, individually and collectively, are doingand at worst they are making erroneous assumptions and decisions. The addition of this information would make administrative records far more useful for the purposes for which they are already used, as well as for the many other potential applications discussed above. For example, the information is critically needed to support DHHS initiatives to design and modify prospective payment systems under Medicaid and Medicare. And Dr. Gregg Meyer, Director of the Center for Quality Measurement and Improvement for the Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality, told the Committee in June 1999 that functional status information was one of his top “wishes” for administrative data for use in assessing quality of care. In short, the institutions responsible for payment, public health, and policy need this information, along with information about diagnoses and health conditions, to make the best possible decisions in their domains. The passage of the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act (HIPAA) in 1996 introduced another powerful vector into the dynamics of this issue. When the National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 8 first standards become mandatory in October 2002, providers will no longer contend with dozens of different claim forms, definitions, and sets of instructions. National standards are developed in consultation with Standards Development Organizations (SDOs). By agreement with the federal government, recommended changes in claims and transaction standards are the purview of Designated SDOs and Data Content Committees, known collectively as Designated Standards Maintenance Organizations, or DSMOs. The law’s administrative simplification provisions impose stringent requirements for changing or enhancing the standards, necessitating the support of the healthcare industry based on a strong business case. However, they also represent active federal support for standardizing administrative data, code sets, and transactions. There are other signs of growing interest in standardization. Of particular note is a recent congressional requirement, enacted as part of the Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP Benefits Improvement Act of 2000, calling for the HHS Secretary to submit to several congressional committees by January 1, 2005 a report on the development of standard instruments for the assessment of the health and functional status of beneficiaries for whom a wide array of Medicare services are provided. This legislative requirement was foreshadowed in January, 2000, when Sally Kaplan, Ph.D., of the Medicare Payment Advisory Commission (MedPac) told the Subcommittee on Populations, We strongly believe that it would be extremely useful, to say the least, to have standardization of functional status measures at least in post-acute care so that if similar patients are treated in different post-acute settings, or if patients are treated in successive post-acute care settings, that we would have a means of measuring them.... It would expand the utility of regularly collected information.13 Subsequently, in a March 2001 report to Congress, MedPac advised that HCFA have a single tool for functional status measurement and reporting. In sum, there seems to be considerable momentum toward standardizing definitions and terminology related to functional status so that it is possible to track people across settings and to communicate across disciplines. ICF: CANDIDATE FOR THE CODE SET The ICIDH-2 provides a solid conceptual framework for clinical assessment and provides strong support for all that we do as rehabilitation service providers, clinicians, researchers and teachers.14 Based on its extensive hearings and deliberations over a period of 18 months, the Subcommittee on Populations concluded that a promising candidate as a code setand the only viable one at presentis the International Classification of Func- The National Committee had made similar observations in a July 3, 1997 letter to the HHS Data Council (see NCVHS web site). 14 Gloriajean Wallace, Ph.D. (July) 13 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 9 tioning, Disability and Health (ICF15). This newly revised classification was created in 1980 (and then called the International Classification of Impairments, Disabilities, and Handicaps, or ICIDH) by the World Health Organization (WHO) to provide a unifying framework for classifying the consequences of disease. The classification complements WHO’s International Classification of Diseases (ICD), which contains information on diagnosis and health condition but not on functional status. A Brief Description The ICF provides a framework and classification scheme for describing a wide range of information about health. It is structured around two broad components 1) body functions and structure and 2) activities (related to tasks and actions by an individual) and participation (involvement in a life situation) with additional information on severity and environmental factors. Functioning and disability are viewed as a complex interaction between the health condition of the individual and the contextual factors of the environment as well as personal factors. The picture produced by this combination of factors and dimensions is of “the person in his or her world.” The classification treats these dimensions as interactive and dynamic rather than linear or static. It allows for an assessment of the degree of disability, although it is not a measurement instrument. It is applicable to all people, whatever their health condition. The language of the ICF is neutral as to etiology, placing the emphasis on function rather than condition or disease. It also is carefully designed to be relevant across cultures as well as age groups and genders, making it highly appropriate for the heterogeneous population of the United States. An example of the use of the ICF to classify a case study is contained in Appendix 4; a WHO description of the classification is in Appendix 3.16 Many who spoke at the Subcommittee’s hearings described the conceptual framework of the ICF as solid and useful. Some recommended that the classification be piloted and further tested to determine its appropriateness as a standardized set for coding functional status data. Others who testified said their organizations have already started to use it for this and other purposes (see examples below). On the strength of these recommendations, the National Committee has concluded that the ICF is worthy of consideration as a possible standardized format for coding functional status information, following testing, piloting, and perhaps further modification. Development of ICIDH/ICF The exhaustive revision process that resulted in the ICF took nearly a decade and involved comments from more than 80 countries and field tests in 42 countries, as well as input from scientists, non-governmental organizations, and others. The process, which was explicitly guided by the needs of users, resulted in a version that was approved by the WHO Executive Board in January 2001 and given final approval by the World Health Assembly in May 2001. Also sometimes called ICIDH-2. This example captures all components of ICF, while routine collection of functional status in administrative records might be more limited and focused on functional limitations. 15 16 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 10 The United States played a major role in the revision, which involved not only federal agencies but also consumer advocacy groups, professional organizations, private sector disability insurance companies, and mental health and disability researchers. Early in the revision process, NCVHS hosted a hearing on the ICIDH in 1993, hearing from consumer advocates, scientists, data users, clinicians, and administrators about their hopes for the revision process. All of these groups had further opportunities to provide input into the process. The WHO Collaborating Center for the Classification of Diseases for North America, housed at the National Center for Health Statistics (and informally called the North American Collaborating Center), coordinated the participation of the U.S. and Canada. Americans had leadership roles in the International Mental Health Task Force, which achieved one of the major changes in the second edition, giving mental functioning parity with physical functioning. North Americans also had leadership roles in the International Children’s Task Force and the International Environmental Task Force. The revised version, the ICF, is widely regarded as a significant conceptual and practical advance over the first one, making it more flexible and useful. The revision process also instituted a process for updating the classification. Dr. Raymond Seltser has noted that the issues with ICIDH that were outlined by Dr. Saad Nagi in a 1991 Institute of Medicine Committee report do not apply to the ICF.17 Efforts were made to make the ICF relevant to children, and the new version can be used to classify their functioning. The International Children’s Task Force is working on a children’s version, which is expected in about two years. Steps to advance the ICF and its use in the U.S. and abroad are being spearheaded by WHO and various stakeholders including the North American Collaborating Center, HHS, and the following professional organizations: the American Speech, Language and Hearing Association; the American Occupational Therapy Association; and the American Psychological Association (APA). A wide range of educational, training, and pilot-testing efforts are also planned or underway. In addition to building awareness of the classification among clinicians, APA is working collaboratively with WHO, other professional organizations, and business and government stakeholders to develop a standard functional assessment procedure manual based on the ICF. In another arena, the ICF was used as a conceptual base for the development of WHO’s Disability Assessment Schedule II, in collaboration with three Institutes from the National Institutes of Health. It is now being used in national surveys in the U.S. as well as in international studies.18 Saad Nagi, "Disability Concepts Revisited: Implications for Prevention," Appendix A of IOM’s Disability in America (1991). Dr. Seltser’s comments were made at the July hearing. 18 More information on ICF is available on the WHO website, http://www.who.int/icidh 17 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 11 Comments on the Classification’s Merits and Drawbacks [The ICF model] addresses the outcome measure of individual performance across disciplines. This hasn't been done before in our medical system. It is also a model which explicitly recognizes the contribution of the environment on the performance of people who have disabilities, and we hope it will eliminate language barriers between professions. As the pressure for accountability increases and the evidence of clinical effectiveness becomes a requirement for reimbursement, this model may become a clear measure to determine if the appropriate clinical outcomes have been achieved. This model would help payers recognize the performance gains in therapy.19 The panelists in the April and July hearings offered opinions on the ICF that ranged from qualified support tempered by caveats, on the one hand, to enthusiastic endorsement and reports of arenas in which clinicians, educators, and researchers are already using the classification, on the other. A few representative comments from the July 2000 meeting, which was devoted to the ICF, are summarized below. (It is worth noting that the classification has undergone significant additional development since then.) In the policy area, John Crews of the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention observed that the ICF creates a method for linking broad public policy (e.g., on transportation and employment) with disability policy. Dr. Raymond Seltser of the University of Pittsburgh stressed the unprecedented ability of the classification to unify disparate fields, make encounter forms more meaningful, and enable the healthcare delivery system to help people maximize their abilities. The American Psychological Association, which values the etiological neutrality of the classification, believes the ICF would be an appropriate way to capture functional status information on health care claims and that this can be done in a relatively simple, methodologically sound manner. So reported Christopher McLaughlin of APA. Dr. Travis Threats of St. Louis University and the American Speech, Language, and Hearing Association said the Schwab Rehabilitation Center, affiliated with the University of Chicago Hospital, has adopted the ICF as a rehabilitation model. Dr. Susan Stark of Washington University School of Medicine reported that the American Occupational Therapy’s practice guide for occupational therapists uses the ICF as a model for understanding the relationships between person, environment, and outcome factors. AOTA views the classification as a “language neutralizer” that facilitates communication between disciplines. Dr. Stark cited institutions that are using the ICF for education and training of OTs, and she stated that the classification can guide assessment, help show clinical effectiveness, and track performance. 19 Susan Stark, Ph.D., OTR/L (July) National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 12 Judy Hawley, P.T., of the Minnesota chapter of the American Physical Therapy Association (APTA) reported that this state chapter intends to incorporate the ICF into the Minnesota Outcome Study and use it to capture activity and activity limitation. The Minnesota chapter is not representative of the parent body, however. Dr. Andrew Guccione of APTA expressed concerns about the validity of the ICF, particularly in the area of participation and the way it addresses the environment. Nevertheless, he noted the potential value of the classification for crosswalking to different assessments and for developing computerized documentation systems. Perhaps the greatest concern of APTA is that the ICF is not compatible with the current requirements of insurance companies and payers. Two other presenters, Michael Wolfson and Alexander Ruggieri, raised questions about the conceptual design as well as operational issues. Dr. Wolfson, who is Assistant Chief Statistician at Statistics Canada and an active partner in the WHO Collaborating Center for the Classification of Diseases for North America, discussed many of the potential contributions of the ICF but also raised concerns about aspects of its conceptual framework. He advised caution, pointing out that even unanimity on the importance of functional status on the encounter form would not necessarily mean that the ICF is the appropriate mechanism for it. Dr. Ruggieri, of the Mayo Foundation, called the ICF “a promising conceptual tool” but also noted the need for a rigorous modeling effort. In addition, he commented on the problems in establishing any new data field on administrative forms. He called for studies to evaluate how well the ICF serves informational needs in various clinical settings before considering its appropriateness as a functional status data field on health care claims. During the July hearing, the Subcommittee also elicited comments on a possible process for achieving the inclusion of functional status information in clinical and administrative records. Dr. Seltser commented on the change in thinking and practice this calls for: “Something has to be done to reverse this situation where the physicians don’t think functional assessment is important because the ICD is the driving force. The disease model is being perpetuated by the encounter form.” He added, “The journey of 1,000 miles begins with a single step. And what you are asking us to consider in terms of the incorporation of a functional assessment element into the encounter forms, administrative records, is to me the first step in a journey of 1,000 miles.” On testing the ICF as a tool for that purpose, Dr. Jayne Lux, a former WHO staff member, took a similarly long-term view, saying that a pilot of coding functional status on administrative records using the ICF could roll out in “a couple of years.” Several speakers at the hearings offered specific suggestions on strategy. Dr. Seltser advocated raising awareness among those on the business side of health care about the potential economic benefits of functional status information. Robert Griss suggested the initiation of demonstration projects in managed care, and Dr. Wallace stressed the importance of minimizing the burden of collecting and coding the information. Dr. Iezzoni advised that alliances be formed with the physician groups most likely to be sympathetic, such as physical medicine, geriatrics, rheumatology, and pediatrics. Mr. McLaughlin described the collaborative process to which the American Psychological Association has already committed considerable time and resources. National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 13 The net effect of this array of expert, experience-based observation, then, is not only to affirm the critical uses of functional status information but also to portray the ICF as a possible code set for including the information in standardized clinical and administrative records. The National Committee believes the ICF is a worthwhile subject of rigorous examination and testing in this regard. NCVHS RECOMMENDATIONS The following NCVHS recommendations are intended to help bring about three basic and necessary steps, which are likely to take several years: first, broad agreement on the importance of collecting functional status information; second, selection of a code set for functional status data in standardized records, including electronic patient records and claims and encounter records; and third, selection and testing of a code set for these purposes. The Committee believes that the ICF should be evaluated for use in coding functional status information in both electronic patient records and administrative data. This research should begin as soon as possible, under the leadership of HHS, with the intention of readying a code set for use when broader agreement has been reached that it is needed. More specifically, the Committee recommends the following: 1. Functional status information is integral to understanding health and should be included in patient records (computerized and otherwise) in the range of settings where care is provided. (The Committee is not recommending any particular functional status measures or instruments.) 2. Because of its importance for both health practice and such policy-related functions as quality assurance and monitoring progress toward Healthy People 2010 objectives, functional status information should be reported at appropriate intervals in standardized data sets, as well as in computerized patient records. 3. The concepts and conceptual framework of the ICF have promise as a code set for reporting functional status information in administrative records and computerized medical records. In the Committee’s view, the ICF is the only existing classification system that could be used to code functional status across the age span. 4. Before any recommendations are made about widespread implementation of the ICF in administrative records and computerized medical records, thorough work is needed by means of research, analysis, testing, and demonstration projects to examine issues such as the following: • the classification’s adequacy across the lifespan • where the gaps are in the testing of the ICF done to date • the feasibility of extracting functional status information from patient records in different settings • the training required for personnel • the time required to ascertain and code functional status information National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status • the cost of extracting functional status information • the appropriate interval at which to collect the information in medical records • the value of the resulting information • the reliability and validity of the information 14 5. Gaps in the availability of instruments for assessing functional status, appropriate to the population as well as the clinical context, should be identified and addressed. The lack of accepted tools for measuring the functional status of children is of particular concern. 6. Any special privacy issues surrounding collection and reporting of functional status information need continuing review. 7. Efforts should be made to increase awareness of functional status assessment and the ICF among policy makers, professional organizations, government organizations, researchers, and other relevant parties. 8. The Department of Health and Human Services is encouraged to take the lead in the activities recommended above. In addition, HHS should provide resources within the Department and to WHO to support work, nationally and internationally, on the classificationin particular, demonstration, testing, maintenance, and updating. 9. The designated standards maintenance organizations (DSMOs) should be alerted that NCVHS and the Department have a strong interest in the coding of functional status information in administrative records and computerized medical records. CONCLUSION There are many signs that agreement is emerging on the importance of functional status information for the optimal carrying out of clinical care, public health practice, policy, and administration. The next task is to find an effective way to get this information into standardized records, and to evaluate the ICF as a possible mechanism for that purpose. The National Committee urges the Department of Health and Human Services to exercise leadership in this effort and to give it the priority it deserves, in continued collaboration with the World Health Organization. The Committee would welcome annual status reports from the Department on this project, beginning in 2002. The standards community is encouraged to begin looking at this issue and possible solutions. Finally, the Committee offers its advice and enthusiastic support for all efforts aimed at enriching clinical and administrative data with functional status information. This report was written for NCVHS by Susan Baird Kanaan. National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 15 APPENDIX 1 References Anderson, E. M., D. L. Patrick, W. B. Carter, and J. A. Malmgren. “Comparing the Performance of Health Status Measures for Healthy Older Adults.” Journal of the American Geriatrics Society 43, no. 9 (1995): 1030-4. Bindman, A. B., D. Keane, and N. Lurie. “Measuring Health Changes Among Severely Ill Patients. The Floor Phenomenon.” Medical Care 28, no. 12 (1990): 1142-52. Calkins, D. R., L. V. Rubenstein, P. D. Cleary, A. R. Davies, A. M. Jette, A. Fink, J. Kosecoff, R. T. Young, R. H. Brook, and T. L. Delbanco. “Failure of Physicians to Recognize Functional Disability in Ambulatory Patients.” Annals of Internal Medicine 114, no. 6 (1991): 451-54. Heerkens, Y. F., C. D. Van Ravensberg and J. W. Brandsma. The Need for Revision of the ICIDH: an example – problems in gait. Disability and Rehabilitation, 1995 (17: 184-94). Iezzoni, L.I, Using Administrative Data to Study People with Disabilities, April 2001. Commissioned paper for the U.S. Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality. International Classification of Functioning, Disability and Health, ICF. Geneva: World Health Organization, 2001. International Classification of Functioning and Disability, ICIDH-2. Beta-2 draft, Full Version. Geneva: World Health Organization, 1999 MacFarlane, Alexander C. The International Classification of Impairments, Disabilities, and Handicaps: its usefulness in classifying and understanding biopsychosocial phenomena. Australian and New Zealand Journal of Psychiatry, 1988 (22:31-42). Mangione, C. M., R. S. Phillips, J. M. Seddon, M. G. Lawrence, E. F. Cook, R. Dailey, and L. Goldman. “Development of the `Activities of Daily Vision Scale’: A Measure of Visual Functional Status.” Medical Care 30, no. 12 (1992): 1111-26. McDowell, I., and C. Newell. Measuring Health: A Guide to Rating Scales and Questionnaires. New York: Oxford University Press, 1987. McHorney, C. A., J. E. Ware, Jr., J. F. Rachel Lu, and C. D. Sherbourne. “The MOS 36-Item Short-Form Health Survey (SF-36): III. Tests of Data Quality, Scaling Assumptions, and Reliability Across Diverse Patient Groups.” Medical Care 32, no. 1 (1994): 40-66. Pope, Andrew M. and Alvin R. Tarlov (eds.). Disability in America: Toward a National Agenda for Prevention. Institute of Medicine, National Academy Press, Washington, D.C., 1991. Rubenstein, L. V., D. R. Calkins, S. Greenfield, A. M. Jette, R. F. Meenan, M. A. Nevins, L. Z. Rubenstein, J. H. Wasson, and M. E. Williams. “Health Status Assessment for Elderly Patients: Report of the Society of General Internal Medicine Task Force on Health Assessment.” Journal of the American Geriatric Society 37, no. 6 (1988): 562-69. Simeonsson, Rune J., Lollar, Donald, Hollowell, Joseph, and Mike Adams. Revision of the International Classification of Impairments, Disabilities, and Handicaps: Developmental Issues. Journal of Clinical Epidemiology 53 (2000) 113-124. National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status 16 Stein, Ruth E.K., Westbrook, Lauren E., and Laurie J. Bauman. The Questionnaire for Identifying Children with Chronic Conditions: A Measure Based on a Noncategorical Approach. Pediatrics, 1997, Vol. 99, No. 4. 513-521 Stewart, A. L., J. E. Ware, Jr., and R. H. Brook. “Advances in the Measurement of Functional Status: Construction of Aggregate Indexes.” Medical Care 19, no. 5 (1981): 473-488. Stewart AL, Greenfield S, Hays RD, Wells K, Rogers WH, Berry SD, McGlynn EA, and Ware JE Jr. Functional status and well-being of patients with chronic conditions. Results from the Medical Outcomes Study. JAMA 1989;262:907-13. Stewart, A. L., and J. E. Ware, Jr., eds. Measuring Functioning and Well-Being: The Medical Outcomes Approach. Durham, NC: Duke University Press, 1992. Tilquin, C., P. Michelon, W. D’Hoore, C. Sicotte, E. Carillo and G. Leonard. Using the Handicap Code of the ICIDH for Classifying Patients by Intensity of Nursing Care Requirements. Disability and Rehabilitation, 1995. (17:176-83). Tinetti, M. E., T. F. Williams, and R. Mayewski. “Fall Risk Index for Elderly Patients Based on Number of Chronic Disabilities.” American Journal of Medicine 80, no. 3 (1986): 429-34. Ware, J. E., Jr. “Conceptualizing and Measuring Generic Health Outcomes.” Cancer 67, no. 3 (Suppl) (1991): 774-779. Weinberger, M., E. Z. Oddone, G. P. Samsa, and P. B. Landsman. “Are Health-Related Qualityof-Life Measures Affected by the Mode of Administration?” Journal of Clinical Epidemiology 49, no. 2 (1996): 135-140. Young, N. L., J. I. Williams, K. K. Yoshida, C. Bombardier, and J. G. Wright. “The Context of Measuring Disability: Does It Matter Whether Capability or Performance Is Measured?” Journal of Clinical Epidemiology 49, no. 10 (1996): 1097-101. http://www.who.int/icidh http://aspe.os.dhhs.gov/admnsimp National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status APPENDIX 2 Hearing Participants and Agendas JANUARY 24, 2000 (Chair: Lisa Iezzoni, M.D., M.S.) Overview of Functional Assessment and Health Status: Issue Identification Robert L. Kane, M.D., University of Minnesota William Braithwaite, M.D., ASPE Functional Assessment and Health Status: Lessons Learned Donald Lollar, Ed.D., CDC Nancy Whitelaw, Ph.D., National Council on the Aging Functional Assessment: Risk Adjustment and Rehabilitation Focus Gretchen Swanson, Ph.D., Western University of Health Sciences Dr. Jinnet Fowles, HealthSystem, Minnesota Dr. Margaret Stineman, University of Pennsylvania Functional Assessment: Selected Focus Areas Ruth Stein, M.D., Albert Einstein College of Medicine Dr. Alice Kroliczak, HRSA Dr. Sally Kaplan, Medicare Payment Advisory Commission APRIL 13, 2000 (Chair: Lisa Iezzoni, M.D., M.S.) Proxy, Disability, and ICIDH: Donald Lollar, Ed.D., CDC Michele Adler, SSA Overview of ICIDH Gerry Hendershot, Ph.D., NCHS Functional Assessment and ICIDH Margo Holm, University of Pittsburgh Rune Simeonsson, M.D., University of North Carolina Allan Meyers, Boston University NHIS: Functional Assessment Jennifer Madans, Ph.D., NCHS Else Pamuk, NCHS Recap of the Day and Discussion 17 National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics: Classifying and Reporting Functional Status JULY 17, 2000 (Chair: Lisa Iezzoni, M.D., M.S.) International Standards and Applications Michael Wolfson, Ph.D., Statistics Canada Jayne Lux, M.S., CCC/SLP, former World Health Organization Yerker Andersson, Ph.D., National Council on Disability ICIDH-2 Training and Testing Activities Gerry Hendershot, Ph.D., NCHS Paul Placek, Ph.D., NCHS Judy Hawley, P.T., Minnesota APTA Gloriajean Wallace, Ph.D., University of Cincinnati Considerations in Possible Uses of ICIDH-2 Nora Wells, MSED, Family Voices Robert Griss, Center on Disability and Health John Crews, DPA, CDC Raymond Seltser, M.D., M.P.H. University of Pittsburgh ICIDH-2 Revision and Applications T. Bedirhan Ustun, M.D., World Health Organization Logistical Considerations in Applications of ICIDH-2 Christopher McLaughlin, American Psychological Association Travis Threats, Ph.D., Saint Louis University Andrew Guccione, P.T., Ph.D., FAPTA American Physical Therapy Association Susy Stark, Ph.D., ORT/L Washington University School of Medicine (AOTA) Conceptual Clarity and Comparable Measures Alexander P. Ruggieri, M.D., Mayo Foundation Elena Andresen, Ph.D., Saint Louis University School of Public Health 18 APPENDIX J: GUIDELINES FOR GRADUATE STUDENTS REQUIREMENTS AND PROCEDURES FOR GRADUATE STUDY (M.A.) in SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY General Requirements 1. Admission to the School of Graduate Studies requires an application for admission, three letters of reference, and transcripts from all university or colleges previously attended. See the CWRU General Bulletin and the departmental website for procedures and further details. 2. Students are responsible for observing the University’s “Academic Regulations” for graduate study as printed in the CWRU General Bulletin, as well as the Department requirements and procedures as outlined in this document. Students have the right to petition in writing for exceptions to these regulations and requirements. In such cases students should consult their advisors. 3. Any deviations from Departmental graduate requirements (e.g., waiving COSI 497) need written approval from the advisor and the Department Chair. The student will petition in writing the requested change and secure the signatures of the advisor and the chair as documentation of approval. Master of Arts in Speech-Language Pathology 1. Program Objectives: The degree of Master of Arts in the Department of Communication Sciences requires that the student demonstrate: 1) knowledge of the basic anatomic/physiologic, physical/psychophysical, and linguistic/psycholinguistic processes involved in speech, language, and hearing, 2) comprehensive knowledge of disordered communication, 3) the ability to appropriately evaluate and establish treatment goals for persons with communication impairments, 4) appropriate intervention skills with children and adults with communication impairments, and 5) knowledge of research methodology employed in communication sciences and disorders 2. Advisors and Registration: a. Each student is assigned to an advisor upon entry into the program. After the orientation in the first semester and at the time of registration for each subsequent semester, the student must meet with the advisor. b. A student may request a change of advisor during the course of study. This change must be approved by the Department Chair. A “Change of Advisor” form is available in the Department Office. 3. Program of Study: a. Two plans of study are possible: Plan A-M.A. with a thesis based on individual research and a final oral examination. Plan B-M.A. without a thesis but requiring a comprehensive examination. b. Plan A: The M.A. Thesis The decision to undertake a thesis must be carefully weighed. Any student who intends to pursue a doctoral degree should consider Plan A. The student and the advisor must consider such factors as background, clinical needs, general resources, ability, and time constraints. Students selecting Plan A must take a minimum of six hours of thesis research (COSI 651). For further details concerning thesis requirements and procedures, consult the CWRU General Bulletin and the Department's Master’s Thesis Regulations, included at the end of this document. Plan A requires 30 hours of coursework plus 6 hours of thesis credit or 27 hours and 9 hours of thesis credit). This represents an additional nine semester hours of coursework beyond the minimum of twenty-seven semester hours set forth by the School of Graduate Studies. No more than 9 hours of thesis credit may count towards graduate credit for graduation. Once registered for thesis credit, the student must register for thesis credit in each succeeding regular semester until the thesis examination occurs. At least 30 semester hours of coursework, including thesis, must be at the 400 level or higher. The written thesis must conform to regulations concerning format, quality, and time of submission as established by the Dean of Graduate Studies. Detailed instructions can be obtained from the Office of Graduate Studies. For completion of the master’s degree under Plan A, an oral examination (defense) of the master’s thesis is required. This examination is conducted by a committee of at least three members of the University faculty. The candidate’s thesis adviser customarily serves as the chair of the examining committee. The other members of the committee are appointed by the Department Chair or curricular program faculty supervising the candidate’s course of study. c. Plan B: Requires 36 semester hours beyond the undergraduate degree. This represents an additional nine semester hours beyond the minimum of twenty-seven semester hours set forth by the School of Graduate Studies. At least 30 semester hours must be at the 400 level or higher. Each candidate for the master’s degree under Plan B must pass satisfactorily a comprehensive examination. The examination may be written or oral or both. A student must be registered during the semester in which any part of the comprehensive examination is taken. If not registered for other courses, the student will be required to register for one semester hour of EXAM 600, Comprehensive Examination, before taking the examination. d. The program of study the student pursues will be determined in part by the student's undergraduate background and his academic and career goals. The program of study must, however, include a minimum of four semesters (four credits) of COSI 452 (A, B, C, E, or D) GRADUATE PRACTICUM and COSI 497 METHODS OF RESEARCH. The latter requirement may be modified for students who enter the program with two or more research/statistics courses. The student should submit a petition in writing to the chair, with the approval of the advisor. e. As a program accredited by the Council on Academic Accreditation of the American SpeechLanguage-Hearing Association, Case's M.A. degree in speech-language pathology fulfills the academic requirements for the Certificate of Clinical Competence. ASHA requirements are detailed in the Requirements for the Certificate of Clinical Competence which is available on the ASHA website (www.asha.org). In addition, completion of the M.A. degree requirements meets some of the requirements for state licensure in Ohio. For the student desiring Ohio Teacher Licensure, the program of study must also meet the requirements for Ohio Teacher Licensure. f. Whereas deficiencies in background subject matter or skills will not prevent acceptance into the graduate program, students accepted under these circumstances will be required to make up deficiencies in a manner approved by the advisor and the Department Chair. Students entering without an undergraduate major in communication disorders will be required to take the essential undergraduate coursework in communication sciences and disorders (up to 18 hours of coursework). Students entering with an undergraduate major in communication disorders, but with deficiencies in their undergraduate program, will be required to make up the appropriate coursework. When a student is required to take courses at the undergraduate level, credits earned at the 300 level or below may not apply toward the 36 hours required under either Plan A or Plan B as described in this document. g. During the first semester of study, each student will, in consultation with his/her advisor, prepare a plan of study that will be used as the guideline for subsequent registration. Students will not be permitted to register for subsequent semesters until the proposed program has been approved by the advisor and Department Chair. Any changes made to the plan of study will require a resubmission of the corrected document to the advisor, department chair and student file. The final plan of study is submitted to the graduate school in the semester of graduation. 4. Academic Progression a. University Standards for the Maintenance of Good Standing (General Bulletin 1998-2000) A student will be subject to separation from the university for any of the following reasons. 1) Failure to achieve a quality-point average of 2.5 or higher at the completion of 12 semester hours or 2 semesters of graduate study. 2) Failure to achieve a quality-average of 2.75 or higher at the completion of 21 semester hours or 4 semesters of graduate study. 3) Failure to receive a grade of S in thesis research 651 or dissertation research. A student who receives a grade of U in thesis or dissertation research will be placed on probation and be subject to separation. The probationary status will be recorded on the student's transcript. The student must be removed from probation by the end of the semester immediately following receipt of the grade of U by repeating the course for the same number of credit hours, and achieving a grade of S. Although removal from probation restores the student's good standing, the grade of U received will not be canceled or substituted by the grade of S subsequently received. Separation will occur if the student placed on probation receives another grade of U in the following semester; or, if the Dean of Graduate Studies, in consultation with the academic unit, determines that the student is unlikely to be successful in working independently and productively toward the completion of the thesis or dissertation research. 4) Failure of a provisionally admitted student to satisfy the provisions stated in the letter of acceptance by the end of the first academic year (2 semesters) or after 18 credits of coursework. 5) Failure to make progress towards degree completion. If the student is not making progress towards degree completion, and it has been judged that the student is unlikely to be successful in working independently and productively toward the completion of the thesis, the department and/or the Dean of Graduate Studies (in consultation with the department) can recommend academic separation. 6) In addition to disciplinary actions based on academic standards, on recommendation of the student's department or school, the Dean of Graduate Studies can suspend or separate a student from the university for failure to maintain appropriate standards of conduct and integrity. Such a suspension or separation will be implemented only for serious breaches of conduct that threaten to compromise the standards of a department or create concern for the safety and welfare of others. In the event of such suspension or separation, the student will be entitled to an appeal through the grievance procedure of the Graduate School. b.University Standards for the Maintenance of Quality Point Average (General Bulletin 19982000): In calculating the quality-point average, courses taken as a student in the School of Graduate Studies at the 400 level and above, as well as any courses accepted toward fulfillment of degree requirements for which quality points are given, will be counted, including courses which may need to be repeated. Unless otherwise stated by the department a minimum cumulative quality-point average of 2.75 is required for the award of the Master's degree. Any department, school, or curricular program committee may choose to establish quality standards higher than those stated above if such additional requirements are made known in writing to the students upon matriculation, and are recorded with the Dean of Graduate Studies. In that case, the departmental standards supersede the minimum standards. c. Departmental Standards for Good Standing and Quality-Point Average to Supercede Above: For item 4.a.1 and 4.a.2 above, departmental standards read: (1) Failure to achieve a quality-point average of 3.0 or higher at the completion of 12 semester hours or 2 semesters of graduate study will result in separation from the university. Students must maintain a 3.0 quality-point average during succeeding semesters of enrollment. If a student’s quality-point average falls below a 3.0 in any succeeding semester, the student will be separated from the university. For item 4.b. above, departmental standards read: Only 400 level courses and above or lower level courses approved to meet the M.A. semester hours requirement will be used to calculate the quality-point average. 5. Clinical Requirements in Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology: a. The M.A. degree program is designed to provide the student with clinical experience to meet the practicum requirements for American Speech-Language-Hearing Association Certificate of Clinical Competence, state licensure, and teacher licensure. The Coordinator of Clinical Education works with each student in designing an appropriate semester-by-semester clinical program. It is the student’s responsibility to maintain contact with the Coordinator of Clinical Education to implement this program. Students must maintain a grade point average of 3.0 or greater to participate in clinical practicum. b. The M.A. in speech-language pathology reflects clinical as well as academic competence. The Department reserves the right to place a student on clinical probation or discontinue the student’s clinical practicum if clinical performance is judged as unacceptable. Students whose clinical performance is not acceptable will not be permitted to continue in clinical practicum. Appropriate notation of this will be entered on the student’s records and cited on any recommendation required from the Department. c. Further information concerning clinical requirements and procedures is detailed in the Department’s Clinical Handbook. 6. Comprehensive Examinations: a. Students who choose Plan B (non-thesis option) are required to take a comprehensive examination. b. Written comprehensive examinations are administered to assess the student’s mastery of the field of speech-language pathology and audiology. The written examination may be followed by a one-hour oral examination in the weeks after the written examination. c. Written comprehensive examination dates are scheduled and posted by the Department during the fall and spring semesters. At least two weeks prior to the scheduled date, the student must petition to take the examination. The form for this petition is available in the Department Office. The petition must be approved by the advisor and Department Chair. d. The written comprehensive exam is a departmental exam and the content encompasses all aspects of the field of study. Written comprehensive exams are not individualized or limited to a student’s plan of study. e. Written answers will be graded by the faculty. Written feedback is generated and distributed to all students participating in comprehensive exams that semester. Grades are given for each question based on the following criteria: A (4.0)= Addresses critical aspects of the question. Shows clear understanding of the question and topic. B (3.0)= Demonstrates understanding of key concepts. Not all supporting information is included. C (2.0)= Demonstrates understanding of some key concepts. Lacks information or includes incorrect information. F (0.0)= Unacceptable. Failure to address the question. Seriously deficient in content. (1) To pass the written comprehensive exam a student must have a 3.0 average across all questions, with no F grades from any reviewer. (2) If a student does not meet the requirement in (1), he or she must develop a written remediation plan, which must be approved by the Department Chair. The student and advisor will meet to develop the plan. (3) If the student fails two (2) written questions (receives an average grade of F for those questions), the remediation plan will include a re-write of the entire comprehensive examination within the same semester or the following semester. If the student does not fail two (2) written questions, but fails to achieve a 3.0 average, the remediation plan will include a re-writing effort that may include multiple questions. (4) Re-written questions will be re-graded. The student's final examination grade will be calculated from the re-written questions and the initial attempt on all questions that were not re-written. (5) If a student fails to achieve a 3.0 average on the written comprehensive examination after rewriting, he or she will be required to complete an oral examination in addition to other elements of the remediation plan developed by his or her advisor and the Department Chair. (6) The oral examination will take place the same semester as the written comprehensive examination or the following semester. The oral examining committee will be composed of the student's advisor and two other faculty members. (7) If the student fails to meet the requirements of the remediation plan, including passing the oral examination, he or she will be separated from the University. 7. Application for the Degree: An application for the degree must be filed with the Dean of Graduate Studies no less than two months before the desired commencement date. Application forms are available in the Office of the Dean of Graduate Studies. MASTER’S DEGREE IN SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY: SEQUENCE OF COURSES Minimum number of credits required for the degree is 36 credit hours. All students are required to take COSI 497: Methods of Research and 4 credit hours of COSI 452: Graduate Clinical Practicum. Students typically take three 3-credit hour courses per semester and 1 credit hour of COSI 452: Graduate Clinical Practicum (10 hours total). Coursework is chosen in consultation with the student’s academic advisor. Second Year First Year Fall Semester* COSI 405 Neuroscience of Communication and Communication Disorders (3) COSI 452 Graduate Clinical Practicum (1) COSI 453 Articulation & Phonology Disorders (3) COSI 497 Research Methods (3) **Based on the student’s undergraduate record, the following courses may be suggested: COSI 211 Phonetics and Phonology (3) COSI 325 Anatomy & Physiology of Speech and Hearing (3) COSI 352 Introduction to Clinical Practice (3) COSI 413 Language Development (3) COSI 470 Introduction to Audiology (3) Spring Semester** COSI 452 Graduate Clinical Practicum (1) COSI 456 Child Language Disorders (3) COSI 557 Acquired Adult Language & Cognitive Disorders (3) COSI 561 Medical Aspects II: Neuromotor & Craniofacial Anomolies (3) COSI 562 Medical Aspects III: Dysphagia (2)| *Based on the student’s undergraduate record, the following course may be suggested: COSI 321 Speech and Hearing Sciences (3) Summer Semester COSI 452 Graduate Clinical Practicum (1) COSI 455 Fluency Disorders (3) COSI 600 Special Topics: Augmentative & Alternative Communication (3) OR COSI 600 Special Topics: Intervention & Assessment: Birth-3 (3) Fall Semester COSI 452 COSI 463 (3) COSI 464 COSI 560 Graduate Clinical Practicum (1) Speech & Language Therapy in Educational Settings Diagnosis of Speech & Language Disorders (3) Medical Aspects I: Voice Disorders (3) Spring Semester COSI 452 Graduate Clinical Practicum (1) COSI 580 Aural Rehabilitation (3) MASTER’S THESIS REGULATIONS Plan A For Master's Plan A, the student must complete either 6 credit hours of thesis research (COSI 651), and 30 semester hours of additional coursework at the 400 level or higher, or, alternatively, 9 credit hours of thesis research and 27 semester hours of coursework at the 400-level or higher. The student’s advisor, in consultation with the student and with the approval of the graduate committee of the department will form a thesis committee. The thesis committee will consist of at least three faculty members from the department, at least one of whom must be a member of the regular faculty as defined by the College of Arts and Sciences. The student must submit a written plan for the thesis to this committee, for its approval prior to initiating the research. This plan should include a brief literature review and rationale for the study, a proposed research method, a proposed timeline for steps involved in the research, and a brief discussion of expected results and their potential significance. The student will present the thesis information in two forums: 1) an informal discussion with peers and members of his/her committee prior to initiating the thesis research, to obtain feedback and direction; and 2) a formal presentation of the thesis research to faculty and students. The precise format of the formal presentation will depend on the nature of the research (e.g., oral presentations, computer demonstrations of software, etc.). The presentation may be a work-in-progress colloquium to report preliminary findings and generate discussion, or may be a presentation of final results. If the formal presentation is a presentation of final results, it may serve as the public oral presentation of the thesis defense (see below). The student must prepare a thesis describing the research and its significance and submit to an oral defense of the thesis. This will include a brief (approximately 20 minute) public oral presentation, followed by examination by the committee. The examination will be open to all members of the faculty but will be otherwise closed. Only members of the thesis committee will vote on whether the thesis and its defense satisfy the requirements of the Department and the School o f Graduate Studies for the M.A. degree. If the student presents a colloquium at the conclusion of his/her research, this may serve as the oral presentation component of the defense. The student must submit an Application to Graduate to the School of Graduate Studies in the semester in which he or she plans to graduate, and file two copies of the thesis according to the dates and guidelines of the School of Graduate Studies. GUIDE FOR GRADUATE STUDENT ADVISING Student: _________ _______________ Advisor: _______ ____ FIRST SEMESTER Initial advising meeting with student Date: __________ _____ a. Review transcript with student. Identify ASHA requirements which have been met and ASHA requirements which will need to be met during grad program (complete Part I of Academic Advising Worksheet) _____ b. Talk to the student about the thesis/nonthesis option _____ c. Identify courses student should be enrolled in for first semester and complete course registration form with student Second advising meeting with student (after midterm) Date: ___________ _____ a. Meet with student to check on how they are doing in current coursework _____ b. Map out sequence of coursework for graduate program with student (Part II of the Academic Advising Worksheet) _____ c. Advisor files copy of Academic Advising Worksheet in student’s permanent file _____ d. Advise student on courses for 2nd semester and complete/sign registration form _____ e. Discuss the purpose of the Plan of Study and refer student to the plan of study examples in graduate student manual. Tell student to complete the plan of study by the first week of second semester. NOTES: SECOND SEMESTER Creating the Plan of Study _____ a. Review rough draft of Plan of Study completed by student. Check to be sure that courses are placed under the appropriate category, that course numbers and titles are listed as they appear on transcripts, and that student meets all minimal requirements set by ASHA and CWRU _____ b. Do a final check on plan of study, sign it, and turn in to department chair for final review. _____ c. Department Chair reviews plan and either approves it or sends it back to the advisor for modification Filing the Plan of Study _____ a. When department Chair approves Plan, it is given to the Department Assistant _____ b. Department Assistant will make copies of the Plan of Study and will distribute them to the following: student; advisor; student file; and the graduate school _____ c. Advisor checks to ensure that Plan of Study has been filed. Date: ________ Academic advising _____ a. Ensure that student knows options for summer courses _____ b. Check on status of completing ASHA requirements (i.e., math, UG leveling) _____ c. Check on student’s performance after midterms _____ d. At end of semester review courses recommended for third semester & sign registration form. Preparation for comprehensive exams (does not apply to student’s doing thesis) _____ a. Talk to student about organizing class notes/references into subject areas in preparation for comprehensive exam process _____ b. Discuss timeline of comprehensive examination and begin addressing strategies that need to be acquired by the student to maximize their effectiveness in comps. Preparation for thesis (does not apply to students doing comps) _____ a. Faculty member agrees to be chair of student’s thesis. _____ b. Student identifies a potential topic area and begins to review literature and develop possible question, and procedures under guidance of faculty member. _____ c. Timeline for completion of project reviewed between thesis advisor and student. _____ d. Faculty expectations defined (e.g., publication; student independence) NOTES: THIRD SEMESTER Academic Advising _____ a. Sign registration for third semester enrollment or distribute PIN #. _____ b. Check on status of student performance after midterms _____ c. At end of semester, review courses recommended for fourth semester and sign registration form. _____ d. Final check by advisor to insure that all COSI and ASHA academic requirements will be met within expected time frame. Comprehensive examination preparation Date: ______________ _____ a. Describe comprehensive examination process including the following: ______ 1. Purpose of the comprehensive examination process ______ 2. Written comprehensive exam format ______ 3. Discuss performance expectations on comps ______ 5. Recommended strategies for studying for comprehensive exams ______ 6. Discuss timeline for doing comps (consider student’s courseload, time for preparing for comps; strengths/weaknesses in completing comp format questions) ______ 7. Complete practice questions and obtain feedback from faculty member on practice questions Thesis _____ a. Thesis committee identified and agreed upon (by members) _____ b. Thesis prospectus prepared and given to committee members _____ c. Prospectus meeting held and input provided _____ d. Prospectus procedures approved by the committee _____ e. Human Subjects Approval form submitted (may be done before prospectus meeting if approved by advisor) _____ f. Data collection NOTES: FOURTH SEMESTER File Check _____ a. Department Assistant reviews student’s folder to ensure that all paperwork for academic requirements is documented in permanent file and organized correctly (see check sheet in front of student’s file). _____ b. Student is notified in writing of any deficiencies in the file with a copy of the notification placed in student’s file. Pre-requisite to comprehensive examination _____ a. Student completes “Request for Examination” form and brings to advisor to sign. _____ b. Student files paperwork with graduate office. _____ c. Student reminded to meet with the Coordinator of Clinical Education to ensure that all clinical requirements will be met. Comprehensive examination _____ a. Student completes written examination. _____ b. Department Assistant distributes copies to exam graders. _____ c. Within one week, exams are graded and general feedback is distributed. _____ d. Advisor meets with student to convey written exam results and recommendations. Thesis _____ a. Data analysis completed and checked by thesis chair _____ b. Student submits written drafts to thesis chair for approval _____ c. When thesis is approved by advisor, submits copies to committee members. _____ d. Date set for oral defense of thesis _____ e. Oral defense held _____ 1. Student brings yellow cards to meeting _____ 2. Department Assistant gives advisor the Request for Exam form _____ 3 . When final form of thesis is approved by committee members, paperwork is signed and returned to the office manager by the thesis advisor. _____ 4. Department Assistant files paperwork in student file and with graduate office _____ f. Student provides department with copy of approved thesis _____ g. Student submits appropriate paperwork/thesis to graduate school NOTES: FINAL CHECK-OUT PROCEDURES Students should make an appointment to complete checks with Coordinator of Clinical Education. Students should allow 10 working days for completion of all paperwork items within the COSI department. ______ 1. Completes final check on clinic hours with Coordinator of Clinical Education ______ 2. Makes at least two copies of clinic hours to be retained by the student after Department chair re-checks and signs hours ______ 3. Department Assistant notarizes final copies of hour sheets (originals retained in COSI file; student takes 2 copies) ______ 4. Coordinator of Clinical Education completes clinical sections of ASHA checklist ______ 5. Office Manager does final check on student’s permanent file to ensure that it is complete. Date: ________________ ______ 6. Chair of Department completes ASHA paperwork documenting student’s completion of ASHA requirements for CFY application (and licensure, if appropriate). MASTER OF ARTS IN SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY: ASHA CERTIFICATION WORKSHEET Name Advisor Dated 75 semester credit hours in Academic Coursework-MINIMUM* 27 semester credits-BASIC SCIENCE COURSEWORK-MIN* 36 semester credits-PROFESSIONAL COURSEWORK-MIN* 30 semester cr-Graduate 21 semester cr-Professional Area 6 credits Biological/ Physical Sciences: 1 course Math: 1 course 6 credits Behavioral and/or Social Sciences COSI 109 Introduction to Communication Disorders (3) F/S COSI 220 Introduction to American Sign Language I (3) F/S COSI 260 Multicultural Aspects of Human Communication (3) F 15 credits Basic Communication Processes Linguistic & Physical Anatomic Psycholinguistic PsychoPhysiologic Physical 1 course in each area-minimum COSI 211 COSI 321 COSI 405 Phonetics & Speech & Neuroscience of Phonology (3) F Hearing Communication Science (3) S Disorders (3) F COSI 313 Language Development (3) F 6 credits Audiology 3 credits 3 credits Hearing Habilitation & Disorders & Rehabilitation Evaluation Procedures COSI 3/470 Introduction to Audiology (3) F COSI 580 Aural Rehabilitation (3) S 6 credits Language Disorders 6 credits Speech Disorders COSI 445 Communication & Aging (3) S COSI 453 Articulation & Phonology (3) F COSI 456 Child Language Disorders (3) S COSI 455 Fluency Disorders (3) Su COSI 464 Case Studies: Diagnosis & Treatment (3) F COSI 560 Neuromotor & Craniofacial Anomolies (3) S COSI 557 Acquired Adult Language Disorders (3) S COSI 600 Intervention & Assessment Birth-3 (1-3) Su COSI 561 Voice Disorders (3) F COSI 562 Dysphagia (2) S COSI 600 Augmentative & Alternative Comm (1-3) Su * A MINIMUM of 6 semester credits of practicum may be applied to the 36 semester credits MINIMUM Professional Coursework, but PRACTICUM MAY NOT BE USED TO SATISFY minimum requirements in AUDIOLOGY or LANGUAGE or SPEECH OTHER: COSI 352 Introduction to Clinical Practice (3) F COSI 463 SLP in Educational Settings (3) F COSI 600 Counseling (1) Su COSI 452 Graduate Clinical Practicum A-E (1) F/S/Su COSI 497 Methods of Research (3) F KNOWLEDGE AND SKILLS ACQUISITION (KASA) SUMMARY FORM FOR CERTIFICATION IN SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY Knowledge and Skills Acquisition (KASA) Summary Form For Certification in Speech-Language Pathology March, 2003 KNOWLEDGE AND SKILLS ACQUISITION (KASA) SUMMARY FORM FOR SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY Instructions for Use The Knowledge and Skills Acquisition (KASA) form summarizes a student's acquisition of the knowledge and skills delineated in the Standards for the Certificate of Clinical Competence (SCCC). Entries are made only upon acquisition of the knowledge or skill; thus the KASA is not an evaluation, but only a record that a particular knowledge or skill has been acquired. Required Documentation 1. Students from CAA-accredited programs (Refer to "Automatic Approval" language in Standard I. Degree) must submit the "Verification by Program Director" page of the KASA when applying for certification. 2. All other applicants must submit the entire, completed document, including the "Verification by Program Director" page when applying for certification. Use of the KASA Form 1. The CFCC encourages programs to use the KASA to demonstrate compliance with accreditation standards related to preparing students to meet ASHA certification requirements. However, programs may develop other documents to verify student's acquisition of knowledge and skills. 2. For students who must submit the entire KASA, and for academic programs wishing to use the KASA as a tracking document, indicate with a check mark in Column B whether each knowledge and skill was achieved. If a particular knowledge or skill was acquired through work completed in a specific course or courses, the title and number of the course(s) should be entered in Column C. If the knowledge or skills were acquired in clinical practicum, enter the title and number of the practicum in Column D. If the knowledge or skill was acquired through course work and/or clinical practicum, and/or lab or research activities, there should be entries in all of the applicable columns: C, D, and/or E. 3. Students and programs using the KASA are advised to keep a copy in a safe place, should they need to provide information to the Council For Clinical Certification at a later date (e.g., upon application for reinstatement). 4. CFCC encourages programs and students to periodically review the KASA (or other tracking documents developed by the program) to assist students in determining knowledge and skills already acquired and those yet to be attained. Knowledge And Skills Acquisition (KASA) Summary Form For Certification in Speech-Language Pathology The KASA form is intended for use by the certification applicant during the graduate program to track the processes by which the knowledge and skills specified in the 2005 Standards for the CCC are being acquired. Each student should review the KASA form at the beginning of graduate study, and update it at intervals throughout the graduate program and at the conclusion of the program. The student, with input and monitoring of program faculty, must enter a check mark in column B as each of the knowledge and skills is acquired. It is expected that many entries will appear in the course work and the clinical practicum columns, with some entries, as appropriate, in the "Other" (lab, research, etc.) columns. Please enter the course or practicum number and title and description of other applicable activity. I. KNOWLEDGE AREAS A Standards Standard III-A. The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of the principles of: ● Biological sciences ● Physical sciences ● Mathematics ● Social/Behavioral sciences Standard III-B. The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of basic human communication and swallowing processes, including their biological, neurological, acoustic, psychological, developmental, and linguistic and cultural bases ● Basic Human Communication Processes ● Biological ● Neurological B C How Achieved? D Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title 3 January, 2003 E Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) A Standards ● Acoustic ● Psychological ● Developmental/Lifespan ● Linguistic ● Cultural ● Swallowing Processes ● Biological ● Neurological ● Acoustic ● Psychological ● Developmental/Lifespan ● Linguistic ● Cultural B Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) Standard III-C. The applicant must demonstrate knowledge of the nature of speech, language, hearing, and communication disorders and differences and swallowing disorders, including their etiologies, characteristics, anatomical/physiological, acoustic, psychological, developmental, and linguistic and cultural correlates. Specific knowledge must be demonstrated in the following areas: Articulation ● Etiologies ● Characteristics Fluency ● Etiologies ● Characteristics 4 January, 2003 A Standards Voice and resonance, including respiration and phonation ● Etiologies ● Characteristics B Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) Receptive and expressive language (phonology, morphology, syntax, semantics, and pragmatics) in speaking, listening, reading, writing, and manual modalities ● Etiologies ● Characteristics Hearing, including the impact on speech and language ● Etiologies ● Characteristics Swallowing (oral, pharyngeal, esophageal, and related functions, including oral function for feeding; orofacial myofunction) ● Etiologies ● Characteristics Cognitive aspects of communication (attention, memory, sequencing, problem-solving, executive functioning ● Etiologies ● Characteristics 5 January, 2003 A B Standards Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) Social aspects of communication (challenging behavior, ineffective social skills, lack of communication opportunities) ● Etiologies ● Characteristics Communication modalities (including oral, manual, augmentative and alternative communication techniques, and assistive technologies) ● Characteristics Standard III-D: The applicant must possess knowledge of the principles and methods of prevention, assessment, and intervention for people with communication and swallowing disorders, including consideration of anatomical/physiological, psychological, developmental, and linguistic and cultural correlates of the disorders. Articulation ● Prevention ● Assessment ● Intervention Fluency ● Prevention ● Assessment 6 January, 2003 A B Standards Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) ● Intervention Voice and Resonance ● Prevention ● Assessment ● Intervention Receptive and Expressive Language ● Prevention ● Assessment ● Intervention Hearing, including the impact on speech and language ● Prevention ● Assessment ● Intervention Swallowing ● Prevention ● Assessment ● Intervention Cognitive aspects of communication ● Prevention ● Assessment ● Intervention Social aspects of communication ● Prevention ● Assessment 7 January, 2003 A B Standards Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) ● Intervention Communication Modalities ● (Prevention not applicable) ● Assessment ● Intervention Standard IV-G: The applicant for certification must complete a program of study that includes supervised clinical experiences sufficient in breadth and depth to achieve the following skills outcomes (in addition to clinical experiences, skills may be demonstrated through successful performance on academic course work and examinations, independent projects, or other appropriate alternative methods): 1. Evaluation (must include all skill outcomes listed in a-g below for each of the 9 major areas) a. Conduct screening and prevention procedures (including prevention activities) b. Collect case history information and integrate information from clients/patients, family, caregivers, teachers, relevant others, and other professionals 8 January, 2003 A B Standards Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) c. Select and administer appropriate evaluation procedures, such as behavioral observations nonstandardized and standardized tests, and instrumental procedures d. Adapt evaluation procedures to meet client/patient needs e. Interpret, integrate, and synthesize all information to develop diagnoses and make appropriate recommendations for intervention f. Complete administrative and reporting functions necessary to support evaluation g. Refer clients/patients for appropriate services ● Articulation ● Fluency ● Voice and resonance, including respiration and phonation ● Receptive and expressive language (phonology, morphology, syntax, semantics, and pragmatics) in speaking, listening, reading, writing, and manual modalities ● Hearing, including the impact on speech and language ● Swallowing (oral, pharyngeal, esophageal, and related functions, including oral function for feeding; orofacial myofunction) 9 January, 2003 A B Standards Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) ● Cognitive aspects of communication (attention, memory, sequencing, problem-solving, executive functioning) ● Social aspects of communication (including challenging behavior, ineffective social skills, lack of communication opportunities) ● Communication modalities (including oral, manual, augmentative, and alternative communication techniques and assistive technologies) 2. Intervention (must include all skill outcomes listed in a-g below for each of the 9 major areas) a. Develop setting-appropriate intervention plans with measurable and achievable goals that meet clients'/patients' needs. Collaborate with clients/patients and relevant others in the planning process b. Implement intervention plans (involve clients/patients and relevant others in the intervention process) c. Select or develop and use appropriate materials and instrumentation for prevention and intervention d. Measure and evaluate clients'/patients' performance and progress 10 January, 2003 A Standards e. Modify intervention plans, strategies, materials, or instrumentation as appropriate to meet the needs of clients/patients f. Complete administrative and reporting functions necessary to support intervention B Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) g. Identify and refer clients/patients for services as appropriate ● Articulation ● Fluency ● Voice and resonance ● Receptive and expressive language ● Hearing, including the impact on speech and language ● Swallowing ● Cognitive aspects of communication ● Social aspects of communication ● Communication modalities 3. Interaction and Personal Qualities a. Communicate effectively, recognizing the needs, values, preferred mode of communication, and cultural/linguistic background of the client/patient, family, caregivers, and relevant others. b. Collaborate with other professionals in case management. 11 January, 2003 A Standards c. Provide counseling regarding communication and swallowing disorders to clients/patients, family, caregivers, and relevant others. d. Adhere to the ASHA Code of Ethics and behave professionally. B Knowledge/ Skill Met? (check ) C How Achieved? D E Course # and Title Practicum Experiences # and Title Other (e.g. labs, research) (Include description of activity) 12 January, 2003 Knowledge and Skills Acquisition (KASA) Summary Form For Certification in Speech-Language Pathology Verification by Program Director The applicant for certification: Has a master's or doctoral degree. A minimum of 75 semester credit hours were completed in a course of study addressing the □ Yes □ No knowledge and skills pertinent to the field of speech-language pathology (Std. I) Initiated and completed all graduate course work and graduate clinical practicum in an institution whose program was accredited by the CAA (Std. I) □ Yes □ No □ Yes □ No □ Yes □ No □ □ □ □ □ □ □ □ □ □ Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No No No □ Yes □ Yes □ No □ No □ Yes □ Yes □ No □ No □ Yes □ No □ Yes □ No Has completed a program of study (a minimum of 75 semester credit hours overall, including at least 36 at the graduate level) that includes academic course work sufficient in depth and breadth to achieve the specified knowledge outcomes (Std. III-A,B,C) Possesses knoweldge of the principles and methods of prevention, assessment and intervention for people with communication and swallowing disorders (Std. III-D) Has demonstrated knowledge of standards of ethical conduct (Std. III-E) Has knowledge of processes used in research and the integration of research principles into evidence-based clinical practice (Std. Has demonstrated knowledge of contemporary professional issues (Std. III-G) Has demonstrated knowledge about certification, specialty recognition, licensure, and other relevant professional credentials Has completed a curriculum of academic and clinical education that follows an appropriate sequence of learning sufficient to achieve the skills outcomes in Standard IV-G (Std. IV-A) Possesses skill in oral and written and other forms of communication sufficient for entry into professional practice (Std. IV-B) Has completed a minimum of 400 clock hours of supervised clinical experience in the practice of speech-language pathology, including 25 hours in clinical observation and 375 hours in direct client/patient contact (Std. IV-C) Has completed at least 325 clock hours while engaged in graduate study (Std. IV-D) Has been supervised by individuals holding a current ASHA Certificate of Clinical Competence in the appropriate area of practice. The amount of supervision was appropriate to the student's level of knowledge, experience, and competence and the supervision was sufficient to ensure the welfare of the client/patient populations (Std. IV-E) Has gained knowledge of and experience with individuals from culturally/linguistically diverse backgrounds and with client/patient populations across the life span (Std. IV-F) The applicant has met the education program's requirements for demonstrating satisfactory performance through ongoing formative assessment of knowledge and skills. (Std. V-A) The program director verifies that the student met each standard and has successfully met the education program's requirements for demonstrating satisfactory performance through ongoing assessment of knowledge and skills. _____________________________________________________ Name _____________________________________________________ Title _____________________________________________________ Signature _____________________________________________________ Program ___________________________________ Date 11 January, 2003 STEPS TOWARD CERTIFICATION, AND LICENSURE I. ASHA CERTIFICATION: Obtain Certification and Membership application forms from the ASHA website: http://www.asha.org/about/membership-certification/handbooks/slp/default.htm. II. OHIO License: Obtain Ohio Board of Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology application for licensure from website: http://slpaud.ohio.gov/ Upon Completion of Comprehensive Exams and coursework: 1. Complete final course and practicum requirements. Make sure you have signatures from ALL of your supervisors and their license numbers. Once you have completed your coursework, final practicum, and have all of the required signatures, neatly hand-write or type a new copy of your Ohio Board hours sheet. Do Not Total the Columns. Make 3 photocopies of this new sheet. 2. Make an appointment to meet with Coordinator of Clinical Education for a final check on practicum requirements. This meeting should be held 1-2 weeks prior to the deadline for submitting application materials to the Ohio Board. The Ohio Board reviews applications on the 1st and 15th of every month. All application materials must be received 5 business days prior to the review date. 3. After meeting with the Coordinator of Clinical Education, your clinical hours sheets will be forwarded to the Department Assistant for signature and notarization. She will notify you when they are available for pick-up. THE DEPARTMENT UNDERSTANDS THAT YOU ARE EAGER TO BEGIN YOUR PROFESSIONAL CAREER, HOWEVER, IT IS YOUR RESPONSIBILITY TO MAKE SURE THAT YOU HAVE ALL APPLICATION MATERIALS TOGETHER AND SUBMITTED TO THE APPROPRIATE PEOPLE IN A TIMELY MANNER. NO EXCEPTIONS! INSTRUCTION FOR OBTAINING AND MAINTAINING ASHA CERTIFICATION The Certificates of Clinical Competence in Speech-Language Pathology (CCC-SLP) and Audiology (CCCA) are awarded by ASHA's Council For Clinical Certification (CFCC) to applicants who hold a graduate degree and who have successfully completed (a) all academic course work and clinical practicum, (b) a clinical fellowship, and (c) the national examination in the area in which certification is sought, as specified in the Standards and Implementation Procedures for the Certificates of Clinical Competence (SCCC) in Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology (see Section III of this Handbook). The applicant must submit an application completed as specified, the appropriate dues and fees, and the supporting documents required for processing the application. Maintaining the CCC-SLP is contingent upon the timely payment of annual dues and fees, and beginning in January 1, 2005, completion of 30 contact hours of continuing professional development. Individuals who are in the certification process, hold the CCC, and/or are members of the Association must abide by ASHA's Code of Ethics. All applicants for certification must meet the currently published standards, policies, and procedures. STEPS FOR OBTAINING AND MAINTAINING THE CERTIFICATES OF CLINICAL COMPETENCE 1. Application Materials. Submit to the ASHA Certification office one complete packet including the following: a properly completed and signed application verification of receipt of graduate degree (Individuals should not submit the application until the graduate degree has been awarded. Those individuals who graduate from a program that has only one graduation per year may apply before receipt of the degree if all graduate course work and graduate level practicum have been completed.) course descriptions or transcripts, if required appropriate payment, by either check or charge (VISA or MasterCard only). [See the "Schedule of Required Dues and Fees,"] No individual documents should be submitted to the ASHA Certification office before submission of the application for certification. Items received before receipt of the application will be returned to the sender. Please note that individuals who wish to be certified in both audiology and speech-language pathology must meet the standards and requirements in both professional areas. 2. Clinical Fellowship (CF) Experience. After verifying that you meet the requirements for state licensure (see "State Licensure/Regulatory Requirements" in Section IV. Clinical Fellowship: Requirements and Procedures), begin the clinical fellowship experience. Both the fellow and the supervisor are responsible for verifying that the supervisor's certification remains valid throughout the entire clinical fellowship period. (For more information about verifying supervisors' certification, see "Clinical Fellows".) 3. Clinical Fellowship Evaluations and Observations. During the CF experience, the clinical fellowship supervisor must complete (a) at least three formal evaluations of the clinical performance using the CFSISLP, and (b) at least 18 on-site observations, 6 per segment, and 18 other monitoring activities, 6 per segment (see Section IV. Clinical Fellowship: Requirements and Procedures for specific information.) 4. Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form. At the completion of the CF experience, the clinical fellowship supervisor must complete and submit the Clinical Fellowship Report and Rating Form (Form D) to the CFCC within 4 weeks of the date the clinical fellowship is completed. Both the supervisor and fellow must sign the report and rating form. 5. Examination. Obtain a passing score on the national examination. Exam results must be sent directly from the Educational Testing Service (ETS) in order to be applicable toward certification. When you register to take the exam, request that your score be reported directly to ASHA. ETS charges an additional fee to report scores after the examination has been taken. To assist the National Office in processing your examination information, it will be helpful if you submit a copy of the report sent to you by the testing service when you submit your application for certification. However, please note that this copy will not be used as official verification of completion of the examination requirement. 6. Certificate. Once certification has been awarded, ordering the certificate is optional. If one is desired, complete and return the certificate order form sent to you with your notification. The certificate will be sent approximately 8 weeks after the certificate order is received in the ASHA National Office. 7. Renew Certification and Membership. Pay annual dues and fees when the annual invoice is received. Maintenance of certification and/or membership is contingent upon the timely payment of annual dues and fees and, beginning January 1, 2005, completion of 30 contact hours of continuing professional development activities. (See ASHA's Certification section for specific information.) Application Instructions "Pass-Through" Applicants You will be considered a "pass-through" applicant if you initiated and completed your graduate education at a program accredited by the Council on Academic Accreditation (CAA). Such applicants are not required to complete the entire application if the program director verifies that all course work and practicum requirements have been met and if the application is submitted no more than 3 years from the date the degree was awarded (see Section III. Standards and Implementation Procedures for the Certificates of Clinical Competence, for specific information). However, if you do not meet these requirements or received your education in a foreign country, you will not be considered a 'pass-through' applicant and will be required to complete the entire application as noted in the section below regarding 'Non-Pass-Through' applicants. "Pass-through" applicants should adhere to the following procedures: Program Director Signature. Have the director of your graduate program review and sign section 21 of the application (Form A). Your program director must verify that all requirements for graduate course work and practicum have been met. Of vital importance are the date on which the course work requirements were completed and the date on which the practicum requirements were completed. Also complete sections 1 through 6 and 19 through 21 of the application. Degree Verification. If the graduate degree has been officially conferred, completion of Section 20.C and the signature of the program director will serve as verification that the applicant has a graduate degree. No additional verification of degree is required; transcripts do not have to be submitted if the degree has been conferred at the time the application is signed by the program director. Degree Conferred in Future. If the graduate degree will be conferred after the application is signed by the program director, verification of actual receipt of the graduate degree is required. Verification can be submitted in any one of the following ways: (a) an official transcript with the degree date imprinted, (b) an unofficial transcript or a photocopy of a transcript with the degree date imprinted, (c) a letter signed by the graduate program director verifying the date on which the graduate degree was awarded, or (d) a letter from the registrar verifying the degree and the date it was awarded. Certification will not be awarded until verification of receipt of the graduate degree has been received by the Certification unit of the National Office. Examination. Exam results must be sent directly from the Educational Testing Service (ETS) in order to be applicable toward certification. When you register to take the exam, request that your score be reported directly to ASHA. ETS charges an additional fee to report scores after the examination has been taken. To assist the National Office in processing your examination information, it will be helpful if you submit a copy of the report sent to you by the testing service when you submit your application for certification. However, please note that this copy will not be used as official verification of completion of the examination requirement. Application Checklist. Finally, before you submit your application materials to the National Office, review the Application Checklist (Form F) to confirm that you have completed all the requirements for certification. Incomplete applications will be returned to the applicant. "Non-Pass-Through" Applicants You will be considered a 'non-pass-through' applicant if you (a) apply more than 3 years after the date your degree is awarded by an institution in which a CAA-accredited program is housed, (b) were enrolled in a CAA-accredited program that had its accreditation withdrawn before you graduated, (c) completed your graduate course work and practicum in the area in which you seek certification in a program that held candidacy status for accreditation, (d) completed your graduate course work and practicum in the area in which you seek certification in a CAA-accredited program but did not receive your graduate degree from the accredited program or received your graduate degree in a related area or received your graduate degree from an institution outside the United States and are not currently certified by an agency that has a reciprocal certification agreement with ASHA. Such applicants must complete the Membership/Certification Application (Form A) in its entirety and must follow the instructions below. Official graduate and undergraduate transcripts must be submitted before the CFCC will evaluate the application. Official transcripts can be submitted either from the applicant or directly from colleges/universities. (Also see Section III. Standards and Implementation Procedures for the Certificate of Clinical Competence, Standard I, for additional information regarding who must complete the entire application.) Complete sections 1 through 18 of the application. Have the director of your graduate program verify your graduate practicum hours at the end of section 18 and complete sections 19 through 21 of the application. List all course work in semester hours. If you earned credit on the quarter-hour system, use the conversion chart to convert quarter hours to semester hours. If you received some other type of credit, you must submit information from your university which equates the credit you earned to the semester-hour system. Applicants must have at least 75 semester credit hours combined over all course work. Only 6 semester credit hours of clinical practicum hours will be accepted within this overall total. Provide the course number and title as listed on your transcripts. If a course title is general or vague, submit a copy of the course description from the college/university catalog to clarify course content. If you wish to receive credit for a thesis/dissertation, you must submit an abstract. Do not send a copy of the entire thesis; materials are not returned to applicants. Be sure to check the appropriate columns for graduate credit, practicum credit, courses with culturally diverse populations, and courses in development and behavior across the life span. In completing the practicum section of the application, cite only those clock hours that were supervised by the indicated supervisor. Double check your math on the hours listed in the practicum sections. Have the application reviewed and signed by the authorized signer at the program where the graduate course work and practicum were completed. Sections 19-21 must be completed. Incomplete applications or those that bear invalid signatures will be returned to the applicant. Exam results must be sent directly from the Educational Testing Service (ETS) in order to be applicable toward certification. When you register to take the exam, request that your score be reported directly to ASHA. ETS charges an additional fee to report scores after the examination has been taken. To assist the National Office in processing your examination information, it will be helpful if you submit a copy of the report sent to you by the testing service when you submit your application for certification. However, please note that this copy will not be used as official verification of completion of the examination requirement. Finally, before you submit your application materials to the National Office, review the Application Checklist (Form F) to confirm that you have completed all the requirements for certification. Incomplete applications will be returned to the applicant. CFCC Interpretations on Course Work. Credit for a course is allowed only if an official transcript shows a passing grade for the course. Course credits should not be split unless it is absolutely necessary. If necessary, a course may be credited to no more than two categories, with no less than 1 semester hour credit assigned to each category. For courses with vague titles, such as "Directed Study," "Independent Study," "Speech Pathology I," "Audiology II," etc., the applicant must submit a copy of the catalog description. Copies of abstracts of projects, theses, or dissertations also must be submitted to the CFCC in order to be counted for credit. The CFCC may request further information on course content or projects if needed for the evaluation. Instructions for Dues and Fees. Refer to section 2 of the application form (Form A) and the current 'Schedule of Required Dues and Fees' (Form B) to determine the amount you must submit with your application. The entire payment must be submitted with the application. Applications received without payment will be returned. All fees must be paid in U.S. currency. Payment may be made by check, money order, or credit card (VISA or MasterCard). Do not send cash. Applications and payments received between January 1 and August 31 are processed for the year in which they are received; individuals will receive an invoice in October for dues and fees for the following year. Applications and payments received between September 1 and December 31 are processed for the following year, and applicants will receive complimentary membership from the time of application through the remainder of that year. Date of receipt is determined by the received date stamped in ASHA's Postal Operations center. Certification staff will not hold applications that arrive before August 31, but will process them as they are received. Dues and fees are based on a calendar year. The required renewal dues and fees must be paid annually upon receipt of the invoice in order to maintain membership, certification, or certification-in-process status. If you are unclear about the fees that you should submit with your application, please contact ASHA's Action Center (1-800-498-2071) for assistance. ABOUT THE PRAXIS EXAM The Praxis Examinations in Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology are a major component for ASHA certification and most state licensing requirements for audiologists and speech-language pathologists. The active participation of faculty and students in ensuring the success of the Praxis experience is essential to the future of each profession. To ensure success, it is essential that students prepare for the examinations and that faculty assist them with their preparation activities. The Praxis Series Specialty Area Tests in Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology are developed and owned by the Educational Testing Service (ETS). The exam is designed to provide a system of thorough, fair, and carefully validated tests and assessments. HOW IS THE TEST SCORED? Only questions answered correctly count toward the reported score. Therefore, it is better to guess than to leave an answer blank . There are several versions for each Praxis examination in speech-language pathology or audiology. The questions on one edition may be slightly more difficult (or easier) than those on another edition. ETS uses statistical methods to ensure that the various scores earned on editions of the active tests are comparable to each other. The passing score for ASHA certification is 600 out of a possible 800 for both Speech Language Pathology and Audiology. Each state determines its passing score for professional licensure and teacher certification. Most states use the same score of 600 as required for ASHA certification. However, in some states the Praxis examination score for licensure or teacher certification may be higher or lower than the ASHA minimum passing score. Typically, 80% of students in both speech-language pathology and audiology pass the Praxis examination on their first attempt. For the academic year 1998-1999, the mean score in audiology was 628, and the mean score in speechlanguage pathology was 651. Speech-language pathology and audiology test takers who have not earned a passing score have no limitation for a two-year period on the number of times that the Praxis examination can be taken. If the examination is not passed successfully within a 2-year period, the applicant's certification file will be closed. If the examination is passed at a later date, the individual will have to reapply for certification under the standards in effect at the time of reapplication. It is recommended that students register and take the examination no earlier than the completion of their graduate coursework and graduate clinical practicum or during the CF experience. WHO WRITES THE PRAXIS QUESTIONS? Several groups of individuals are involved in developing the questions to be included in each Praxis examination. ETS has a test development committee comprised of faculty and clinicians in speechlanguage pathology and a separate ETS test development committee for audiology. These individuals are well versed in developing test questions in specific content areas. In addition, ETS staff have specific responsibilities in developing and evaluating the Praxis questions. The ETS staff work very closely with staff members at ASHA's National Office who are involved in the areas of academic affairs, academic program accreditation and clinical certification. The following is a general overview of the role of the ETS Test Development Committees, ETS staff and ASHA staff. The Role of ASHA National Office Staff • Make recommendations to ETS about potential test development committee members • Contract with ETS every 5 to 7 years to conduct a job analysis and skills validation study for each profession • Identify the knowledge and skills necessary for entry-level practitioners to practice either speechlanguage pathology or audiology, based on the job analysis and skills validation study. The Role of ETS Staff • Develop contracts with each test development committee member • Review individual test questions from both content and statistical perspectives • Develop and/or modify a pool of questions • Review any questions identified as potentially flawed during a particular test administration • Assemble tests to conform to rigorous test standards and analyses of test questions • Provide differential statistical analyses to remove any cultural bias and to ensure a representative reflection of the multicultural nature of our society • Respond to questions raised by test takers, faculty and/or administrators • ETS will conduct cut-score studies for professional certification and licensure The Role of the ETS Test Development Committee • Provide feedback on the current scope of practice in the profession and changing demands of clinical practitioners For more information about the Praxis exam, see www.ets.org/praxis. FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS ABOUT THE PRAXIS EXAM Is it possible to study for the Praxis exam in Speech-Language Pathology or Audiology? Yes. Reviewing your course materials, becoming familiar with the test, and taking practice exams are all effective ways to prepare for the Praxis exams. This will help you to pace yourself, improve your score, and understand the questions that are asked. What is the format of the Praxis exam? The Praxis exams are 2-hour, multiple-choice tests. Multiple-choice questions based on case studies are included in the exams. There are no essay questions on the examinations. Is there a penalty for guessing on the Praxis exam? No. Only correct answers count toward your score. Leave NO question blank. It is to your advantage to guess! Is it true that as long as you get good grades in your courses and clinical practica you will pass the Praxis exam? No. You must be able to integrate this information and draw from your coursework and clinical experiences to pass the Praxis examination. Are there accommodations available for students with disabilities? Yes. See www.ets.org/praxis/prxdsabl.html for details. Can you cancel your score once you sit for the exam? Yes. If ETS receives a written request to cancel your score within one week of your test date, your score can be canceled. For special circumstances see www.ets.org/praxis/praxcrs.html for more information about score reporting. Do you have to pass the Praxis exam in order to be eligible for ASHA's Certificate of Clinical Competence (CCC) in Speech Language Pathology or Audiology? Yes. ASHA has set a passing score of 600 as one requirement for the CCC-SLP and CCC-A. If your primary language is not English, can you request special testing conditions? Yes. If your primary language is not English, you may be eligible for an alternate test site and/or extended time. Monday testing is available for those individuals unable to take a Saturday exam for religious reasons or because they are in the U.S. Armed Forces. Find out more details from www.ets.org/praxis. Is the Praxis exam culturally and linguistically fair? Yes. Each question undergoes a rigorous review for sensitivity and differential item analysis to ensure that no question favors or disfavors any group of test-takers by race, gender, or ethnicity. Also, each test is reviewed by a team of linguists with specific training in sociolinguistics to ensure accessibility. Does a Praxis score belong to ASHA once you take the test? No. You have the right to control the information that ETS has regarding your test score. No one will see your scores unless you designate them as a score recipient. SPEECH-LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY EXAM CONTENT Topics Covered The following list represents the topics covered the Speech Language Pathology Exam that is currently being administered. These topics are consistent with standards for clinical certification set by the American Speech-Language-Hearing Association. Basic Human Communication Processes • • • Language acquisition and learning theory o normal development of speech and language o developmental norms in phonology, syntax, semantics, and pragmatics o theoretical models of learning related to language and cognition o behavior management and modification o cognitive development o developmental, motor, and linguistic processes Language science o the structure of language o the phonetic and phonological representations of speech sounds o phonological theory as it relates to normal development o grammatical categories o morphology, syntax, semantics, and pragmatics, as these fields relate to normal language processing and production Learning theory o theoretical models of learning related to language and the effective treatment of disorders o models of behavior management and modification o • • theories of cognitive development Multicultural awareness o applications of theoretical models of language in society to a variety of linguistic and cultural groups o cultural and socioeconomic factors that influence speech and language o communicative differences between speakers of the same language, including idiolectal and dialectal distinctions o differentiation between first language/dialect interference and speech/language disorders o cultural differences in the use of nonverbal communication Speech science o speech perception o physiological phonetics o acoustic phonetics o anatomy and physiology, as related to the production, reception, and processing of speech, language, and hearing o neural bases of speech and hearing Phonological and Language Disorders Assessment and Treatment • • Phonological disorders o articulation disorders as influenced by anomalous, oral-motor, dental, learning, or behavioral factors o phonological process disorders Language disorders o developmental, motor, and linguistic processes o differentiation of normal, delayed, and disordered language development o the nature of expressive and receptive language disorders o treatment of language delays and language disorders Speech Disorders: Identification, Assessment, Treatment, and Prevention • Fluency disorders o theories of fluency o neurological and psychological factors o assessment, treatment, and prevention of fluency disorders • • Resonance disorders o resonance, as influenced by congenital anomalies, neuralgic disorders, disease, trauma, and behavioral factors o assessment, treatment, and prevention of resonance disorders Voice disorders o phonation, as influenced by respiratory, laryngeal, and airway problems resulting from malformations, neuralgia, disease, trauma, and behavioral factors o alaryngeal speech o assessment, treatment, and prevention of voice disorders Neurogenic Disorders • • Neurological disorders o aphasia o progressive disorders o motor speech disorders o traumatic brain injury o cognitive communication disorders Dysphagia o the process of swallowing o causes and effects of swallowing disorders o assessment and treatment of swallowing disorders Audiology/Hearing • • Hearing science o principles of hearing o anatomy and physiology of the hearing mechanism o congenital and acquired hearing loss in children and adults Audiological assessment o hearing screening for clients of all ages o interpretation of audiograms and tympanograms o referrals to appropriate professionals • Auditory habilitation and rehabilitation o management of clients with hearing loss o issues of intervention relevant to the practice of speech-language pathology Clinical Management • • • • • • Alternative/augmentative communication o assessment and use of alternative/augmentative communication devices o determining candidacy for alternative/augmentative devices Counseling o communicating assessment and treatment plans, progress, and results to clients and appropriate professionals o interpersonal communication and counseling techniques Documentation and monitoring client progress o collecting and using information from other agencies o communicating to other professionals concerning the client's history o data gathering and interpretation o determining termination criteria based on prognosis, progress, and motivation o procedures for referral and follow-up o writing professional reports Efficacy o demonstration of results of clinical services in relation to speech, language, and hearing o determining and communicating information about the outcomes of assessment and treatment Instrumentation o instrumentation used in speech and language analysis o the purpose, use, and applications of technological developments with respect to assessment and treatment of speech and language disorders Speech-language assessment o establishing clients' past and present status • • o formulating recommendations, including impact of life conditions, type of treatment, and service-delivery models o identifying individuals at risk for communication disorders o interviewing techniques and interpersonal skills o procedures for screening clients of all ages o selection and administration of standardized evaluation procedures, such as formal tests o selection and administration of non-standardized procedures, such as language samples and behavioral observations Speech-language intervention o diagnostic intervention o selecting activities appropriate to the client's age, sociocultural membership, and disorder o implementing remediation methods and strategies for disorders Syndromes and genetics o basic principles of genetics o syndromic and nonsyndromic inherited and developmental conditions o influence of syndromic and nonsyndromic conditions on hearing, speech and language development, production, and processing Professional Issues/Psychometrics/Research • • • Ethical practices o understanding standards for professional conduct o making referrals, obtaining permissions, keeping and using client records o ensuring client privacy o handling staffing issues in a professional and legally prudent manner Research methodology/psychometrics o criteria for selection of test materials o determining the reliability of assessment procedures o models of research design o test construction principles Standards and laws o designing appropriate assessment and treatment through knowledge of governmental regulations and professional standards o federal laws and regulations impacting delivery of services o reporting requirements of governmental agencies SOURCES FOR THE NATIONAL EXAMINATION IN SPEECH LANGUAGE PATHOLOGY AND AUDIOLOGY Although there are no specific study guides for the examinations, some individuals have reported the following sources to be helpful. (If you know of additional helpful review materials or courses, please notify the Certification Section in the National Office.) ASHA does not have these publications available. To receive additional information on how to obtain these books, please contact your local bookstore or library, or the publisher directly. Lass, N., et al. (1988). Handbook of Speech-Language Pathology and Audiology. B.C. Decker, Inc. A comprehensive volume covering the latest information on processes/pathologies of speech, language and hearing. Shames & Anderson (2003). Human Communication Disorders: An Introduction. Pearson Allyn & Bacon. Perkins, W. & Bell, J. (1977). Study Guide for Speech Pathology and Review for the National Examination. Mosby Co. Out of Print. May be available at local libraries. Nicolosi, L., Harryman, E. & Kresheck, J. (2003). Terminology of Communication Disorders - Speech, Language, Hearing. Lippincott Williams & Wilkins Company, Baltimore, MD. Provides a comprehensive dictionary/source book which includes definitions of the terminology used in the field and in allied areas. Educational Testing Service. (2003) Speech-Language Pathology Study Guide (Praxis Study Guides). WHEN First Semester TIMELINE FOR TRANSITION FROM GRADUATE STUDENT TO SLP PROFESSIONAL CASE ASHA CERTIFICATION OHIO LICENSURE DESCRIPTION/ACTIVITY X Complete initial Plan of Study with advisor. If you are interested in School Certification, please see Coordinator of Teacher Licensure. X Throughout Program X X X X X X Completion of required academic coursework and clinical hours. Begin preparing for comprehensive exam process. Organize notes, articles, etc. for each area. By the middle of the semester, you should meet with your advisor to discuss strategies for studying and to discuss comprehensive exam process. Begin studying. Complete practice questions and get feedback from faculty members. Successfully complete comprehensive exams. 3rd Semester or Semester Before Comprehensive Exams X 4th Semester or Semester of Comprehensive Exams X X X Apply for Graduation. X X X Take the PRAXIS Exam. Have scores sent to Case, Ohio Board of Speech Language Pathology and Audiology, ASHA, and Ohio Department of Education if filing for Teacher Licensure. X Request ASHA Membership and Certification Handbook (www.asha.org). X Request “Conditional License” application materials from the Ohio Board of Speech Language Pathology and Audiology (www.state.oh/us/slp) X X X Complete final academic and clinical requirements. X X X Prepare resume for job search process. X X Obtain a CFY position and a CFY supervisor. X Complete application materials for Ohio Board of Speech Language Pathology and Audiology. APPENDIX K: PORTFOLIO ASSESSMENT AND INTERVENTION FORMS Use the following forms to document your clinical experiences each semester. Keep a copy for your portfolio. In addition, provide a copy for the Coordinator of Clinical Education at the end of each semester. You may choose to share these with your supervisor as you formulate your goals for clinical growth. A completed example has bee provided. ASSESSMENT Semester _______ Year _________ Standardized Tools Placement: ___________________________________________ Non-standardized Tools Analysis INTERVENTION Semester ______________ Diagnosis Year _______________ Age/Demographic Variables Placement _________________________________ Treatment Approaches Describe contact with others relevant to client’s communication (e.g. parents, teachers, aides, etc.)